SINCLAIR BROADCAST GROUP INC
424B4, 1997-09-19
TELEVISION BROADCASTING STATIONS
Previous: SINCLAIR BROADCAST GROUP INC, 424B3, 1997-09-19
Next: FINANCIAL SECURITY ASSURANCE HOLDINGS LTD/NY/, 8-K, 1997-09-19




PROSPECTUS SUPPLEMENT
(TO PROSPECTUS DATED SEPTEMBER 16, 1997)
                                3,000,000 SHARES


                                      SBG
                            SINCLAIR BROADCAST GROUP





                 $3.00 CONVERTIBLE EXCHANGEABLE PREFERRED STOCK
                              ------------------


     Each share of $3.00 Series D Convertible  Exchangeable Preferred Stock, par
value  $.01 per share  (the  "Convertible  Exchangeable  Preferred  Stock"),  of
Sinclair  Broadcast Group, Inc.  ("Sinclair" or the "Company") has a liquidation
preference of $50.  Dividends on the  Convertible  Exchangeable  Preferred Stock
will be cumulative from the date of original issue and will be payable quarterly
commencing on December 15, 1997, in the amount of $3.00 per share annually when,
as and if declared by the Board of Directors out of legally available funds. See
"Description of Preferred Stock - Dividends."

     Shares of the Convertible  Exchangeable  Preferred Stock are convertible at
any time, at the option of the holders thereof,  unless  previously  redeemed or
exchanged, into shares of Class A Common Stock, par value $.01 per share, of the
Company (the "Class A Common Stock") at an initial  conversion  price of $45.625
per share of Class A Common Stock  (equivalent  to a  conversion  rate of 1.0959
shares of Class A Common Stock per share of Convertible  Exchangeable  Preferred
Stock) subject to adjustment in certain  events.  See  "Description of Preferred
Stock - Conversion  Rights". On September 17, 1997, the last reported sale price
of the Class A Common  Stock as  reported  by Nasdaq was $36 5/8 per share.  The
Convertible  Exchangeable Preferred Stock will not be redeemable until September
20,  2000.  On and  after  September  20,  2000,  the  Convertible  Exchangeable
Preferred Stock will be redeemable at the option of the Company,  in whole or in
part,  initially  at a price  per  share  equal to  104.20%  of the  liquidation
preference   thereof  and  thereafter  at  prices  declining  to  100%  of  such
liquidation  preference  on and  after  September  15,  2007,  in each case plus
accrued  and unpaid  dividends  to the  redemption  date.  See  "Description  of
Preferred Stock - Company's Right of Redemption."


                                                       (continued on next page)
                               ------------------

     SEE  "RISK  FACTORS" BEGINNING ON PAGE 3 OF THE ACCOMPANYING PROSPECTUS FOR
A  DISCUSSION  OF  CERTAIN  FACTORS  THAT  SHOULD  BE  CONSIDERED BY PROSPECTIVE
PURCHASERS  OF  THE  SHARES  OF CONVERTIBLE EXCHANGEABLE PREFERRED STOCK OFFERED
HEREBY.
                              ------------------

  THESE SECURITIES HAVE NOT BEEN APPROVED OR DISAPPROVED BY THE SECURITIES AND
 EXCHANGE COMMISSION OR ANY STATE SECURITIES COMMISSION, NOR HAS THE SECURITIES
   AND EXCHANGE COMMISSION OR ANY STATE SECURITIES COMMISSION PASSED UPON THE
     ACCURACY OR ADEQUACY OF THIS PROSPECTUS SUPPLEMENT OR THE ACCOMPANYING
      PROSPECTUS. ANY REPRESENTATION TO THE CONTRARY IS A CRIMINAL OFFENSE.
- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------


<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
                   PRICE TO     UNDERWRITING DISCOUNTS        PROCEEDS TO
                  THE PUBLIC      AND COMMISSIONS (1)       THE COMPANY (2)
<S>             <C>                   <C>                    <C>
Per Share       $      50.00          $    1.375             $     48.625
Total(3)        $150,000,000          $4,125,000             $145,875,000
</TABLE>
- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------

   (1)   The Company has agreed to indemnify the  Underwriters  against  certain
         liabilities, including liabilities under the Securities Act of 1933, as
         amended. See "Underwriting."

   (2)   Before  deducting  expenses  of the  Offering  payable  by the  Company
         estimated at $800,000.

   (3)   The Company has granted the Underwriters a 30-day option to purchase up
         to  an  aggregate   of  450,000   additional   shares  of   Convertible
         Exchangeable  Preferred  Stock on the same  terms  as set  forth  above
         solely to cover over-allotments, if any. If such option is exercised in
         full,  the  total  Price  to the  Public,  Underwriting  Discounts  and
         Commissions   and  Proceeds  to  the  Company  will  be   $172,500,000,
         $4,743,750 and $167,756,250, respectively. See "Underwriting."
                               ------------------

The  shares of Convertible Exchangeable Preferred Stock are being offered by the
several  Underwriters  named  herein,  subject  to  prior  sale, when, as and if
accepted  by  them  and  subject  to  certain  conditions.  It  is  expected the
Convertible  Exchangeable Preferred Stock will be available for delivery in book
entry  form  only through the facilities of The Depository Trust Company ("DTC")
in New York, New York on or about September 23, 1997,  against payment  therefor
in immediately available funds.
                               ------------------

SMITH BARNEY INC.
           BT ALEX. BROWN
                      CREDIT SUISSE FIRST BOSTON
                                    SALOMON BROTHERS INC
                                                 CHASE SECURITIES INC.
September  17, 1997                                                  FURMAN SELZ


<PAGE>


                                  [INSERT MAP]

   TELEVISION AND RADIO STATIONS (I) OWNED AND OPERATED BY THE COMPANY, (II)
           PROGRAMMED BY THE COMPANY PURSUANT TO LMAS, (III) PROVIDED
 SELLING SERVICES PURSUANT TO JSAS, (IV) SUBJECT TO OPTIONS TO ACQUIRE AND (V)
                   UNDER AGREEMENTS TO BE ACQUIRED, INCLUDING
 AGREEMENTS TO ACQUIRE RIGHTS TO PROGRAM STATIONS PURSUANT TO LMAS, ALL AS SET
                       FORTH UNDER "BUSINESS OF SINCLAIR."


Certain persons  participating in this offering may engage in transactions  that
stabilize,  maintain, or otherwise affect the price of Convertible  Exchangeable
Preferred Stock, including  overallotment,  entering stabilizing bids, effecting
syndicate covering  transactions and imposing penalty bids. For a description of
those activities, see "Underwriting." 

<PAGE>


     Subject to certain  conditions,  on any  dividend  payment  date  beginning
December  15,  2000,  the  Convertible  Exchangeable  Preferred  Stock  will  be
exchangeable  at the  option of the  Company,  in whole but not in part,  for 6%
Convertible  Subordinated  Exchange  Debentures (the "Exchange  Debentures") due
September 15, 2012 in a principal  amount equal to $50 per share of  Convertible
Exchangeable  Preferred Stock,  provided that all accrued dividends  (whether or
not declared) have been paid. The Exchange Debentures will be issued pursuant to
an indenture (the "Exchange  Debentures  Indenture"),  will be convertible  into
shares of Class A Common Stock on the same terms as the Convertible Exchangeable
Preferred Stock and will pay interest  quarterly.  The Exchange  Debentures will
contain redemption  provisions similar to those of the Convertible  Exchangeable
Preferred  Stock. The Exchange  Debentures will be unsecured  obligations of the
Company  and  subordinated  to all  Senior  Debt  (as  defined  herein)  whether
outstanding on the date of the exchange or thereafter  incurred.  As of June 30,
1997, on a pro forma basis, after giving effect to the Debt Issuance (as defined
herein), the sale of the Convertible Exchangeable Preferred Stock offered hereby
and the use of the estimated  net proceeds  therefrom,  the aggregate  amount of
Senior  Debt that would have ranked  senior in right of payment to the  Exchange
Debentures  would have been  approximately  $1.6 billion.  See  "Description  of
Exchange Debentures."

     Concurrently  with the offering of the Convertible  Exchangeable  Preferred
Stock hereunder (the  "Preferred  Stock Offering" or the "Offering") the Company
and  certain  stockholders  of the  Company  (the  "Selling  Stockholders")  are
offering  to sell by a  separate  Prospectus  Supplement  4,000,000  shares  and
1,300,000  shares,  respectively,  of Class A Common  Stock (the  "Common  Stock
Offering").  The completion of the Preferred  Stock Offering is not  conditioned
upon the completion of the Common Stock Offering.


     The  Company has  applied  for  listing  for the  Convertible  Exchangeable
Preferred Stock on the Nasdaq National Market.

     The  Company's  outstanding  capital  stock  consists  of shares of Class A
Common  Stock,  shares of Class B Common  Stock,  par value  $.01 per share (the
"Class B Common Stock"),  shares of Series B Preferred Stock, par value $.01 per
share (the "Series B Preferred  Stock") and shares of Series C Preferred  Stock,
par value $.01 per share (the  "Series C  Preferred  Stock").  The rights of the
Class A Common  Stock and the Class B Common  Stock  (collectively,  the "Common
Stock") are  identical,  except that each share of Class A Common Stock entitles
the holder  thereof to one vote in respect of matters  submitted for the vote of
holders of Common Stock, whereas each share of Class B Common Stock entitles the
holder thereof to one vote on "going private" and certain other transactions and
to ten votes on other matters.  The Controlling  Stockholders (as defined in the
accompanying  Prospectus) and their Permitted  Transferees  (generally,  related
parties  of a  Controlling  Stockholder)  have  the  power  to vote  100% of the
outstanding shares of Class B Common Stock representing, together with the Class
A Common Stock held by the Controlling Stockholders,  approximately 96.0% of the
aggregate voting power of the Company's  capital stock (or  approximately  94.1%
after the sale of shares in the Common  Stock  Offering  assuming no exercise of
the over-allotment option granted the Underwriters in connection with the Common
Stock Offering).  Each share of Class B Common Stock converts automatically into
one share of Class A Common  Stock upon sale or other  transfer to a party other
than a  Permitted  Transferee.  Each  share of  Series B  Preferred  Stock has a
liquidation  preference  of $100,  is  convertible  into 3.64  shares of Class A
Common Stock (subject to adjustment), and has 3.64 votes on all matters on which
shares of Common  Stock have a vote.  Except as  described  in the  accompanying
Prospectus, the Series C Preferred Stock does not have rights to vote on matters
on which shares of Common Stock have a vote. See  "Description of Capital Stock"
in the accompanying Prospectus.




                                      iii
<PAGE>

                         PROSPECTUS SUPPLEMENT SUMMARY

     The following  summary should be read in conjunction with the more detailed
information,  financial  statements and notes thereto appearing  elsewhere in or
incorporated by reference into this Prospectus  Supplement and the  accompanying
Prospectus.  Unless the context requires otherwise,  this Prospectus  Supplement
and the  Prospectus  assume  no  exercise  of the  Underwriters'  over-allotment
option. Unless the context otherwise indicates, as used herein, the "Company" or
"Sinclair"  means  Sinclair  Broadcast  Group,  Inc. and its direct and indirect
wholly-owned subsidiaries (collectively, the "Subsidiaries").  Capitalized terms
used in this Prospectus Supplement have the meaning set forth in the Glossary of
Defined Terms, which appears at the end of this Prospectus Supplement.


                                  THE COMPANY

     The Company is a  diversified  broadcasting  company  that owns or provides
programming  services  to more  television  stations  than any other  commercial
broadcasting  group in the United States. The Company currently owns or provides
programming  services  pursuant  to  Local  Marketing  Agreements  (LMAs)  to 29
television  stations,  has pending  acquisitions of four  additional  television
stations,  and has pending  acquisitions of the rights to provide programming to
two additional  television stations.  The Company believes it is also one of the
top 20 radio groups in the United  States,  when measured by the total number of
radio  stations  owned.  The  Company  owns  27  radio  stations,   has  pending
acquisitions of 24 radio stations and has options to acquire an additional seven
radio stations.


     The 29  television  stations the Company owns or programs  pursuant to LMAs
are located in 21 geographically diverse markets, with 23 of the stations in the
top 51 television DMAs in the United States.  The Company's  television  station
group is diverse in network  affiliation with ten stations  affiliated with Fox,
12 with UPN, three with WB, two with ABC and one with CBS. One station  operates
as an  independent.  The Company has recently  entered into an agreement with WB
pursuant to which eight of its stations  would switch  affiliations  to, and one
independent station has become affiliated with, WB. In addition, the Company has
notified UPN of its non-renewal of affiliation  with respect to three additional
stations,   which  will  either  operate  as  independents  or  enter  into  new
affiliation agreements with UPN or another network.


     The Company's  radio station  group is also  geographically  diverse with a
variety of  programming  formats  including  country,  urban,  news/talk/sports,
progressive  rock  and  adult  contemporary.  Of the 27  stations  owned  by the
Company,  12  broadcast  on the AM band and 15 on the FM band.  The Company owns
from two to eight stations in all but one of the seven radio markets it serves.


     The Company has undergone rapid and  significant  growth over the course of
the last six years. Since 1991, the Company has increased the number of stations
it owns or provides services to from three television  stations to 29 television
stations and 27 radio  stations.  From 1991 to 1996, net broadcast  revenues and
Adjusted  EBITDA (as  defined  herein)  increased  from $39.7  million to $346.5
million, and from $15.5 million to $180.3 million,  respectively.  Pro forma for
the acquisitions completed in 1996 and the Heritage Acquisition described below,
1996 net broadcast  revenues and Adjusted  EBITDA would have been $532.4 million
and $246.3 million, respectively.


                               COMPANY STRATEGY

     The Company's  operating  strategy is to (i) attract audience share through
the acquisition and broadcasting of popular programming,  children's  television
programming,  counter-programming,  local news programming in selected DMAs, and
popular  sporting  events in selected  DMAs;  (ii)  increase its share of market
revenues through  innovative  sales and marketing  efforts;  (iii)  aggressively
control  programming  and other  operating  costs;  (iv) attract and retain high
quality management;  (v) expand its stations'  involvement in their communities;
and (vi) establish additional television LMAs and increase the size of its radio
clusters.


                                      S-1
<PAGE>

     The  Company's  LMA  arrangements  in  markets  where  it  already  owns  a
television  station are a major  factor in enabling  the Company to increase its
revenues and improve operating margins.  These LMAs have also helped the Company
to manage its  programming  inventory  effectively  and increase  the  Company's
broadcast revenues in those markets. In addition,  the Company believes that its
LMA  arrangements  have assisted  certain  television  and radio  stations whose
operations  may have been  marginally  profitable  to  continue  to air  popular
programming  and  contribute  to  programming   diversity  in  their  respective
television DMAs and radio MSAs.

     The Company intends to continue to pursue  acquisitions in order to build a
larger  and  more  diversified   broadcasting   company.   In  implementing  its
acquisition strategy, the Company routinely reviews and conducts  investigations
of  potential  television  and  radio  station  acquisitions.  When the  Company
believes  a  favorable  opportunity  exists,  the  Company  seeks to enter  into
discussions  with the owners of such stations  regarding the  possibility  of an
acquisition by the Company. At any given time, the Company may be in discussions
with one or more such station owners.  In addition,  the Company intends to seek
and may take advantage of favorable opportunities to sell or swap television and
radio stations. See "Business of Sinclair - Broadcast Acquisition Strategy."



                              RECENT DEVELOPMENTS


AGREEMENT WITH THE WB NETWORK

     On July 4, 1997,  the Company  entered into an  agreement  with WB (the "WB
Agreement"),  pursuant  to  which  the  Company  agreed  that  certain  stations
currently affiliated with UPN would terminate their affiliations with UPN at the
end of the  current  affiliation  term in  January  1998,  and would  enter into
affiliation  agreements  with WB  effective  as of that date.  The  Company  has
advised UPN that the following stations owned or provided  programming  services
by the Company  will not renew their  affiliation  agreements  with UPN when the
current   agreements   expire  on  January  15,   1998:   WPTT-TV,   Pittsburgh,
Pennsylvania,  WNUV-TV, Baltimore, Maryland. WSTR-TV, Cincinnati, Ohio, KRRT-TV,
San Antonio,  Texas,  KOCB-TV,  Oklahoma City, Oklahoma,  KSMO-TV,  Kansas City,
Missouri,  KUPN-TV, Las Vegas, Nevada, WCGV-TV, Milwaukee,  Wisconsin,  WABM-TV,
Birmingham, Alabama, and WTTV-TV/WTTK-TV,  Indianapolis, Indiana. These stations
(other  than  WCGV-TV,  KSMO-TV  and  WABM-TV,  which  either  will  operate  as
independents  or  enter  into new  affiliation  agreements  with UPN or  another
network) will enter into ten-year  affiliation  agreements  with WB beginning on
 January 16, 1998  (other  than  WTTV-TV/WTTK-TV,  with  respect to which the
affiliation  agreement  will begin  January 11, 1999 and end January 15,  2008).
Pursuant  to the  WB  Agreement,  the  WB  affiliation  agreements  of  WVTV-TV,
Milwaukee,  Wisconsin,  and WTTO-TV,  Birmingham,  Alabama (whose programming is
simulcasted on WDBB-TV, Tuscaloosa,  Alabama), have been extended to January 16,
2008. In addition, WFBC-TV in Greenville,  South Carolina will become affiliated
with WB on November 1, 1999, when WB's current  affiliation with another station
in that market expires.  WTVZ-TV,  Norfolk, Virginia and WLFL-TV, Raleigh, North
Carolina,  will  become  affiliated  with WB when  their  affiliations  with Fox
expire. These Fox affiliations are scheduled to expire on August 31, 1998. Under
the terms of the WB  Agreement,  WB has agreed to pay the  Company  $64  million
aggregate  amount in monthly  installments  during the eight years commencing on
January 16, 1998 in consideration for entering into affiliation  agreements with
WB. In addition, WB will be obligated to pay an additional $10 million aggregate
amount in monthly  installments in each of the following two years provided that
WB is in the business of supplying  programming  as a television  network during
each of those years. 

     In August 1997,  UPN filed an action in Los Angeles  Superior Court against
the Company,  seeking  declaratory  relief and specific  performance  or, in the
alternative,  unspecified  damages and alleging that neither the Company nor its
affiliates  provided  proper notice of their intention not to extend the current
UPN affiliations beyond January 15, 1998. Certain subsidiaries of the Company


                                      S-2
<PAGE>

have filed an action in the Circuit Court for Baltimore City seeking declaratory
relief that their notice was effective to terminate the  affiliations on January
15, 1998. See "Risk Factors - Certain Network  Affiliations" in the accompanying
Prospectus and "Business of Sinclair - Legal Proceedings" herein.


HERITAGE ACQUISITION

     On July 16,  1997,  the Company  entered  into  agreements  (the  "Heritage
Acquisition  Agreements")  with The News  Corporation  Limited,  Heritage  Media
Group,   Inc.   and  certain   subsidiaries   of  Heritage   Media   Corporation
(collectively,  "Heritage"),  pursuant  to which the  Company  agreed to acquire
certain  television  and radio assets of such  subsidiaries.  Under the Heritage
Acquisition Agreements,  the Company will acquire the assets of, or the right to
program  pursuant to LMAs,  six  television  stations  in three  markets and the
assets of 24 radio stations in seven markets (the "Heritage  Acquisition").  The
television stations serve the following markets:  Charleston/  Huntington,  West
Virginia;   Mobile,   Alabama/Pensacola,   Florida;  and  Burlington,   Vermont/
Plattsburgh,  New York.  The radio  stations  serve the following  markets:  St.
Louis, Missouri; Portland, Oregon; Kansas City, Missouri; Milwaukee,  Wisconsin;
Norfolk,  Virginia;  New  Orleans,  Louisiana;  and  Rochester,  New  York.  The
aggregate  purchase  price for the  assets is $630  million  payable  in cash at
closing,  less a deposit of $63 million paid at the time of signing the Heritage
Acquisition Agreements. The Heritage Acquisition Agreements also provide for the
acquisition of the assets of a television  station in Oklahoma  City,  Oklahoma;
the  Company is required by the  agreements  to dispose of its  interest in that
station,  and the  Company  has  entered  into a letter  of  intent to sell that
station for $60 million in cash.  The  Company  intends to finance the  purchase
price from some  combination of the proceeds of the Common Stock  Offering,  the
proceeds of the Preferred Stock Offering,  funds available under the Bank Credit
Agreement,  and the  anticipated  $60 million in  proceeds  from the sale of the
Company's  interest  in the  Oklahoma  City  station.  Closing  of the  Heritage
Acquisition  is  conditioned  on,  among  other  things,  FCC  approval  and the
expiration  of  the  applicable  waiting  period  under  the   Hart-Scott-Rodino
Antitrust Improvements Act of 1976, as amended.


COMMON STOCK OFFERING


     Concurrently with the Preferred Stock Offering, the Company and the Selling
Stockholders  have agreed to sell 4,000,000 shares and 1,300,000 shares of Class
A Common  Stock,  respectively,  in the Common Stock  Offering.  There can be no
assurance that the Common Stock Offering will be consummated.  The completion of
the  Preferred  Stock  Offering is not  conditioned  upon the  completion of the
Common Stock Offering. 


                                      S-3
<PAGE>

                                 THE OFFERING


SHARES OF CONVERTIBLE
EXCHANGEABLE PREFERRED
STOCK OFFERED.              3,000,000 shares (a)

PREFERRED AND COMMON STOCK
TO  BE  OUTSTANDING  AFTER
THE OFFERING .............  1,088,904 shares of Series B Preferred Stock
                            2,062,000 shares of Series C Preferred Stock
                            3,000,000   shares   of   Convertible   Exchangeable
                            Preferred Stock(a)
                            7,245,566   shares  of  Class  A  Common   Stock(b)
                            27,510,581 shares of Class B Common Stock 
                            34,756,147 total shares of Common Stock(b)

USE  OF  PROCEEDS  .......  The net  proceeds to the Company  from the  Offering
                            and the Common Stock  Offering will be used to repay
                            certain amounts outstanding under the Company's Bank
                            Credit  Agreement,  with the remainder  retained for
                            general  corporate  purposes  including  funding the
                            Heritage Acquisition,  which is anticipated to close
                            in the first quarter of 1998, and other acquisitions
                            if  suitable   acquisitions  can  be  identified  on
                            acceptable terms. See "Use of Proceeds."


DIVIDENDS ................  Dividends on the Convertible  Exchangeable Preferred
                            Stock will be cumulative and accrue from the date of
                            issuance and will be payable quarterly commencing on
                            December 15, 1997,  in the amount of $3.00 per share
                            annually,  when,  as and if declared by the Board of
                            Directors out of legally available funds.


LIQUIDATION PREFERENCE ...  $50.00  per  share,  plus  an  amount  equal  to any
                            accrued and unpaid dividends.

CONVERSION  RIGHTS .......  The  shares of  Convertible  Exchangeable  Preferred
                            Stock are convertible at the option of the holder at
                            any time, unless  previously  redeemed or exchanged,
                            into  Class A  Common  Stock  of the  Company,  at a
                            conversion  price of  $45.625  per  share of Class A
                            Common Stock  (equivalent  to a  conversion  rate of
                            1.0959  shares of Class A Common  Stock per share of
                            Convertible  Exchangeable  Preferred Stock), subject
                            to adjustment in certain events. See "Description of
                            Convertible    Exchangeable    Preferred   Stock   -
                            Conversion Rights."



- ----------

(a) Excludes  up  to  450,000 shares of Convertible Exchangeable Preferred Stock
    that  may  be sold by the Company upon exercise of the over-allotment option
    granted to the Underwriters. See "Underwriting."


(b) Excludes  3,949,029  shares of Class A Common  Stock that may be issued upon
    conversion  of shares  of Series B  Preferred  Stock  outstanding  after the
    Offering  and up to 2,641,673  shares of Class A Common  Stock  reserved for
    issuance  pursuant  to  the  Company's  Incentive  Stock  Option  Plan,  the
    Company's  Designated  Participants  Stock  Option  Plan  and the  Company's
    Long-Term  Incentive  Plan.  Also excludes (i)  4,000,000  shares of Class A
    Common  Stock that are being  issued in the  Common  Stock  Offering  by the
    Company and 1,300,000  shares of Class A Common Stock that are being sold by
    the Selling  Stockholders  in the Common Stock  Offering  (which  shares are
    included in shares of Class B Common Stock), (ii) 395,000 shares and 450,000
    shares  (which  shares are  included  in shares of Class B Common  Stock) of
    Class  A  Common  Stock  that  may be sold by the  Company  and the  Selling
    Stockholders,  respectively,  upon  exercise  of the  over-allotment  option
    granted to the Underwriters in the Common Stock Offering and (iii) 3,287,671
    shares of Class A Common  Stock that may be issued  upon  conversion  of the
    shares of Convertible  Exchangeable Preferred Stock offered hereby (based on
    the conversion price on the date of issuance).



                                      S-4
<PAGE>

CHANGE  OF  CONTROL.......  Upon the  occurrence  of a  Change  of  Control  (as
                            defined   herein),   each   share   of   Convertible
                            Exchangeable  Preferred Stock will be convertible at
                            the option of its holder for a limited  period  into
                            the  number  of  shares  of  Class  A  Common  Stock
                            determined   by   dividing   the   $50   liquidation
                            preference  of such share,  plus  accrued and unpaid
                            dividends,  by an adjusted  conversion price. Upon a
                            Change  of  Control,  the  Company  may elect to pay
                            holders of the  Convertible  Exchangeable  Preferred
                            Stock exercising their special  conversion rights an
                            amount  in  cash   equal  to  the  $50   liquidation
                            preference of the Convertible Exchangeable Preferred
                            Stock  plus any  accrued  and unpaid  dividends,  in
                            which event no  conversion  pursuant to the exercise
                            of the special conversion rights will occur,  unless
                            the Company defaults in payments of such amounts.  A
                            Change of Control will result in an event of default
                            under the Bank Credit  Agreement (as defined herein)
                            and  could  result  in  the   acceleration   of  all
                            indebtedness   under  the  Bank  Credit   Agreement.
                            Moreover,  the Bank Credit  Agreement  prohibits the
                            repurchase of the Convertible Exchangeable Preferred
                            Stock by the Company.  A Change of Control will also
                            require the Company to offer to redeem the  Existing
                            Notes (as defined herein) and the Series C Preferred
                            Stock. See "Description of Convertible  Exchangeable
                            Preferred Stock - Change of Control."



OPTIONAL  REDEMPTION  ....  The  Convertible  Exchangeable  Preferred  Stock  is
                            redeemable at the Company's option, in whole or from
                            time to time in  part,  for  cash at any  time on or
                            after  September 20, 2000,  initially at a price per
                            share equal to 104.20% of the liquidation preference
                            thereof,  declining ratably on or after September 15
                            of each year thereafter to a redemption  price equal
                            to 100% of such liquidation  preference per share on
                            or after  September  15,  2007  plus,  in each case,
                            accrued and unpaid  dividends.  See  "Description of
                            Convertible    Exchangeable    Preferred   Stock   -
                            Redemption at Option of the Company."



RANK......................  With respect to dividends  and amounts  payable upon
                            the  liquidation,  dissolution  or winding up of the
                            Company,  the  Convertible   Exchangeable  Preferred
                            Stock  will rank (i)  junior in right of  payment to
                            all    indebtedness   of   the   Company   and   its
                            Subsidiaries,  (ii)  senior  to the  Class A  Common
                            Stock and the Class B Common Stock, (iii) pari passu
                            with the Series C Preferred  Stock  ($206.2  million
                            liquidation  value as of the date  hereof)  and (iv)
                            senior to the  Company's  Series B  Preferred  Stock
                            ($108.9  million  liquidation  value  as of the date
                            hereof)  except that upon the  termination  of Barry
                            Baker's employment  agreement with the Company prior
                            to May 31, 2001 by the Company for any reason  other
                            than  "for  cause"  (as  defined  in the  employment
                            agreement)   or   by   Mr.   Baker   under   certain
                            circumstances    described   under   "Management   -
                            Employment   Agreements,"   then   the   Convertible
                            Exchangeable  Preferred  Stock  will rank pari passu
                            with the  Series B  Preferred  Stock in  respect  of
                            dividends  and   distributions   upon   liquidation,
                            dissolution and winding-up of the Company.  One such
                            circumstance   pursuant  to  which  Mr.   Baker  can
                            terminate his employment agreement is the failure of
                            Mr.  Baker to be elected  and  continued  in certain
                            positions  at the Company  before  August 31,  1997,
                            which  election  cannot  take  place  prior  to  the
                            Company


                                      S-5
<PAGE>

                            taking  certain  actions  related to FCC approval of
                            such  election.  The  Company  has  not  taken these
                            actions   as   of   the   date  of  this  Prospectus
                            Supplement  and,  accordingly,  Mr. Baker is able to
                            terminate  his employment agreement at any time. See
                            "Description  of  Convertible Exchangeable Preferred
                            Stock - Liquidation Rights."



VOTING  RIGHTS  ..........  Except as  described  below or as  required  by law,
                            holders of Convertible  Exchangeable Preferred Stock
                            will  not be  entitled  to  any  voting  rights.  In
                            exercising any voting rights, each outstanding share
                            of Convertible  Exchangeable Preferred Stock will be
                            entitled  to one  vote.  Whenever  dividends  on the
                            Convertible  Exchangeable  Preferred  Stock  are  in
                            arrears in an aggregate amount equal to at least six
                            quarterly  dividends  (whether or not  consecutive),
                            the size of the Company's Board of Directors will be
                            increased  by two (or,  if the size of the  Board of
                            Directors cannot be so increased,  the Company shall
                            cause the  removal or  resignation  of a  sufficient
                            number of directors), and the holders of Convertible
                            Exchangeable Preferred Stock, voting separately as a
                            class,  will be entitled to select two  directors to
                            the Board of Directors at (i) any annual  meeting of
                            stockholders  at which  directors  are to be elected
                            held during the period when the dividends  remain in
                            arrears or (ii) a special  meeting  of  stockholders
                            called by the  Company at the request of the holders
                            of the  Convertible  Exchangeable  Preferred  Stock.
                            These  voting   rights  will   terminate   when  all
                            dividends  in arrears and for the current  quarterly
                            period  have been paid in full or  declared  and set
                            apart  for  payment.  The  term  of  office  of  the
                            additional   directors  so  elected  will  terminate
                            immediately  upon  that  payment  or  provision  for
                            payment.  Under certain  circumstances,  the Company
                            may be required to pay  additional  dividends  if it
                            fails to provide  for the board  seats  referred  to
                            above. See "Description of Convertible  Exchangeable
                            Preferred Stock - Voting Rights."


                            In addition, so long as any Convertible Exchangeable
                            Preferred  Stock is  outstanding,  the Company  will
                            not,  without the affirmative vote or consent of the
                            holders  of at  least  66  2/3%  of all  outstanding
                            shares of Convertible  Exchangeable  Preferred Stock
                            (i) amend,  alter or repeal (by merger or otherwise)
                            any  provision of the Amended and Restated  Articles
                            of Incorporation of the Company,  as amended, or the
                            Bylaws of the Company so as to affect  adversely the
                            relative   rights,   preferences,    qualifications,
                            limitations  or   restrictions  of  the  Convertible
                            Exchangeable Preferred Stock, (ii) authorize any new
                            class of Senior Dividend Stock (as defined  herein),
                            any Senior  Liquidation Stock (as defined herein) or
                            any security  convertible into Senior Dividend Stock
                            or Senior  Liquidation  Stock,  or (iii)  effect any
                            reclassification  of  the  Convertible  Exchangeable
                            Preferred  Stock.  See  "Description  of Convertible
                            Exchangeable Preferred Stock - Voting Rights."



EXCHANGE  PROVISIONS .....  Subject to certain  conditions,  the Company may, at
                            its option,  on any scheduled  Dividend Payment Date
                            (as defined herein) commencing on December 15, 2000,
                            exchange  the  Convertible   Exchangeable  Preferred
                            Stock,  in whole but not in part,  for the Company's
                            6% Convertible Subordinated Debentures due 2012 (the
                            "Exchange   Debentures").   Holders  of  Convertible
                            Exchangeable  Preferred  Stock so exchanged  will be
                            entitled to



                                      S-6
<PAGE>


                            $1,000 principal  amount of Exchange  Debentures for
                            each $1,000 of liquidation preference of Convertible
                            Exchangeable Preferred Stock held by such holders at
                            the time of  exchange  plus an  amount  per share in
                            cash  equal  to all  accrued  but  unpaid  dividends
                            (whether  or not  declared)  thereon  to the date of
                            exchange. The Exchange Debentures will bear interest
                            payable  quarterly  in arrears on March 15, June 15,
                            September   15  and   December   15  of  each  year,
                            commencing on the first such payment date  following
                            the date of  exchange.  Beginning  on  December  15,
                            2000,   at  the  Company's   option,   the  Exchange
                            Debentures will be redeemable,  in whole or in part,
                            at the  redemption  prices  set  forth  herein  plus
                            accrued   and   unpaid   interest.   Under   certain
                            circumstances involving a Change of Control, holders
                            will  have  the  right to  require  the  Company  to
                            purchase their Exchange  Debentures at a price equal
                            to 100% of the principal amount thereof plus accrued
                            interest.    The   Exchange   Debentures   will   be
                            convertible   into   Class   A   Common   Stock   on
                            substantially  the  same  terms  as the  Convertible
                            Exchangeable  Preferred  Stock is  convertible  into
                            Class A Common Stock.  The Exchange  Debentures will
                            be  subordinated  to all  Senior  Debt  (as  defined
                            herein).  As of June 30, 1997, on a pro forma basis,
                            after giving effect to the Debt Issuance (as defined
                            herein),  the sale of the  Convertible  Exchangeable
                            Preferred  Stock  offered  hereby and the use of the
                            estimated  net  proceeds  therefrom,  the  aggregate
                            amount of the Senior  Debt that  would  have  ranked
                            senior  in  right  of   payment   to  the   Exchange
                            Debentures  would  have  been   approximately   $1.6
                            billion.    See    "Description    of    Convertible
                            Exchangeable  Preferred Stock - Exchange Rights" and
                            "Description of Exchange Debentures."


NASDAQ NATIONAL MARKET 
LISTING. .................  The   Company   has   applied  for  listing  of  the
                            Convertible  Exchangeable  Preferred  Stock  on  the
                            Nasdaq  National  Market.  No assurance can be given
                            that such  application  will be approved or that the
                            Convertible  Exchangeable Preferred Stock will trade
                            on the Nasdaq National Market.



FEDERAL INCOME TAX 
CONSIDERATIONS............  There are certain federal income tax  considerations
                            associated   with  the   purchasing,   holding   and
                            disposing of the Convertible  Exchangeable Preferred
                            Stock or the Exchange Debentures, including the fact
                            that  the  exchange  of   Convertible   Exchangeable
                            Preferred  Stock for Exchange  Debentures  will be a
                            taxable  event.  See  "Certain  Federal  Income  Tax
                            Considerations."


                                      S-7
<PAGE>

 SINCLAIR BROADCAST GROUP, INC. - SUMMARY HISTORICAL AND PRO FORMA CONSOLIDATED
                                FINANCIAL DATA
                  (DOLLARS IN THOUSANDS, EXCEPT PER SHARE DATA)

     The  summary  historical  consolidated  financial  data for the years ended
December  31,  1992,  1993,  1994,  1995 and 1996  have  been  derived  from the
Company's audited Consolidated Financial Statements (the "Consolidated Financial
Statements"). The Consolidated Financial Statements for the years ended December
31,  1994,  1995 and 1996 are  incorporated  herein by  reference.  The  summary
historical  consolidated  financial  data for the six months ended June 30, 1996
and 1997 and as of June 30, 1996 and 1997 are  unaudited,  but in the opinion of
management,  such  financial  data have been  prepared  on the same basis as the
Consolidated  Financial Statements  incorporated herein by reference and include
all adjustments,  consisting only of normal recurring adjustments, necessary for
a fair presentation of the financial position and results of operations for that
period.  Results  for the six  months  ended  June  30,  1996  and  1997 are not
necessarily  indicative  of the results  for a full year.  The summary pro forma
statement  of  operations  data and other data of the  Company  reflect the 1996
Acquisitions  (as defined in  "Business of Sinclair -  Broadcasting  Acquisition
Strategy"), the Heritage Acquisition, and the application of the proceeds of the
issuance  of  $200,000,000  in  principal  amount  of the  Company's  9%  Senior
Subordinated Notes due 2007 (the "1997 Notes") issued on July 2, 1997 (the "Debt
Issuance"),  the issuance of $200,000,000 in liquidation amount of the Company's
11 5/8% High Yield Trust Offered  Preferred  Securities (the "HYTOPS") issued on
March 14, 1997 (the  "HYTOPS  Issuance"),  and the  Preferred  and Common  Stock
Offerings and the  application  of the proceeds  thereof as set forth in "Use of
Proceeds" as though they occurred at the beginning of the periods  presented and
are derived from the pro forma consolidated  financial statements of the Company
included  elsewhere in this Prospectus  Supplement.  See "Pro Forma Consolidated
Financial Information of Sinclair" included herein. The information below should
be read in conjunction with  "Management's  Discussion and Analysis of Financial
Condition and Results of Operations of Sinclair"  included herein and Sinclair's
Consolidated   Financial  Statements   incorporated  by  reference  herein,  and
Sinclair's Annual Report on Form 10-K (as amended) for the period ended December
31, 1996 and Sinclair's  Quarterly Report on Form 10-Q for the period ended June
30, 1997.  Included  elsewhere in this Prospectus  Supplement  under the heading
"Pro  Forma  Consolidated  Financial  Information  of  Sinclair"  are pro  forma
financial statements for the six months ended June 30, 1997.




<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
                                                                         YEARS ENDED DECEMBER 31,
                                                       ------------------------------------------------------------
                                                           1992         1993       1994(A)     1995(A)    1996(A)
                                                       ------------ ------------ ----------- ----------- ----------
<S>                                                    <C>          <C>          <C>         <C>         <C>
STATEMENT OF OPERATIONS DATA:
 Net broadcast revenues(c) ...........................  $ 61,081     $ 69,532     $118,611    $187,934     $346,459
 Barter revenues  ....................................     8,805        6,892       10,743      18,200       32,029
                                                        --------     --------     --------    --------    ---------
 Total revenues   ....................................    69,886       76,424      129,354     206,134      378,488
                                                        --------     --------     --------    --------    ---------
 Operating expenses, excluding depreciation and amor-
 tization, deferred compensation and special bonuses
 paid to executive officers   ........................    32,993       32,295       50,545      80,446      167,765
 Depreciation and amortization(d)   ..................    30,943       22,486       55,587      80,410      121,081
 Amortization of deferred compensation ...............         -            -            -           -          739
 Special bonuses paid to executive officers  .........         -       10,000        3,638           -            -
                                                        --------     --------     --------    --------    ---------
 Broadcast operating income   ........................     5,950       11,643       19,584      45,278       88,903
                                                        --------     --------     --------    --------    ---------
 Interest and amortization of debt discount expense       12,997       12,852       25,418      39,253       84,314
 Interest and other income ...........................     1,207        2,131        2,447       4,163        3,478
 Subsidiary trust minority interest expense(e)  ......         -            -            -           -            -
                                                        --------     --------     --------    --------    ---------
 Income (loss) before (provision) benefit for income
 taxes and extraordinary item ........................  $ (5,840)    $    922     $ (3,387)   $ 10,188     $  8,067
                                                        ========     ========     ========    ========    =========
 Net income (loss) available to common sharehold-
 ers                                                    $ (4,651)    $ (7,945)    $ (2,740)   $     76     $  1,131
                                                        ========     ========     ========    ========    =========
 Earnings (loss) per common share:
 Net income (loss) before extraordinary item .........  $  (0.16)    $      -     $  (0.09)   $   0.15     $   0.03
 Extraordinary item  .................................         -        (0.27)           -       (0.15)           -
                                                        --------     --------     --------    --------    ---------
 Net income (loss) per common share ..................  $  (0.16)    $  (0.27)    $  (0.09)   $      -     $   0.03
                                                        ========     ========     ========    ========    =========
 Weighted average shares outstanding (in thousands)       29,000       29,000       29,000      32,205       37,381
                                                        ========     ========     ========    ========    =========
OTHER DATA:
 Broadcast cash flow(f) ..............................  $ 28,019     $ 37,498     $ 67,519    $111,124     $189,216
 Broadcast cash flow margin(g)   .....................     45.9 %       53.9 %       56.9 %     59.1 %       54.6 %
 Adjusted EBITDA(h)  .................................  $ 26,466     $ 35,406     $ 64,547    $105,750     $180,272
 Adjusted EBITDA margin(g) ...........................     43.3 %       50.9 %       54.4 %     56.3 %       52.0 %
 After tax cash flow(i) ..............................  $  9,398     $ 17,950     $ 24,948    $ 51,288     $ 76,745
 After tax cash flow margin(g)   .....................     15.4 %       25.8 %       21.0 %     27.3 %       22.3 %
 Program contract payments ...........................  $ 10,427     $  8,723     $ 14,262    $ 19,938     $ 30,451
 Capital expenditures   ..............................       426          528        2,352       1,702       12,609
 Corporate overhead expense   ........................     1,553        2,092        2,972       5,374        8,944



<CAPTION>
                                                                                      DEBT AND
                                                                                  HYTOPS ISSUANCES,
                                                          SIX MONTHS ENDED      1996 ACQUISITIONS AND
                                                              JUNE 30,          HERITAGE ACQUISITION
                                                       ----------------------- -----------------------
                                                                                PRO FORMA YEAR ENDED
                                                        1996(A)     1997(A)      DECEMBER 31, 1996(B)
                                                       ---------- ------------ -----------------------
                                   (UNAUDITED)
<S>                                                    <C>        <C>          <C>
STATEMENT OF OPERATIONS DATA:
 Net broadcast revenues(c) ...........................   $117,339  $219,701          $ 532,357
 Barter revenues  ....................................      9,571    19,870             40,179
                                                        ---------  --------          ---------
 Total revenues   ....................................    126,910   239,571            572,536
                                                        ---------  --------          ---------
 Operating expenses, excluding depreciation and amor-
 tization, deferred compensation and special bonuses
 paid to executive officers   ........................     52,826   114,697            274,073
 Depreciation and amortization(d)   ..................     45,493    76,650            177,286
 Amortization of deferred compensation ...............        506       233                933
 Special bonuses paid to executive officers  .........          -         -                  -
                                                        ---------  --------          ---------
 Broadcast operating income   ........................     28,085    47,991            120,244
                                                        ---------  --------          ---------
 Interest and amortization of debt discount expense        27,646    51,993            163,207
 Interest and other income ...........................      3,172     1,087              7,753
 Subsidiary trust minority interest expense(e)  ......          -     7,007             23,250
                                                        ---------  --------          ---------
 Income (loss) before (provision) benefit for income
 taxes and extraordinary item ........................   $  3,611  $ (9,922)         $ (58,460)
                                                        =========  ========          =========
 Net income (loss) available to common sharehold-
 ers                                                     $  1,511  $ (5,822)         $ (40,553)
                                                        =========  ========          =========
 Earnings (loss) per common share:
 Net income (loss) before extraordinary item .........   $   0.04  $  (0.17)         $   (1.04)
 Extraordinary item  .................................          -         -                  -
                                                        ---------  --------          ---------
 Net income (loss) per common share ..................   $   0.04  $  (0.17)         $   (1.04)
                                                        =========  ========          =========
 Weighted average shares outstanding (in thousands)        34,750    34,746             39,058
                                                        =========  ========          =========
OTHER DATA:
 Broadcast cash flow(f) ..............................   $ 65,079  $105,600          $ 257,528
 Broadcast cash flow margin(g)   .....................     55.5 %     48.1 %             48.4 %
 Adjusted EBITDA(h)  ................................. $ 62,013    $ 98,615          $ 246,278
 Adjusted EBITDA margin(g) ...........................    52.8 %      44.9 %             46.3 %
 After tax cash flow(i) .............................. $ 30,441    $ 32,737          $  78,383
 After tax cash flow margin(g)   .....................    26.0 %      15.0 %             14.7 %
 Program contract payments ........................... $ 12,071    $ 26,259          $  52,185
 Capital expenditures   ..............................    2,114       8,286             18,512
 Corporate overhead expense   ........................    3,066       6,985             11,250



<CAPTION>
                                                                                             DEBT AND
                                                                  DEBT AND              HYTOPS ISSUANCES,
                                                             HYTOPS ISSUANCES,          1996 ACQUISITIONS,
                                                             1996 ACQUISITIONS,        HERITAGE ACQUISITION,
                                                            HERITAGE ACQUISITION       PREFERRED AND COMMON
                                                        AND PREFERRED STOCK OFFERING    STOCK OFFERINGS(M)
                                                       ------------------------------ ----------------------
                                                             PRO FORMA YEAR ENDED DECEMBER 31, 1996(B)
                                                       -----------------------------------------------------
<S>                                                    <C>                            <C>
STATEMENT OF OPERATIONS DATA:
 Net broadcast revenues(c) ...........................           $ 532,357                  $ 532,357
 Barter revenues  ....................................              40,179                     40,179
                                                                 ---------                  ---------
 Total revenues   ....................................             572,536                    572,536
                                                                 ---------                  ---------
 Operating expenses, excluding depreciation and amor-
 tization, deferred compensation and special bonuses
 paid to executive officers   ........................             274,073                    274,073
 Depreciation and amortization(d)   ..................             177,286                    177,286
 Amortization of deferred compensation ...............                 933                        933
 Special bonuses paid to executive officers  .........                   -                          -
                                                                 ---------                  ---------
 Broadcast operating income   ........................             120,244                    120,244
                                                                 ---------                  ---------
 Interest and amortization of debt discount expense                153,327                    143,771
 Interest and other income ...........................               7,753                      7,753
 Subsidiary trust minority interest expense(e)  ......              23,250                     23,250
                                                                 ---------                  ---------
 Income (loss) before (provision) benefit for income
 taxes and extraordinary item ........................           $ (48,580)                 $ (39,024)
                                                                 =========                  =========
 Net income (loss) available to common sharehold-
 ers                                                             $ (44,000)                 $ (37,892)
                                                                 =========                  =========
 Earnings (loss) per common share:
 Net income (loss) before extraordinary item .........           $   (1.13)                 $   (0.88)
 Extraordinary item  .................................                   -                          -
                                                                 ---------                  ---------
 Net income (loss) per common share ..................           $   (1.13)                 $   (0.88)
                                                                 =========                  =========
 Weighted average shares outstanding (in thousands)                 39,058                     43,058
                                                                 =========                  =========
OTHER DATA:
 Broadcast cash flow(f) ..............................           $ 257,528                  $ 257,528
 Broadcast cash flow margin(g)   .....................               48.4 %                     48.4 %
 Adjusted EBITDA(h)  .................................           $ 246,278                  $ 246,278
 Adjusted EBITDA margin(g) ...........................               46.3 %                     46.3 %
 After tax cash flow(i) ..............................           $  84,311                  $  90,044
 After tax cash flow margin(g)   .....................               15.8 %                     16.9 %
 Program contract payments ...........................           $  52,185                  $  52,185
 Capital expenditures   ..............................              18,512                     18,512
 Corporate overhead expense   ........................              11,250                     11,250
</TABLE>


                          (Continued on following page)


                                      S-8
<PAGE>


<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
                                                                       AS OF DECEMBER 31,                            AS OF    
                                               ------------------------------------------------------------------   JUNE 30,  
                                                   1992         1993        1994(A)      1995(A)        1996(A)      1997(A)  
                                                  ------       ------       -------      -------        -------    ---------  
                                                                                                                   (UNAUDITED)
<S>                                              <C>        <C>          <C>          <C>          <C>             <C>        
BALANCE SHEET AND CASH                                                                                                        
 FLOW DATA:                                                                                                                   
 Cash and cash equivalents  ..................   $ 1,823    $  18,036    $   2,446    $  112,450   $      2,341    $   2,740  
 Total assets   ..............................   140,366      242,917      399,328       605,272      1,707,297    1,762,505  
 Total debt(j)  ..............................   110,659      224,646      346,270       418,171      1,288,147    1,175,783  
 Company Obligated Mandatorily Re-                                                                                            
  deemable Security of Subsidiary                                                                                             
  Trust Holding Solely KDSM Senior                                                                                            
  Debentures(k) ..............................         -            -            -             -              -      200,000  
 Total stockholders' equity (deficit)   ......    (3,127)     (11,024)     (13,723)       96,374        237,253      232,638  
 Cash flows from operating activities(l).          5,235       11,230       20,781        55,909         68,970       42,483  
 Cash flows from investing activities(l)        . (1,051)       1,521     (249,781)     (119,243)    (1,011,897)    (112,429) 
 Cash flows from financing activities(l)        . (3,741)       3,462      213,410       173,338        832,818       70,345  

</TABLE>

     NOTES TO SUMMARY HISTORICAL AND PRO FORMA CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL DATA

(a)  The Company made  acquisitions in 1994, 1995, 1996 and the first six months
     of  1997  as  described  in the  footnotes  to the  Consolidated  Financial
     Statements  incorporated  herein by reference.  The statement of operations
     data  and  other  data  presented  for  periods   preceding  the  dates  of
     acquisitions  do not include amounts for these  acquisitions  and therefore
     are not comparable to subsequent periods.  Additionally, the years in which
     the specific  acquisitions  occurred may not be  comparable  to  subsequent
     periods depending on when during the year the acquisition occurred.


(b)  The pro forma  information  in this table  reflects the pro forma effect of
     the  Debt  Issuance,  the  HYTOPS  Issuance,  the  1996  Acquisitions,  the
     completion of the Heritage  Acquisition and the completion of the Preferred
     Stock Offering and the Common Stock Offering.  See "Pro Forma  Consolidated
     Financial  Information of Sinclair" included elsewhere herein. The Heritage
     Acquisition is subject to a number of conditions customary for acquisitions
     of broadcasting properties. See "- Recent Developments."


(c)  Net  broadcast  revenues  are defined as  broadcast  revenues net of agency
     commissions.


(d)  Depreciation  and  amortization  includes  amortization of program contract
     costs and net realizable value  adjustments,  depreciation and amortization
     of  property  and  equipment,   and  amortization  of  acquired  intangible
     broadcasting  assets and other assets  including  amortization  of deferred
     financing costs and costs related to excess syndicated programming.


(e)  Subsidiary trust minority interest expense  represents the distributions on
     the HYTOPS.


(f)  "Broadcast  cash  flow" is  defined  as  broadcast  operating  income  plus
     corporate  overhead  expense,  special bonuses paid to executive  officers,
     depreciation and amortization (including film amortization and amortization
     of deferred  compensation  and excess  syndicated  programming),  less cash
     payments for program contract rights.  Cash program payments represent cash
     payments  made  for  current  program   payables  and  do  not  necessarily
     correspond to program usage. Special bonuses paid to executive officers are
     considered non-recurring expenses. The Company has presented broadcast cash
     flow data,  which the Company  believes are comparable to the data provided
     by other companies in the industry,  because such data are commonly used as
     a measure of performance for broadcast companies.  However,  broadcast cash
     flow does not purport to represent cash provided by operating activities as
     reflected in the Company's consolidated  statements of cash flows, is not a
     measure  of  financial  performance  under  generally  accepted  accounting
     principles and should not be considered in isolation or as a substitute for
     measures of  performance  prepared in accordance  with  generally  accepted
     accounting principles.


(g)  "Broadcast  cash flow margin" is defined as broadcast  cash flow divided by
     net broadcast  revenues.  "Adjusted  EBITDA  margin" is defined as Adjusted
     EBITDA divided by net broadcast  revenues.  "After tax cash flow margin" is
     defined as after tax cash flow divided by net broadcast revenues.


(h)  "Adjusted EBITDA" is defined as broadcast cash flow less corporate overhead
     expense  and is a  commonly  used  measure  of  performance  for  broadcast
     companies.  Adjusted  EBITDA does not purport to represent cash provided by
     operating activities as reflected in the Company's consolidated  statements
     of cash flows,  is not a measure of financial  performance  under generally
     accepted accounting principles and should not be considered in isolation or
     as a substitute  for measures of  performance  prepared in accordance  with
     generally accepted accounting principles.


(i)  "After tax cash flow" is defined as net income (loss) before  extraordinary
     items plus  depreciation and  amortization of intangibles,  (excluding film
     amortization),  amortization  of  deferred  compensation,  amortization  of
     excess syndicated programming,  special bonuses paid to executive officers,
     and the deferred tax provision  (or minus the deferred tax benefit).  After
     tax cash flow is presented  here not as a measure of operating  results and
     does not purport to represent cash provided by operating activities.  After
     tax cash flow should not be considered in isolation or as a substitute  for
     measures of  performance  prepared in accordance  with  generally  accepted
     accounting principles. 

                                             (notes continued on following page)

                                      S-9
<PAGE>

(j)  "Total debt" is defined as long-term debt, net of unamortized discount, and
     capital lease obligations, including current portion thereof. In 1992 total
     debt  included  warrants  outstanding  which were  redeemable  outside  the
     control of the  Company.  The  warrants  were  purchased by the Company for
     $10,400 in 1993.  Total debt as of December 31, 1993  included  $100,000 in
     principal  amount of the 1993 Notes (as defined  herein),  the  proceeds of
     which were held in escrow to provide a source of financing for acquisitions
     that were subsequently  consummated in 1994 utilizing  borrowings under the
     Bank Credit  Agreement.  $100,000 of the 1993 Notes was  redeemed  from the
     escrow in the first quarter of 1994. Total debt does not include the HYTOPS
     or the Company's preferred stock.


(k)  Company  Obligated  Mandatorily  Redeemable  Security of  Subsidiary  Trust
     Holding  Solely  KDSM  Senior  Debentures   represents  $200,000  aggregate
     liquidation value of the HYTOPS.


(l)  These  items  are  financial  statement   disclosures  in  accordance  with
     generally  accepted  accounting  principles  and are also  presented in the
     Company's  consolidated  financial  statements  incorporated  by  reference
     herein.


(m)  There  can  be  no  assurance  that  the  Common  Stock  Offering  will  be
     consummated.  The  completion  of  the  Preferred  Stock  Offering  is  not
     conditioned upon the completion of the Common Stock Offering.


                                      S-10
<PAGE>

         HISTORICAL AND PRO FORMA RATIOS OF EARNINGS TO FIXED CHARGES
            AND OF EARNINGS TO FIXED CHARGES AND PREFERRED DIVIDENDS

     The Company's consolidated ratios of earnings to fixed charges and earnings
to fixed charges and preferred  dividends for each of the periods  indicated are
set forth below:


<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
                                                                                                     SIX MONTHS
                                                                                                        ENDED
                                                             YEARS ENDED DECEMBER 31,                 JUNE 30,
                                                     ---------------------------------------------   ---------------
                                                     1992     1993      1994      1995      1996     1996     1997  
                                                     ----     ----      ----      ----      ----     ----     ------
                                                                                                       (UNAUDITED)  
<S>                                                   <C>     <C>         <C>     <C>       <C>      <C>        <C> 
Ratio of earnings to fixed charges(a)  .........      -       1.1 x       -       1.3 x     1.1 x    1.1 x      -   
Ratio of earnings to fixed charges and preferred                                                                    
 stock dividends(a)  ...........................      -       1.1 x       -       1.3 x     1.1 x    1.1 x      -   
                                                      =       =====       =       =====     =====    =====      =   

</TABLE>

- ----------

(a) Earnings were inadequate to cover fixed charges and were inadequate to cover
    fixed charges and preferred stock dividends for the years ended December 31,
    1992 and  1994,  and for the six  months  ended  June 30,  1997.  Additional
    earnings of $5,840,  $3,387,  and $9,922  would have been  required to cover
    fixed charges and to cover fixed charges and  preferred  stock  dividends in
    the years ended  December  31, 1992 and 1994,  and the six months ended June
    30, 1997, respectively.



     Earnings  were  inadequate  to cover  fixed  charges for the pro forma year
ended  December  31,  1996  after  giving  effect  to (i) the  Debt  and  HYTOPS
Issuances,  1996 Acquisitions and Heritage  Acquisition,  (ii) such transactions
and consummation of the Preferred Stock Offering and (iii) such transactions and
consummation of the Preferred and Common Stock Offerings as if each  transaction
had  occurred on January 1, 1996;  additional  earnings of $58,460,  $48,580 and
$39,024,  respectively,  would have been required to cover fixed charges for the
pro forma year ended December 31, 1996.

     Earnings  were  inadequate  to cover  fixed  charges  for the pro forma six
months  ended  June 30,  1997  after  giving  effect to (i) the Debt and  HYTOPS
Issuances, and the Heritage Acquisition, (ii) such transactions and consummation
of the Preferred Stock Offering and (iii) such  transactions and consummation of
the Preferred and Common Stock Offerings as if each  transaction had occurred on
January  1,  1997;   additional  earnings  of  $22,063,   $17,123  and  $12,345,
respectively,  would have been required to cover fixed charges for the pro forma
six months ended June 30, 1997. 

                                      S-11
<PAGE>

                                USE OF PROCEEDS


     The  proceeds  to  the  Company  from  the  Preferred   Stock  Offering  as
contemplated  hereby (net of  underwriting  discounts  and  commissions  and the
estimated  expenses of the Offering) are  estimated to be  approximately  $145.1
million ($167.0 million, if the Underwriter's over-allotment option is exercised
in  full).  Concurrently  with  this  Offering,  the  Company  and  the  Selling
Stockholders are conducting the Common Stock Offering, the net proceeds of which
to the Company are estimated to be  approximately  $139.0 million at an offering
price of  $36.50  per  share  (such  offering  along  with the  Preferred  Stock
Offering,  the  "Offerings").  There can be no  assurance  that the Common Stock
Offering will be consummated.  The completion of the Preferred Stock Offering is
not conditioned  upon completion of the Common Stock Offering.  The Company will
not receive any of the net proceeds from the sale of Class A Common Stock by the
Selling  Stockholders,  in the  Common  Stock  Offering.  A  portion  of the net
proceeds  to the  Company  from the  Offerings  will be used to  repay  existing
borrowings  under the Company's  revolving credit facility under the Bank Credit
Agreement (as defined herein).  These borrowings,  which total $11 million as of
the date of this Prospectus Supplement and which were used for general corporate
purposes,  bear  interest  at the  rate of  8.5%  per  annum.  After  such  debt
repayment, the Company may make additional borrowings under the revolving credit
facility  until  December 31, 2004.  The  remainder of the net proceeds from the
Offerings  ($273.1  million if both of the  Offerings  are  completed and $134.1
million if only the Preferred  Stock Offering is completed)  will be retained by
the  Company for  general  corporate  purposes  including  funding the  Heritage
Acquisition,  which is  anticipated  to close in the first quarter of 1998,  and
other  acquisitions  if suitable  acquisitions  can be  identified on acceptable
terms.  The  Company  has  requested  that the  lenders  under  the Bank  Credit
Agreement  approve  an  amendment  that  would  recharacterize  $275  million of
indebtedness  from the Tranche A term loan under the Credit Agreement to amounts
owing under the revolving  credit facility.  If this amendment is approved,  the
Company will use all of the net proceeds of the Offerings to repay  indebtedness
under the Bank  Credit  Agreement,  all of which may be  reborrowed.  Borrowings
under  the  Tranche  A term loan  were  used to  finance  acquisitions,  and the
weighted average interest rate of the borrowings  thereunder was 6.73% as of the
date of this Prospectus Supplement.



                                      S-12
<PAGE>

                                 CAPITALIZATION


     The  following  table  sets  forth,  as of June 30,  1997,  (a) the  actual
capitalization of the Company,  (b) the pro forma  capitalization of the Company
as adjusted to reflect the consummation of the Debt Issuance consummated on July
2, 1997 and the Heritage Acquisition as if such transaction had occurred on June
30, 1997 (c) the pro forma  capitalization of the Company as adjusted to reflect
the items in (b) and the Preferred  Stock  Offering at an offering  price of $50
per share and the  application  of the estimated  net proceeds  therefrom as set
forth in "Use of Proceeds" as if such transactions had occurred on June 30, 1997
and (d) the pro forma  capitalization  of the Company as adjusted to reflect the
items noted in (b) and (c) and the Common Stock Offering at an offering price of
$36.50 per share and the application of the estimated net proceeds  therefrom as
set forth in "Use of Proceeds" as if such  transactions had occurred on June 30,
1997. The  information  set forth below should be read in conjunction  with "Pro
Forma Consolidated  Financial Information of Sinclair" located elsewhere in this
Prospectus  Supplement and the historical  Consolidated  Financial Statements of
the Company incorporated herein by reference.





<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
                                                                                     JUNE 30, 1997
                                                          --------------------------------------------------------------------
                                                                                 (DOLLARS IN THOUSANDS)

                                                                                        DEBT ISSUANCE,      DEBT ISSUANCE,
                                                                                           HERITAGE      HERITAGE ACQUISITION,
                                                                        DEBT ISSUANCE    ACQUISITION        PREFERRED AND
                                                                        AND HERITAGE    AND PREFERRED           COMMON
                                                             ACTUAL      ACQUISITION    STOCK OFFERING    STOCK OFFERINGS(A)
                                                          ------------ --------------- ---------------- ----------------------
<S>                                                       <C>          <C>             <C>              <C>
Cash and cash equivalents  .............................. $   2,740      $   35,740      $   35,740          $   35,740
                                                          ==========     ==========      ==========          ==========
Current portion of long-term debt   ..................... $  66,881      $   66,881      $   66,881          $   66,881
                                                          ==========     ==========      ==========          ==========
Long-term debt:
 Commercial bank financing    ........................... $ 697,000      $1,104,500      $  959,425          $  820,430
 Notes and capital leases payable to affiliates .........    11,872          11,872          11,872              11,872
 Capital leases   .......................................        30              30              30                  30
 Senior subordinated notes ..............................   400,000         600,000         600,000             600,000
                                                          ----------     ----------      ----------          ----------
                                                          1,108,902       1,716,402       1,571,327           1,432,332
                                                          ----------     ----------      ----------          ----------
Company Obligated Mandatorily Redeemable Security
 of Subsidiary Trust Holding Solely KDSM Senior
 Debentures .............................................   200,000         200,000         200,000             200,000
                                                          ----------     ----------      ----------          ----------
Stockholders' equity (deficit):
 Series B Preferred  Stock,  $.01 par value,  10,000,000  shares  authorized and
  1,106,608 shares issued and
  outstanding  ..........................................        11              11              11                  11
 Series D Convertible Exchangeable Preferred Stock,
v $.01 par  alue, 3,450,000 shares authorized and
  3,000,000 shares issued and outstanding post Pre-
  ferred Stock Offering .................................        --              --              30                  30
 Class A Common Stock, $.01 par value, 100,000,000
  shares authorized and 7,100,188 shares issued and
  outstanding; 11,100,188 shares issued and outstand-
  ing, post Common Stock Offering .......................        71              71              71                 111
 Class B Common Stock, $.01 par value, 35,000,000
  shares authorized and 27,591,581 shares issued and
  outstanding  ..........................................       277             277             277                 277
 Additional paid-in capital   ...........................   234,812         234,812         379,857             518,812
 Additional paid-in capital - deferred compensation .....      (896)           (896)           (896)               (896)
 Additional paid-in capital - equity put options   ......    23,117          23,117          23,117              23,117
 Accumulated deficit    .................................   (24,754)        (24,754)        (24,754)            (24,754)
                                                          ----------     ----------      ----------          ----------
  Total stockholders' equity  ...........................   232,638         232,638         377,713             516,708
                                                          ----------     ----------      ----------          ----------
   Total capitalization ................................. $1,541,540     $2,149,040      $2,149,040          $2,149,040
                                                          ==========     ==========      ==========          ==========
</TABLE>


- ----------

(a)  There  can  be  no  assurance  that  the  Common  Stock  Offering  will  be
     consummated.  The  completion  of  the  Preferred  Stock  Offering  is  not
     conditioned upon the completion of the Common Stock Offering.


                                      S-13
<PAGE>

            PRO FORMA CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL INFORMATION OF SINCLAIR


     The following Pro Forma  Consolidated  Financial Data include the unaudited
pro  forma  consolidated  balance  sheet as of June 30,  1997  (the  "Pro  Forma
Consolidated Balance Sheet") and the unaudited pro forma consolidated  statement
of operations for the year ended December 31, 1996 and the six months ended June
30, 1997 (the "Pro Forma Consolidated  Statement of Operations").  The unaudited
Pro Forma  Consolidated  Balance  Sheet is  adjusted  to give effect to the Debt
Issuance, the Heritage Acquisition,  the Preferred Stock Offering and the Common
Stock Offering as if they occurred on June 30, 1997 and assuming  application of
the proceeds of the Preferred  Stock  Offering and the Common Stock  Offering as
set forth in "Use of  Proceeds"  above.  The  unaudited  Pro Forma  Consolidated
Statement of Operations for the year ended December 31, 1996 is adjusted to give
effect to the 1996  Acquisitions,  the HYTOPS Issuance,  the Debt Issuance,  the
Heritage Acquisition, the Preferred Stock Offering and the Common Stock Offering
as if each occurred at the beginning of such period and assuming  application of
the proceeds of the Preferred  Stock  Offering and the Common Stock  Offering as
set forth in "Use of Proceeds." The unaudited Pro Forma  Consolidated  Statement
of Operations  for the six months ended June 30, 1997 is adjusted to give effect
to the HYTOPS Issuance,  the Debt Issuance,  the Heritage  Acquisition,  and the
Preferred  Stock  Offering and the Common Stock  Offering as if each occurred at
the  beginning  of such period and assuming  application  of the proceeds of the
Preferred  Stock  Offering and the Common Stock Offering as set forth in "Use of
Proceeds." The pro forma  adjustments  are based upon available  information and
certain  assumptions  that the Company  believes are  reasonable.  The Pro Forma
Consolidated  Financial  Data should be read in  conjunction  with the Company's
Consolidated Financial Statements as of and for the year ended December 31, 1996
and related  notes  thereto,  the  Company's  unaudited  consolidated  financial
statements for the six months ended June 30, 1997 and related notes thereto, the
historical  financial data of Flint T.V., Inc., the historical financial data of
Superior  Communications,  Inc., the historical financial data of KSMO and WSTR,
the  historical  financial  data  of  River  City  Broadcasting,  L.P.  and  the
historical  financial  data of  Heritage  Media  Services,  Inc. -  Broadcasting
Segment,  all of which have been filed  with the  Commission  as part of (i) the
Company's  Annual  Report on Form 10-K for the year ended  December 31, 1996 (as
amended), together with the report of Arthur Andersen LLP, independent certified
public  accountants;  (ii) the Company's  Quarterly  Report on Form 10-Q for the
quarter ended June 30, 1997; or (iii) the Company's  Current Reports on Form 8-K
and Form 8-K/A filed May 10,  1996,  May 13, 1996,  May 17, 1996,  May 29, 1996,
August  30,  1996,  September  5, 1996 and  August  26,  1997,  each of which is
incorporated  by reference into this  Prospectus  Supplement.  The unaudited Pro
Forma Consolidated Financial Data do not purport to represent what the Company's
results of operations or financial position would have been had any of the above
events  occurred on the dates  specified or to project the Company's  results of
operations or financial position for or at any future period or date. 


                                      S-14
<PAGE>

                        SINCLAIR BROADCAST GROUP, INC.
                      PRO FORMA CONSOLIDATED BALANCE SHEET
                              AS OF JUNE 30, 1997
                            (DOLLARS IN THOUSANDS)
                                  (UNAUDITED)




<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
                                                                                                                     DEBT
                                                                                                                   ISSUANCE
                                                                 CONSOLIDATED       DEBT            HERITAGE       AND HERITAGE
                                                                  HISTORICAL     ISSUANCE(A)     ACQUISITION(B)    ACQUISITION
                                                                --------------  --------------  ----------------  ------------
                            ASSETS                                                                                            
<S>                                                              <C>             <C>              <C>              <C>        
CURRENT ASSETS:                                                                                                               
 Cash and cash equivalents ....................................  $    2,740      $ 33,000(e)                       $   35,740 
 Accounts receivable, net of allowance for doubtful accounts        102,093                                           102,093 
 Current portion of program contract costs   ..................      34,768                       $       926          35,694 
 Prepaid expenses and other current assets   ..................       4,054                                             4,054 
 Deferred barter costs  .......................................       4,267                             2,218           6,485 
 Deferred tax asset  ..........................................       8,188                                             8,188 
                                                                 ----------      --------         -----------      ---------- 
   Total current assets .......................................     156,110        33,000               3,144         192,254 
PROGRAM CONTRACT COSTS, less current portion ..................      30,778                               712          31,490 
LOANS TO OFFICERS AND AFFILIATES ..............................      11,241                                            11,241 
PROPERTY AND EQUIPMENT, net   .................................     156,681                            22,022         178,703 
NON-COMPETE AND CONSULTING AGREEMENTS, net   ..................       2,250                                             2,250 
OTHER ASSETS   ................................................      71,970         4,500(f)                           76,470 
ACQUIRED INTANGIBLE BROADCASTING ASSETS, net ..................   1,333,475                           545,969       1,879,444 
                                                                 ----------      --------         -----------      ---------- 
   Total Assets   .............................................  $1,762,505      $ 37,500         $   571,847      $2,371,852 
                                                                 ==========      ========         ===========      ========== 
                         LIABILITIES AND                                                                                      
                           STOCKHOLDERS' EQUITY                                                                               
CURRENT LIABILITIES:                                                                                                          
 Accounts payable .............................................  $    5,310                                        $    5,310 
 Accrued liabilities ..........................................      39,023                                            39,023 
 Current portion of long-term liabilities-                                                                                    
  Notes payable and commercial bank financing   ...............      65,500                                            65,500 
  Capital leases payable   ....................................          11                                                11 
  Notes and capital leases payable to affiliates   ............       1,370                                             1,370 
  Program contracts payable   .................................      49,766                       $     1,096          50,862 
 Deferred barter revenues  ....................................       4,458                                             4,458 
                                                                 ----------      --------         -----------      ---------- 
   Total current liabilities  .................................     165,438                             1,096         166,534 
LONG-TERM LIABILITIES:                                                                                                        
  Notes payable and commercial bank financing   ...............   1,097,000      $ 37,500(g)          570,000(h)    1,704,500 
  Capital leases payable   ....................................          30                                                30 
  Notes and capital leases payable to affiliates   ............      11,872                                            11,872 
  Program contracts payable   .................................      46,670                               751          47,421 
  Other long-term liabilities .................................       4,960                                             4,960 
                                                                 ----------      --------         -----------      ---------- 
   Total liabilities ..........................................   1,325,970        37,500             571,847       1,935,317 
                                                                 ----------      --------         -----------      ---------- 
MINORITY INTEREST IN CONSOLIDATED SUBSIDIARIES  ...............       3,897                                             3,897 
                                                                 ----------      --------         -----------      ---------- 
COMPANY OBLIGATED MANDATORILY REDEEMABLE SE-                                                                                  
 CURITY OF SUBSIDIARY TRUST HOLDING SOLELY KDSM                                                                               
 SENIOR DEBENTURES   ..........................................     200,000                                           200,000 
                                                                 ----------      --------         -----------      ---------- 
COMMITMENTS AND CONTINGENCIES                                                                                                 
STOCKHOLDERS' EQUITY:                                                                                                         
  Series B Preferred Stock    .................................          11                                                11 
  Series D Convertible Exchangeable Preferred Stock   .........           -                                                 - 
  Class A Common Stock  .......................................          71                                                71 
  Class B Common Stock  .......................................         277                                               277 
  Additional paid-in capital  .................................     234,812                                           234,812 
  Additional paid-in capital - deferred compensation  .........        (896)                                            (896) 
  Additional paid-in capital - equity put options  ............      23,117                                            23,117 
  Accumulated deficit   .......................................     (24,754)                                         (24,754) 
                                                                 ----------      --------         -----------      ---------- 
   Total stockholders' equity .................................     232,638                                           232,638 
                                                                 ----------      --------         -----------      ---------- 
   Total Liabilities and Stockholders' Equity   ...............  $1,762,505     $  37,500         $   571,847      $2,371,852 
                                                                 ==========      ========         ===========      ========== 
</TABLE>

                                                   (Continued on following page)

                                      S-15
<PAGE>

                        SINCLAIR BROADCAST GROUP, INC.
                      PRO FORMA CONSOLIDATED BALANCE SHEET
                              AS OF JUNE 30, 1997
                            (DOLLARS IN THOUSANDS)
                                  (UNAUDITED)




<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
                                      
                                                              DEBT ISSUANCE      PREFERRED   
                                                               AND HERITAGE        STOCK     
                                                               ACQUISITION      OFFERING(C)  
                                                              --------------   ------------  
<S>                                                           <C>              <C>           
                         ASSETS                                                              
CURRENT ASSETS:                                                                              
 Cash and cash equivalents   ...........................      $   35,740                     
 Accounts receivable, net of allowance for doubtful ac-                                      
  counts                                                         102,093                     
 Current portion of program contract costs  ............          35,694                     
 Prepaid expenses and other current assets  ............           4,054                     
 Deferred barter costs .................................           6,485                     
 Deferred tax asset ....................................           8,188               --    
                                                              ----------       ----------    
   Total current assets   ..............................         192,254                     
PROGRAM CONTRACT COSTS, less current portion                      31,490                     
LOANS TO OFFICERS AND AFFILIATES   .....................          11,241                     
PROPERTY AND EQUIPMENT, net  ...........................         178,703                     
NON-COMPETE AND CONSULTING AGREE-                                                            
 MENTS, net                                                        2,250                     
OTHER ASSETS  ..........................................          76,470                     
ACQUIRED INTANGIBLE BROADCASTING AS-                                                         
 SETS, net                                                     1,879,444               --    
                                                              ----------       ----------    
   Total Assets  .......................................      $2,371,852       $             
                                                              ==========       ==========    
                          LIABILITIES AND                                                    
                      STOCKHOLDERS' EQUITY                                                   
CURRENT LIABILITIES:                                                                         
 Accounts payable   ....................................      $    5,310                     
 Accrued liabilities   .................................          39,023                     
 Current portion of long-term liabilities-                                                   
  Notes payable and commercial bank financing  .........          65,500                     
  Capital leases payable  ..............................              11                     
  Notes and capital leases payable to affiliates  ......           1,370                     
  Program contracts payable  ...........................          50,862                     
 Deferred barter revenues ..............................           4,458               --    
                                                              ----------       ----------    
   Total current liabilities ...........................         166,534                     
LONG-TERM LIABILITIES:                                                                       
  Notes payable and commercial bank financing  .........       1,704,500       $ (145,075)   
  Capital leases payable  ..............................              30                     
  Notes and capital leases payable to affiliates  ......          11,872                     
  Program contracts payable  ...........................          47,421                     
  Other long-term liabilities   ........................           4,960                     
                                                              ----------                     
   Total liabilities   .................................       1,935,317         (145,075)   
                                                              ----------       ----------    
MINORITY INTEREST IN CONSOLIDATED SUB-                                                       
 SIDIARIES                                                         3,897                     
                                                              ----------                     
COMPANY OBLIGATED MANDATORILY RE-                                                            
 DEEMABLE SECURITY OF SUBSIDIARY                                                             
 TRUST HOLDING SOLELY KDSM SENIOR DE-                                                        
 BENTURES                                                        200,000                     
                                                              ----------                     
COMMITMENTS AND CONTINGENCIES                                                                
STOCKHOLDERS' EQUITY:                                                                        
  Series B Preferred Stock   ...........................              11                     
  Series D Convertible Exchangeable Preferred Stock                    -               30    
  Class A Common Stock    ..............................              71                     
  Class B Common Stock    ..............................             277                     
  Additional paid-in capital ...........................         234,812          145,045    
  Additional paid-in capital - deferred compensation.               (896)                    
  Additional paid-in capital - equity put options ......          23,117                     
  Accumulated deficit  .................................         (24,754)                    
                                                              ----------                     
   Total stockholders' equity   ........................         232,638          145,075    
                                                              ----------       ----------    
   Total Liabilities and Stockholders' Equity  .........      $2,371,852       $       --    
                                                              ==========       ==========    



<CAPTION>
                                                                                               DEBT
                                                                DEBT                        ISSUANCE,
                                                             ISSUANCE,                       HERITAGE
                                                              HERITAGE                     ACQUISITION,
                                                          ACQUISITION, AND     COMMON      PREFERRED AND
                                                          PREFERRED STOCK       STOCK      COMMON STOCK
                                                              OFFERING       OFFERING(D)   OFFERINGS(D)
                                                         ------------------ ------------- --------------
<S>                                                      <C>                <C>           <C>
                          ASSETS
CURRENT ASSETS:
 Cash and cash equivalents   ...........................    $    35,740                    $    35,740
 Accounts receivable, net of allowance for doubtful ac-
  counts                                                        102,093                        102,093
 Current portion of program contract costs  ............         35,694                         35,694
 Prepaid expenses and other current assets  ............          4,054                          4,054
 Deferred barter costs .................................          6,485                          6,485
 Deferred tax asset ....................................          8,188                          8,188
                                                            -----------                    -----------
   Total current assets   ..............................        192,254                        192,254
PROGRAM CONTRACT COSTS, less current portion                     31,490                         31,490
LOANS TO OFFICERS AND AFFILIATES   .....................         11,241                         11,241
PROPERTY AND EQUIPMENT, net  ...........................        178,703                        178,703
NON-COMPETE AND CONSULTING AGREE-
 MENTS, net                                                       2,250                          2,250
OTHER ASSETS  ..........................................         76,470                         76,470
ACQUIRED INTANGIBLE BROADCASTING AS-
 SETS, net                                                    1,879,444               -      1,879,444
                                                            -----------      ----------    -----------
   Total Assets  .......................................    $ 2,371,852      $             $ 2,371,852
                                                            ===========      ==========    ===========
                          LIABILITIES AND
                      STOCKHOLDERS' EQUITY
CURRENT LIABILITIES:
 Accounts payable   ....................................    $     5,310                    $     5,310
 Accrued liabilities   .................................         39,023                         39,023
 Current portion of long-term liabilities-
  Notes payable and commercial bank financing  .........         65,500                         65,500
  Capital leases payable  ..............................             11                             11
  Notes and capital leases payable to affiliates  ......          1,370                          1,370
  Program contracts payable  ...........................         50,862                         50,862
 Deferred barter revenues ..............................          4,458               -          4,458
                                                            -----------      ----------    -----------
   Total current liabilities ...........................        166,534                        166,534
LONG-TERM LIABILITIES:
  Notes payable and commercial bank financing  .........      1,559,425      $ (138,995)     1,420,430
  Capital leases payable  ..............................             30                             30
  Notes and capital leases payable to affiliates  ......         11,872                         11,872
  Program contracts payable  ...........................         47,421                         47,421
  Other long-term liabilities   ........................          4,960                          4,960
                                                            -----------                    -----------
   Total liabilities   .................................      1,790,242        (138,995)     1,651,247
                                                            -----------      ----------    -----------
MINORITY INTEREST IN CONSOLIDATED SUB-
 SIDIARIES                                                        3,897                          3,897
                                                            -----------                    -----------
COMPANY OBLIGATED MANDATORILY RE-
 DEEMABLE SECURITY OF SUBSIDIARY
 TRUST HOLDING SOLELY KDSM SENIOR DE-
 BENTURES                                                       200,000                        200,000
                                                            -----------                    -----------
COMMITMENTS AND CONTINGENCIES
STOCKHOLDERS' EQUITY:
  Series B Preferred Stock   ...........................             11                             11
  Series D Convertible Exchangeable Preferred Stock                  30                             30
  Class A Common Stock    ..............................             71              40            111
  Class B Common Stock    ..............................            277                            277
  Additional paid-in capital ...........................        379,857         138,955        518,812
  Additional paid-in capital - deferred compensation.              (896)                          (896)
  Additional paid-in capital - equity put options ......         23,117                         23,117
  Accumulated deficit  .................................        (24,754)                       (24,754)
                                                            -----------                    -----------
   Total stockholders' equity   ........................        377,713         138,995        516,708
                                                            -----------      ----------    -----------
   Total Liabilities and Stockholders' Equity  .........    $ 2,371,852      $        -    $ 2,371,852
                                                            ===========      ==========    ===========
</TABLE>




                                      S-16
<PAGE>

                 NOTES TO PRO FORMA CONSOLIDATED BALANCE SHEET

(a) To reflect the proceeds of the Debt  Issuance  consummated  on July 2, 1997,
    net of  $4,500 of  underwriting  discounts  and  commissions  and  estimated
    expenses and the application of the proceeds therefrom.

(b) The Heritage Acquisition column reflects the assets and liabilities acquired
    in  connection  with the  $630,000  purchase  of  Heritage  less the $60,000
    divestiture  of the  Heritage  television  station  KOKH in  Oklahoma  City,
    Oklahoma which is required pursuant to the Heritage  Acquisition  Agreements
    and with  respect to which the Company has entered  into a letter of intent.
    The Heritage  Acquisition is subject to a number of conditions customary for
    acquisitions  of  broadcasting  properties.  Total acquired  intangibles are
    calculated as follows:





<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
                                                                                        HERITAGE
                                                              HERITAGE      KOKH       ACQUISITION
                                                             ----------   ----------   ------------
<S>                                                           <C>        <C>            <C>     
Purchase Price ..........................................                               $630,000
 Add:
   Liabilities acquired-
   Current portion of program contracts payable .........     $ 1,552    $  (456)          1,096
   Long-term portion of program contracts payable  ......         860       (109)            751
 Less:
   Assets acquired-
   Current portion of program contract costs ............       1,603       (677)            926
   Deferred barter costs   ..............................       2,496       (278)          2,218
   Program contract costs, less current portion .........       1,266       (554)            712
   Property and equipment  ..............................      27,524     (5,502)         22,022
   Sale of KOKH   .......................................                                 60,000
                                                                                        --------
   Acquired intangibles .................................                               $545,969
                                                                                        ======== 
</TABLE>


(c) To reflect  the  proceeds of the  Preferred  Stock  Offering  (at an assumed
    offering price of $50 per share),  net of $4,925 of  underwriting  discounts
    and commissions  and estimated  expenses and the application of the proceeds
    therefrom  as set  forth in "Use of  Proceeds"  and  assuming  the  Heritage
    Acquisition has been consummated.

(d) To reflect the proceeds of the Common Stock  Offering (at an offering  price
    of  $36.50  per  share),  net  of  $7,005  of  underwriting   discounts  and
    commissions  and  estimated  expenses  and the  application  of the proceeds
    therefrom  as set  forth in "Use of  Proceeds"  and  assuming  the  Heritage
    Acquisition has been consummated.  There can be no assurance that the Common
    Stock Offering will be  consummated.  The completion of the Preferred  Stock
    Offering  is  not  conditioned  upon  the  completion  of the  Common  Stock
    Offering.


(e) To record the increase in cash and cash  equivalents  resulting from the net
    proceeds of the Debt  Issuance  after giving  effect to the repayment of the
    revolving credit facility under the Bank Credit Agreement as follows:




<TABLE>
<S>                                                     <C>          
          Offering proceeds.......................      $ 200,000    
          Underwriting discounts,  commissions and         (4,500)   
          estimated    expenses    Repayment    of                   
          revolving credit facility under the Bank       (162,500)   
          Credit Agreement .......................      ---------    
                                                        $  33,000    
          Pro forma adjustment ...................      =========    
                                                                     
</TABLE>

(f)  To record underwriting  discounts and commissions and estimated expenses of
     $4,500.

(g)  To reflect the increase in  indebtedness  resulting  from the Debt Issuance
     after giving effect to the repayment of the revolving credit facility under
     the Bank Credit Agreement as follows:




<TABLE>
<S>                                                     <C>         
          Indebtedness               incurred           $  200,000  
          ....................................                      
          Repayment   of   revolving   credit             (162,500) 
          facility   under  the  Bank  Credit           ----------  
          Agreement                                     $   37,500  
          Pro forma adjustment ...............          ==========  
                                                                    
</TABLE>

(h)  To reflect the incurrence of $570,000 of bank financing in connection  with
     the Heritage Acquisition.

                                      S-17
<PAGE>

                        SINCLAIR BROADCAST GROUP, INC.
                 PRO FORMA CONSOLIDATED STATEMENT OF OPERATIONS
                     FOR THE YEAR ENDED DECEMBER 31, 1996
                 (DOLLARS IN THOUSANDS, EXCEPT PER SHARE DATA)
                                  (UNAUDITED)


<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
                                                                                             SUPERIOR                   
                                                              CONSOLIDATED     FLINT      COMMUNICATIONS                
                                                               HISTORICAL   TV, INC.(A)   GROUP, INC.(B)   KSMO(C)      
                                                             -------------- ------------ ---------------- ----------    
<S>                                                          <C>              <C>            <C>          <C>           
REVENUES:                                                                                                               
 Station broadcast revenues, net of agency commis-                                                                      
 sions  .............................................        $  346,459       $1,012         $4,431       $ 7,694       
 Revenues realized from station barter arrange-                                                                         
 ments  .............................................            32,029                                     2,321       
                                                             ----------                                   --------      
  Total revenues ....................................           378,488        1,012          4,431        10,015       
                                                             ----------       -------        ------       --------      
OPERATING EXPENSES:                                                                                                     
 Program and production   ...........................            66,652          101            539         1,550       
 Selling, general and administrative  ...............            75,924          345          2,002         2,194       
 Expenses realized from barter arrangements .........            25,189                                     2,276       
 Amortization of program contract costs and net                                                                         
   realizable value adjustments   .....................          47,797          125            736           601       
 Amortization of deferred compensation   ............               739                                                 
 Depreciation and amortization of property and                                                                          
   equipment    .......................................          11,711            4            373           374       
 Amortization of acquired intangible broadcasting                                                                       
   assets, non-compete and consulting agreements                                                                        
  and other assets   .................................           58,530                         529                     
 Amortization of excess syndicated programming             .      3,043                                                 
                                                             ----------                                                 
     Total operating expenses   ......................          289,585          575          4,179         6,995       
                                                             ----------       -------        ------       --------      
   Broadcast operating income (loss)  ................           88,903          437            252         3,020       
                                                             ----------       -------        ------       --------      
OTHER INCOME (EXPENSE):                                                                                                 
 Interest and amortization of debt discount expense             (84,314)                       (457)         (823)      
 Interest income ....................................             3,136                                                 
 Subsidiary trust minority interest expense .........                                                                   
 Other income (expense)   ...........................               342           19              4             7       
                                                             ----------       -------        ------       --------      
  Income (loss) before provision (benefit) for                                                                          
  income taxes   ....................................             8,067          456           (201)        2,204       
PROVISION (BENEFIT) FOR INCOME                                                                                          
 TAXES  .............................................             6,936                                                 
                                                             ----------                                                 
NET INCOME (LOSS)   .................................        $    1,131       $  456         $ (201)      $ 2,204       
                                                             ==========       =======        ======       ========      
NET INCOME (LOSS) AVAILABLE TO COM-                                                                                     
 MON STOCKHOLDERS                                            $    1,131                                                 
                                                             ==========                                                 
NET INCOME (LOSS) PER COMMON AND                                                                                        
 COMMON EQUIVALENT SHARE  ...........................        $     0.03                                                 
                                                             ==========                                                 
WEIGHTED AVERAGE COMMON AND COM-                                                                                        
 MON EQUIVALENT SHARES OUTSTANDING                               37,381                                                 
                                                             ==========                                                 
                                                                                                                        

</TABLE>
<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
                                                                             RIVER CITY(E)                         1996      
                                                                        --------------------------              ACQUISITION  
                                                             WSTR(D)    RIVER CITY      WSYX         WYZZ(F)     ADJUSTMENTS 
                                                            ----------- ----------- ------------   --------- --------------- 
<S>                                                          <C>          <C>          <C>            <C>        <C>         
REVENUES:                                                                                                                    
 Station broadcast revenues, net of agency commis-                                                                           
   sions  ...........................................      $ 7,488      $  86,869    $ (10,783)     $ 1,838                  
 Revenues realized from station barter arrange-                                                                              
   ments  ...........................................        1,715       --------    ----------     -------     ----------   
     Total revenues .................................        9,203         86,869      (10,783)       1,838     ----------   
OPERATING EXPENSES:                                                                                                          
 Program and production   ...........................          961         10,001         (736)         214                  
 Selling, general and administrative  ...............        2,173         39,786       (3,950)         702    $    (3,577)(h)
 Expenses realized from barter arrangements .........        1,715                                                           
 Amortization of program contract costs and net                                                                              
 realizable value adjustments   .....................        1,011          9,721         (458)         123                  
 Amortization of deferred compensation   ............                                                                  194 (i)
 Depreciation and amortization of property and                                                                               
   equipment  .......................................          284          6,294       (1,174)           6           (943)(j)
 Amortization of acquired intangible broadcasting                                                                            
   assets, non-compete and consulting agreements                                                                             
 and other assets   .................................           39         14,041       (3,599)           3          4,034 (k)
 Amortization of excess syndicated programming ......
                                                                   
     Total operating expenses  .......................        6,183         79,843       (9,917)       1,048           (292)  
                                                          --------      ----------   ----------     -------     ------------ 
  Broadcast operating income (loss)  .................        3,020          7,026         (866)         790            292   
                                                          --------      ----------   ----------     -------     ------------ 
OTHER INCOME (EXPENSE):                                                                                                      
 Interest and amortization of debt discount expense         (1,127)       (12,352)                                 (17,409)(l)
 Interest income .....................................          15            195                                   (1,636)(m)
 Subsidiary trust minority interest expense ..........                                                                        
 Other income (expense)   ............................                       (149)          (8)                              
                                                          --------      ----------   ----------     -------     ------------ 
  Income (loss) before provision (benefit) for                                                                               
  income taxes   .....................................       1,908         (5,280)        (874)         790        (18,753)  

PROVISION (BENEFIT) FOR INCOME                                                                                               
 TAXES  ..............................................     --------      ----------   ----------     -------         (7,900)(n)
                                                                                                                             
NET INCOME (LOSS)   ..................................     $ 1,908      $  (5,280)   $    (874)     $   790    $   (10,853)  
                                                          ========      ==========   ==========     =======     ============ 
NET INCOME (LOSS) AVAILABLE TO COM-                                                                                          
 MON STOCKHOLDERS  ...................................     

NET INCOME (LOSS) PER COMMON AND                                                                                             
 COMMON EQUIVALENT SHARE  ............................                                                                       

WEIGHTED AVERAGE COMMON AND COM-                                                                                             
 MON EQUIVALENT SHARES OUTSTANDING
</TABLE>

<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
                                                                                              DEBT ISSUANCE,
                                                              HYTOPS             DEBT          HYTOPS ISSUANCE
                                                             ISSUANCE         ISSUANCE      AND 1996 ACQUISITIONS
                                                        ----------------   -------------  ------------------------
<S>                                                         <C>               <C>              <C>           
REVENUES:                                                                                                    
 Station broadcast revenues, net of agency commis-                                                           
 sions                                                                                        $    445,008   
 Revenues realized from station barter arrange-                                                              
 ments                                                                                              36,065   
                                                            -----------       ---------       ------------   
  Total revenues ....................................                                              481,073   
                                                            -----------       ---------       ------------   
OPERATING EXPENSES:                                                                                          
 Program and production   ...........................                                               79,282   
 Selling, general and administrative  ...............                                              115,599   
 Expenses realized from barter arrangements .........                                               29,180   
 Amortization of program contract costs and net                                                              
 realizable value adjustments   .....................                                               59,656   
 Amortization of deferred compensation   ............                                                  933   
 Depreciation and amortization of property and                                                               
 equipment    .......................................                                               16,929   
 Amortization of acquired intangible broadcasting                                                            
 assets, non-compete and consulting agreements                                                               
 and other assets   .................................       $       500 (p)   $     450 (s)         74,527   
 Amortization of excess syndicated programming           .                                           3,043   
                                                            -----------       ---------       ------------   
  Total operating expenses   ........................               500             450            379,149   
                                                            -----------       ---------       ------------   
  Broadcast operating income (loss)   ...............              (500)           (450)           101,924   
                                                            -----------       ---------       ------------   
OTHER INCOME (EXPENSE):                                                                                      
 Interest and amortization of debt discount expense              11,820 (q)     (18,000)(t)       (122,662)  
 Interest income ....................................                                                1,710   
 Subsidiary trust minority interest expense .........            23,250)(r)                        (23,250)  
 Other income (expense)   ...........................                                                  215   
                                                                                              ------------   
  Income (loss) before provision (benefit) for                                                               
  income taxes   ....................................            11,930)        (18,450)           (42,063)  
PROVISION (BENEFIT) FOR INCOME                                                                               
 TAXES  .............................................            (4,772)(n)      (7,380)(n)        (13,116)  
                                                            -----------       ---------       ------------   
NET INCOME (LOSS)   .................................       $    (7,158)      $ (11,070)      $    (28,947)  
                                                            -----------       ---------       ------------   
NET INCOME (LOSS) AVAILABLE TO COMMON                                                                        
 STOCKHOLDERS .......................................                                                        
                                                                                                             
NET INCOME (LOSS) PER COMMON AND                                                                             
 COMMON EQUIVALENT SHARE  ...........................                                                        
                                                                                                             
WEIGHTED AVERAGE COMMON AND COMMON                                                                           
 EQUIVALENT SHARES OUTSTANDING ......................                                                        
</TABLE>


                                                   (Continued on following page)
                                      S-18
<PAGE>

                        SINCLAIR BROADCAST GROUP, INC.
                 PRO FORMA CONSOLIDATED STATEMENT OF OPERATIONS
                     FOR THE YEAR ENDED DECEMBER 31, 1996
                 (DOLLARS IN THOUSANDS, EXCEPT PER SHARE DATA)
                                  (UNAUDITED)



<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
                                                                                               HERITAGE(G)
                                                                    DEBT ISSUANCE,      -------------------------
                                                                    HYTOPS ISSUANCE
                                                                 AND 1996 ACQUISITIONS    HERITAGE       KOKH
                                                                ----------------------- ------------ ------------
<S>                                                             <C>                     <C>          <C>
REVENUES:
 Station broadcast revenues, net of agency commissions   ......      $   445,008        $  95,302     $ (7,953)
 Revenues realized from station barter arrangements   .........           36,065            4,292         (178)
                                                                     -----------        ----------    --------
  Total revenues  .............................................          481,073           99,594       (8,131)
                                                                     -----------        ----------    --------
OPERATING EXPENSES:
 Program and production .......................................           79,282           20,089       (1,871)
 Selling, general and administrative   ........................          115,599           31,916       (1,722)
 Expenses realized from barter arrangements  ..................           29,180            3,478          (70)
 Amortization of program contract costs and net realizable
 value adjustments   ..........................................           59,656            3,165       (1,208)
 Amortization of deferred compensation ........................              933
 Depreciation and amortization of property and equipment   .              16,929            5,472       (1,022)
 Amortization of acquired intangible broadcasting assets, non-
 compete and consulting agreements and other assets   .........           74,527            8,460         (367)
 Amortization of excess syndicated programming  ...............            3,043
                                                                     -----------
  Total operating expenses    .................................          379,149           72,580       (6,260)
                                                                     -----------        ----------    --------
  Broadcast operating income (loss) ...........................          101,924           27,014       (1,871)
                                                                     -----------        ----------    --------
OTHER INCOME (EXPENSE):
 Interest and amortization of debt discount expense   .........         (122,662)         (17,949)       1,025
 Gain on sale of station   ....................................                             6,031
 Interest income  .............................................            1,710
 Subsidiary trust minority interest expense  ..................          (23,250)
 Other income (expense) .......................................              215             (203)
                                                                     -----------        ----------
  Income (loss) before provision (benefit) for income taxes              (42,063)          14,893         (846)
PROVISION (BENEFIT) FOR INCOME
 TAXES   ......................................................          (13,116)           7,853         (466)
                                                                     -----------        ----------    --------
NET INCOME (LOSS) .............................................      $   (28,947)       $   7,040     $   (380)
                                                                     ===========        ==========    ========
NET INCOME (LOSS) AVAILABLE TO COMMON
 STOCKHOLDERS  ................................................
NET INCOME (LOSS) PER COMMON AND COMMON
 EQUIVALENT SHARE .............................................
WEIGHTED AVERAGE COMMON AND COMMON
 EQUIVALENT SHARES OUTSTANDING   ..............................



<CAPTION>
                                                                                         DEBT ISSUANCE,
                                                                      HERITAGE          HYTOPS ISSUANCE,         PREFERRED
                                                                    ACQUISITION       1996 ACQUISITIONS AND        STOCK
                                                                    ADJUSTMENTS       HERITAGE ACQUISITION       OFFERING
                                                                -------------------- ----------------------- -----------------
<S>                                                              <C>                      <C>                 <C>
REVENUES:
 Station broadcast revenues, net of agency commissions   ......                           $    532,357
 Revenues realized from station barter arrangements   .........                                 40,179
                                                                                          ------------
  Total revenues  .............................................                                572,536
                                                                                          ------------
OPERATING EXPENSES:
 Program and production .......................................                                 97,500
 Selling, general and administrative   ........................  $     (1,808) (u)             143,985
 Expenses realized from barter arrangements  ..................                                 32,588
 Amortization of program contract costs and net realizable
 value adjustments   ..........................................                                 61,613
 Amortization of deferred compensation ........................                                    933
 Depreciation and amortization of property and equipment   .             (900) (v)              20,479
 Amortization of acquired intangible broadcasting assets, non-
 compete and consulting agreements and other assets   .........         9,531  (w)              92,151
 Amortization of excess syndicated programming  ...............                                  3,043
                                                                                          ------------
  Total operating expenses    .................................         6,823                  452,292
                                                                 ------------             ------------
  Broadcast operating income (loss) ...........................        (6,823)                 120,244
                                                                 ------------             ------------
OTHER INCOME (EXPENSE):
 Interest and amortization of debt discount expense   .........       (23,621) (x)            (163,207)       $    9,880 (y)
 Gain on sale of station   ....................................                                  6,031
 Interest income  .............................................                                  1,710
 Subsidiary trust minority interest expense  ..................                                (23,250)
 Other income (expense) .......................................                                     12
                                                                                          ------------
  Income (loss) before provision (benefit) for income taxes           (30,444)                 (58,460)            9,880
PROVISION (BENEFIT) FOR INCOME
 TAXES   ......................................................       (12,178) (n)             (17,907)            3,952 (n)
                                                                 ------------             ------------        ----------
NET INCOME (LOSS) .............................................  $    (18,266)            $    (40,553)       $    5,928
                                                                 ============             ============        ==========
NET INCOME (LOSS) AVAILABLE TO COMMON
 STOCKHOLDERS  ................................................                           $    (40,553)
                                                                                          ============
NET INCOME (LOSS) PER COMMON AND COMMON
 EQUIVALENT SHARE .............................................                           $      (1.04)
                                                                                          ============
WEIGHTED AVERAGE COMMON AND COMMON
 EQUIVALENT SHARES OUTSTANDING   ..............................                                 39,058 (o)
                                                                                          ============



<CAPTION>
                                                                                                             DEBT ISSUANCE,
                                                                    DEBT ISSUANCE,                          HYTOPS ISSUANCE,
                                                                   HYTOPS ISSUANCE,                        1996 ACQUISITIONS,
                                                                  1996 ACQUISITIONS,                      HERITAGE ACQUISITION,
                                                                 HERITAGE ACQUISITION       COMMON           PREFERRED AND
                                                                 AND PREFERRED STOCK         STOCK            COMMON STOCK
                                                                       OFFERING          OFFERING(MM)        OFFERINGS(MM)
                                                                ---------------------- ----------------- ----------------------
<S>                                                             <C>                    <C>               <C>
REVENUES:
 Station broadcast revenues, net of agency commissions   ......     $    532,357                             $     532,357
 Revenues realized from station barter arrangements   .........           40,179                                    40,179
                                                                    ------------                             -------------
  Total revenues  .............................................          572,536                                   572,536
                                                                    ------------                             -------------
OPERATING EXPENSES:
 Program and production .......................................           97,500                                    97,500
 Selling, general and administrative   ........................          143,985                                   143,985
 Expenses realized from barter arrangements  ..................           32,588                                    32,588
 Amortization of program contract costs and net realizable
 value adjustments   ..........................................           61,613                                    61,613
 Amortization of deferred compensation ........................              933                                       933
 Depreciation and amortization of property and equipment   .              20,479                                    20,479
 Amortization of acquired intangible broadcasting assets, non-
 compete and consulting agreements and other assets   .........           92,151                                    92,151
 Amortization of excess syndicated programming  ...............            3,043                                     3,043
                                                                    ------------                             -------------
  Total operating expenses    .................................          452,292                                   452,292
                                                                    ------------                             -------------
  Broadcast operating income (loss) ...........................          120,244                                   120,244
                                                                    ------------                             -------------
OTHER INCOME (EXPENSE):
 Interest and amortization of debt discount expense   .........         (153,327)       $    9,556 (z)            (143,771)
 Gain on sale of station   ....................................            6,031                                     6,031
 Interest income  .............................................            1,710                                     1,710
 Subsidiary trust minority interest expense  ..................          (23,250)                                  (23,250)
 Other income (expense) .......................................               12                                        12
                                                                    ------------                             -------------
  Income (loss) before provision (benefit) for income taxes              (48,580)            9,556                 (39,024)
PROVISION (BENEFIT) FOR INCOME
 TAXES   ......................................................          (13,955)            3,823 (n)             (10,132)
                                                                    ------------        ----------           -------------
NET INCOME (LOSS) .............................................     $    (34,625)       $    5,733           $     (28,892)
                                                                    ============        ==========           =============
NET INCOME (LOSS) AVAILABLE TO COMMON
 STOCKHOLDERS  ................................................     $    (43,625)                            $     (37,892)
                                                                    ============                             =============
NET INCOME (LOSS) PER COMMON AND COMMON
 EQUIVALENT SHARE .............................................     $      (1.12)                            $       (0.88)
                                                                    ============                             =============
WEIGHTED AVERAGE COMMON AND COMMON
 EQUIVALENT SHARES OUTSTANDING   ..............................       39,058 (o)                              43,058 (aa)
                                                                    ============                             =============
</TABLE>



                                      S-19
<PAGE>

                        SINCLAIR BROADCAST GROUP, INC.
                 PRO FORMA CONSOLIDATED STATEMENT OF OPERATIONS
                    FOR THE SIX MONTHS ENDED JUNE 30, 1997
                 (DOLLARS IN THOUSANDS, EXCEPT PER SHARE DATA)
                                  (UNAUDITED)




<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
                                                                                                             HERITAGE(G)
                                                  CONSOLIDATED        HYTOPS               DEBT        --------------------
<S>                                              <C>            <C>                 <C>                <C>         <C>
                                                   HISTORICAL        ISSUANCE            ISSUANCE       HERITAGE       KOKH
                                                   ------------      --------------      ------------- ---------   --------
REVENUES:
 Station broadcast revenues, net of agency
   commissions   ...............................  $  219,701                                           $ 46,451     $ (3,706)
 Revenues realized from station barter ar-
   rangements                                         19,870                                              2,430         (125)
                                                  ----------                                           ---------    --------
      Total revenues  ..........................     239,571                                             48,881       (3,831)
                                                  ----------                                           ---------    --------
OPERATING EXPENSES:
 Program and production ........................      46,760                                             15,313       (1,150)
 Selling, general and administrative   .........      51,634                                              9,447         (784)
 Expenses realized from station barter ar-
   rangements                                         16,303                                              1,849          (62)
 Amortization of program contract costs and
   net realizable value adjustments   ..........      30,918                                                824         (297)
 Amortization of deferred compensation .........         233
 Depreciation and amortization of property
   and equipment    ............................       8,340                                              2,819         (445)
 Amortization of acquired intangible broad-
   casting assets, non-compete and consult-
   ing agreements and other assets                    37,392    $          88 (bb)  $         225 (ee)    4,174         (184)
                                                  ----------    -------------       -------------      --------     --------
      Total operating expenses .................     191,580               88                 225        34,426       (2,922)
                                                  ----------    -------------       -------------      --------     --------
      Broadcast operating income (loss) ........      47,991              (88)               (225)       14,455         (909)
                                                  ----------    -------------       -------------      --------     --------
OTHER INCOME (EXPENSE):
 Interest and amortization of debt discount
   expense .....................................     (51,993)           2,894 (cc)         (9,000)(ff)   (9,979)         425
 Gain of sale of station   .....................                                                          9,401
 Interest income  ..............................       1,040
 Subsidiary trust minority interest expense     .     (7,007)          (4,618)(dd)
 Other income  .................................          47                                                (98)
                                                  ----------                                           --------
  Income (loss) before provision (bene-
    fit) for income taxes                             (9,922)          (1,812)             (9,225)       13,779         (484)
PROVISION (BENEFIT) FOR INCOME TAXES   .........      (4,100)            (725)(n)          (3,690)(n)     7,262         (369)
                                                  ----------    -------------       -------------      --------     --------
NET INCOME (LOSS) ..............................  $   (5,822)   $      (1,087)      $      (5,535)     $  6,517     $   (115)
                                                  ==========    =============       =============      ========     ========
NET LOSS AVAILABLE TO COMMON
  STOCKHOLDERS  ................................  $   (5,822)
                                                  ==========
NET LOSS PER COMMON AND COMMON EQUIVALENT SHARE   $    (0.17)
                                                  ==========
WEIGHTED AVERAGE COMMON
  SHARES OUTSTANDING  ..........................      34,746
                                                  ==========



<CAPTION>
                                                       HERITAGE             DEBT ISSUANCE,            PREFERRED
                                                     ACQUISITION           HYTOPS ISSUANCE              STOCK
<S>                                              <C>                  <C>                        <C>
                                                     ADJUSTMENTS       AND HERITAGE ACQUISITION       OFFERING
                                                     ----------------  -------------------------      --------------
REVENUES:
 Station broadcast revenues, net of agency
   commissions   ...............................                              $ 262,446
 Revenues realized from station barter ar-
   rangements                                                                    22,175
                                                                              ---------
      Total revenues  ..........................                                284,621
                                                                              ---------
OPERATING EXPENSES:
 Program and production ........................                                 60,923
 Selling, general and administrative   ......... $         (883) (gg)            59,414
 Expenses realized from station barter ar-
   rangements                                                                    18,090
 Amortization of program contract costs and
   net realizable value adjustments   ..........                                 31,445
 Amortization of deferred compensation .........                                    233
 Depreciation and amortization of property
   and equipment    ............................           (450) (hh)            10,264
 Amortization of acquired intangible broad-
   casting assets, non-compete and consult-
   ing agreements and other assets                        4,964 (ii)             46,659
                                                 --------------               ---------
      Total operating expenses .................          3,631                 227,028
                                                 --------------               ---------
      Broadcast operating income (loss) ........         (3,631)                 57,593
                                                 --------------               ---------
OTHER INCOME (EXPENSE):
 Interest and amortization of debt discount
   expense .....................................        (10,768) (jj)           (78,421)          $     4,940 (kk)
 Gain of sale of station   .....................                                  9,401
 Interest income  ..............................                                  1,040
 Subsidiary trust minority interest expense     .                               (11,625)
 Other income  .................................                                    (51)
                                                                              ---------
 Income (loss) before provision (bene-
   fit) for income taxes                                (14,399)                (22,063)                4,940
PROVISION (BENEFIT) FOR INCOME TAXES   .........         (5,760) (n)             (7,382)                1,975 (n)
                                                 --------------               ---------           ----------
NET INCOME (LOSS) .............................. $       (8,639)              $ (14,681)          $     2,965
                                                 ==============               =========           ==========
NET LOSS AVAILABLE TO COMMON
  STOCKHOLDERS  ................................                              $ (14,681)
                                                                              =========
NET LOSS PER COMMON AND COMMON EQUIVALENT SHARE                               $   (0.42)
                                                                              =========
WEIGHTED AVERAGE COMMON
  SHARES OUTSTANDING  ..........................                                 34,769
                                                                              =========



<CAPTION>
                                                                                                DEBT ISSUANCE,
                                                     DEBT ISSUANCE,                            HYTOPS ISSUANCE,
                                                    HYTOPS ISSUANCE,                         HERITAGE ACQUISITION,
                                                  HERITAGE ACQUISITION        COMMON            PREFERRED AND
                                                     AND PREFERRED             STOCK             COMMON STOCK
<S>                                              <C>                    <C>                 <C>
                                                     STOCK OFFERING        OFFERING(MM)         OFFERINGS(MM)
                                                 ---------------------- ------------------- ----------------------
REVENUES:
 Station broadcast revenues, net of agency
   commissions   ...............................       $ 262,446                                $     262,446
 Revenues realized from station barter ar-
   rangements                                             22,175                                       22,175
                                                       ---------                                -------------
      Total revenues  ..........................         284,621                                      284,621
                                                       ---------                                -------------
OPERATING EXPENSES:
 Program and production ........................          60,923                                       60,923
 Selling, general and administrative   .........          59,414                                       59,414
 Expenses realized from station barter ar-
   rangements                                             18,090                                       18,090
 Amortization of program contract costs and
   net realizable value adjustments   ..........          31,445                                       31,445
 Amortization of deferred compensation .........             233                                          233
 Depreciation and amortization of property
   and equipment    ............................          10,264                                       10,264
 Amortization of acquired intangible broad-
   casting assets, non-compete and consult-
   ing agreements and other assets                        46,659                                       46,659
                                                       ---------                                -------------
      Total operating expenses .................         227,028                                      227,028
                                                       ---------                                -------------
      Broadcast operating income (loss) ........          57,593                                       57,593
                                                       ---------                                -------------
OTHER INCOME (EXPENSE):
 Interest and amortization of debt discount
   expense .....................................         (73,481)        $     4,778 (ll)             (68,703)
 Gain of sale of station   .....................           9,401                                        9,401
 Interest income  ..............................           1,040                                        1,040
 Subsidiary trust minority interest expense     .        (11,625)                                     (11,625)
 Other income  .................................             (51)                                         (51)
                                                       ---------                                -------------
Income (loss) before provision (bene-
  fit) for income taxes                                  (17,123)              4,778                  (12,345)
PROVISION (BENEFIT) FOR INCOME TAXES   .........         (5,407)          1,911 (n)                   (3,496)
                                                       ---------         ----------             -------------
NET INCOME (LOSS) ..............................       $ (11,716)        $     2,867            $      (8,849)
                                                       =========         ==========             =============
NET LOSS AVAILABLE TO COMMON
  STOCKHOLDERS  ................................       $ (16,216)                               $     (13,349)
                                                       =========                                =============
NET LOSS PER COMMON AND COMMON EQUIVALENT SHARE        $   (0.47)                               $       (0.34)
                                                       =========                                =============
WEIGHTED AVERAGE COMMON
  SHARES OUTSTANDING  ..........................          34,769                                 38,769 (aa)
                                                       =========                                =============
</TABLE>



                                      S-20
<PAGE>

                        SINCLAIR BROADCAST GROUP, INC.
            NOTES TO PRO FORMA CONSOLIDATED STATEMENT OF OPERATIONS
                            (DOLLARS IN THOUSANDS)

(a) The  Flint T.V., Inc. ("Flint-TV") column reflects the results of operations
    for  WSMH  for  the  period  from  January 1, 1996 to February 28, 1996, the
    date the Flint Acquisition was consummated.

(b) The  Superior  Communications  Group,  Inc.  column  reflects the results of
    operations  for  Superior  for  the  period  from  January 1, 1996 to May 7,
    1996, the date the Superior Acquisition was consummated.

(c) The KSMO  column  reflects  the  results of  operations  for the period from
    January 1, 1996 to June 30, 1996 as the  transaction was consummated in July
    1996.

(d) The WSTR  column  reflects  the  results of  operations  for the period from
    January  1, 1996 to July 31,  1996 as the  transaction  was  consummated  in
    August 1996.

(e) The  River  City  column  reflects  the results of operations for River City
    (including  KRRT,  Inc.)  for  the  period  from  January 1, 1996 to May 31,
    1996,  the  date the River City Acquisition was consummated. The WSYX column
    removes  the  results  of WSYX from the results of River City for the period
    as  the  Company  has  not  yet  acquired  WSYX. See "Business of Sinclair -
    Broadcasting Acquisition Strategy."

(f) The WYZZ  column  reflects  the  results of  operations  for the period from
    January 1, 1996 to June 30, 1996 as the purchase transaction was consummated
    in July 1996.

(g) The Heritage  column  reflects the results of operations for the period from
    January 1, 1996 to December  31, 1996 for the year ended  December  31, 1996
    Pro Forma Consolidated Statement of Operations and the results of operations
    for the  period  from  January  1, 1997 to June 30,  1997 for the six months
    ended June 30, 1997 Pro Forma Consolidated Statement of Operations. The KOKH
    column  removes the  results of KOKH from the  results of Heritage  for both
    periods to  reflect  the sale of KOKH,  which is  required  pursuant  to the
    Heritage  Acquisition  Agreements  and with respect to which the Company has
    entered  into  a  letter  of  intent.  See  "Business  of  Sinclair  -  1997
    Acquisitions."

(h) To adjust River City operating  expenses for non-recurring LMA payments made
    to KRRT,  Inc.  for KRRT,  Inc.  debt  service and to adjust  River City and
    Superior  operating  expenses for employment  contracts and other  corporate
    overhead expenses not assumed at the time of the 1996 Acquisitions.

(i) To  record  compensation  expense  related  to  options  granted  under  the
    Company's Long-Term Incentive Plan:



<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
                                                               YEAR ENDED
                                                              DECEMBER 31,
                                                                  1996
                                                              -------------
<S>                                                               <C>
   Compensation expense related to the Long-Term Incentive
     Plan on a pro forma basis   .........................      $  933
   Less: Compensation expense recorded by the Company re-
     lated to the Long-Term Incentive Plan                        (739)
                                                                ------
                                                                $  194
                                                                ======
</TABLE>

(j) To record  depreciation  expense  related to  acquired  tangible  assets and
    eliminate depreciation expense recorded by Flint-TV,  Superior,  KSMO, WSTR,
    River City and WYZZ from the period of January 1, 1996  through  the date of
    acquisition. Tangible assets are to be depreciated over lives ranging from 5
    to 29.5 years, calculated as follows:



<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
                                                                 YEAR ENDED
                                                              DECEMBER 31, 1996
                                                      ---------------------------------
                                                       FLINT-TV   SUPERIOR     KSMO
                                                      ---------- ---------- -----------
<S>                                                   <C>        <C>        <C>
   Depreciation expense on acquired tangible assets    $ 32       $  315     $   240
   Less: Depreciation expense recorded by Flint-TV,
    Superior, KSMO, WSTR, River City and WYZZ  ......      (4)      (373)       (374)
                                                       ----       ------     -------
   Pro forma adjustment   ...........................  $ 28       $  (58)    $  (134)
                                                       ====       ======     =======



<CAPTION>
                                                        WSTR     RIVER CITY     WYZZ        TOTAL
                                                      --------- ------------ ----------- -----------
<S>                                                   <C>       <C>          <C>         <C>
   Depreciation expense on acquired tangible assets   $  507     $   3,965    $ 159      $  5,218
   Less: Depreciation expense recorded by Flint-TV,
    Superior, KSMO, WSTR, River City and WYZZ  ......   (284)       (5,120)        (6)     (6,161)
                                                      -------    ---------    -----      ---------
   Pro forma adjustment   ........................... $  223     $  (1,155)   $ 153      $   (943)
                                                      =======    =========    =====      =========
</TABLE>

(k) To record  amortization  expense related to acquired  intangible  assets and
    deferred  financing  costs and eliminate  amortization  expense  recorded by
    Flint-TV,  Superior,  KSMO,  WSTR,  River  City and WYZZ from the  period of
    January 1, 1996 through  date of  acquisition.  Intangible  assets are to be
    amortized over lives ranging from 1 to 40 years, calculated as follows:





<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
                                                                   YEAR ENDED
                                                                DECEMBER 31, 1996
                                                          -----------------------------
                                                           FLINT-TV   SUPERIOR   KSMO
                                                          ---------- ---------- -------
<S>                                                       <C>        <C>        <C>
   Amortization expense on acquired intangible assets       $ 167     $   827     $ 180
   Deferred financing costs   ...........................
   Less: Amortization expense recorded by Flint-TV,
    Superior, KSMO, WSTR, River City and WYZZ   .........       -        (529)        -
                                                            -----     -------    ------
   Pro forma adjustment    ..............................   $ 167     $   298     $ 180
                                                            ======    =======    ======



<CAPTION>
                                                           WSTR    RIVER CITY     WYZZ       TOTAL
                                                          ------- ------------ ---------- ------------
<S>                                                       <C>     <C>          <C>        <C>
   Amortization expense on acquired intangible assets     $ 285   $  12,060     $ 99      $  13,618
   Deferred financing costs   ...........................             1,429                   1,429
   Less: Amortization expense recorded by Flint-TV,
    Superior, KSMO, WSTR, River City and WYZZ   .........   (39)    (10,442)        (3)     (11,013)
                                                          -----   ---------     ----      ---------
   Pro forma adjustment    .............................. $ 246   $   3,047     $ 96      $   4,034
                                                          =====   =========     ====      =========
</TABLE>



                                      S-21
<PAGE>

(l) To  record  interest  expense  for  the  year  ended  December  31,  1996 on
    acquisition financing relating to Superior of $59,850 (under the Bank Credit
    Agreement  at 8.0% for four  months),  KSMO and WSTR of $10,425  and $7,881,
    respectively  (both under the Bank Credit Agreement at 8.0% for six months),
    River City (including  KRRT) of $868,300 (under the Bank Credit Agreement at
    8.0% for five  months)  and of $851 for  hedging  agreements  related to the
    River City financing and WYZZ of $20,194 (under the Bank Credit Agreement at
    8.0% for six months) and eliminate  interest expense  recorded.  No interest
    expense  has been  recorded  for  Flint-TV as it has been  assumed  that the
    proceeds from the 1995 Notes were used to purchase Flint-TV.



<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
                                                                    YEAR ENDED
                                                                 DECEMBER 31, 1996
                                                       -------------------------------------
                                                         SUPERIOR       KSMO        WSTR
                                                       ------------- ----------- -----------
<S>                                                    <C>           <C>         <C>
   Interest expense adjustment as noted above   ......  $  (1,596)    $  (417)    $  (315)
   Less: Interest expense recorded by Superior, KSMO,
    WSTR, River City and WYZZ ........................        457         823       1,127
                                                        ---------     -------     -------
   Pro forma adjustment    ...........................  $  (1,139)    $   406     $   812
                                                        =========     =======     =======



<CAPTION>
                                                        RIVER CITY     WYZZ        TOTAL
                                                       ------------ ---------- --------------
<S>                                                    <C>          <C>        <C>
   Interest expense adjustment as noted above   ......  $ (29,032)   $  (808)   $  (32,168)
   Less: Interest expense recorded by Superior, KSMO,
    WSTR, River City and WYZZ ........................     12,352          -        14,759
                                                        ---------    -------    ----------
   Pro forma adjustment    ...........................  $ (16,680)   $  (808)   $  (17,409)
                                                        =========    =======    ==========
</TABLE>

(m) To  eliminate  interest  income  for the year  ended  December  31,  1996 on
    proceeds  from the sale of the 1995  Notes  due to  assumed  utilization  of
    excess cash for the following acquisitions: Flint-TV, KSMO and WSTR and WYZZ
    of $34,400  (with a  commercial  bank at 5.7% for two  months),  $10,425 and
    $7,881  (both with a  commercial  bank at 5.7% for six  months)  and $20,194
    (with a commercial bank at 5.7% for six months).



<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
                                                                                     YEAR ENDED
                                                                                  DECEMBER 31, 1996
                                                      -------------------------------------------------------------------------
                                                       FLINT-TV     KSMO        WSTR      RIVER CITY     WYZZ         TOTAL
                                                      ---------- ----------- ----------- ------------ ----------- -------------
<S>                                                   <C>        <C>         <C>         <C>          <C>         <C>
   Interest income adjustment as noted above   ......  $  (327)   $  (297)    $  (226)     $     -     $  (576)    $  (1,426)
   Less: Interest income recorded by Flint-TV, KSMO,
    WSTR, River City and WYZZ   .....................        -          -         (15)        (195)          -          (210)
                                                       -------    -------     -------      -------     -------     ---------
   Pro forma adjustment   ...........................  $  (327)   $  (297)    $  (241)     $  (195)    $  (576)    $  (1,636)
                                                       =======    =======     =======      =======     =======     =========
</TABLE>

(n) To record tax provision (benefit) at the applicable statutory tax rates.

(o) Weighted  average  shares  outstanding on a pro forma basis assumes that the
    1,150,000  shares of Series B Preferred  Stock were  converted  to 4,181,818
    shares of Class A Common Stock and the Company's Incentive Stock Options and
    Long-Term Incentive Plan Options were outstanding as of the beginning of the
    period.


(p) To record  amortization  expense on other  assets that relates to the HYTOPS
    Issuance for one year ($6,000 over 12 years).


(q) To record the net interest expense reduction for 1996 related to application
    of the  HYTOPS  Issuance  proceeds  to the  outstanding  balance  under  the
    revolving  credit  facility offset by an increase in commitment fees for the
    available but unused portion of the revolving  credit  facility for the year
    ended December 31, 1996.



<TABLE>
<S>                                                                                       <C>
     Interest on adjusted borrowing on the revolving credit facility ..................    $ 12,600
     Commitment fee on available but unused borrowings of $250,000 of revolving credit
      facility at  1/2 of 1% for 12 months   ..........................................      (1,250)
     Commitment fee on available borrowings recorded by the Company  ..................         470
                                                                                           --------
     Pro forma adjustment  ............................................................    $ 11,820
                                                                                           ========
</TABLE>

(r) To record  subsidiary  trust  minority  interest  expense for the year ended
    December 31, 1996 ($200,000 aggregate liquidation value of HYTOPS).

(s) To  record amortization expense on other assets for one year ($4,500 over 10
    years). See note (f) of notes to Pro Forma Consolidated Balance Sheet.

(t) To  record interest expense on the 1997 Notes for one year ($200,000 at 9%).

(u) To adjust Heritage  operating expenses for corporate overhead expenses which
    the Company does not expect to incur upon its  consummation  of the Heritage
    Acquisition on a going-forward basis.

(v) To record depreciation expense related to acquired tangible assets of $3,550
    and eliminate depreciation expense of $4,450 recorded by Heritage.  Tangible
    assets are to be depreciated over lives ranging from 5 to 29.5 years.

(w) To record  amortization  expense  related to acquired  intangible  assets of
    $17,624 and eliminate  amortization  expense of $8,093 recorded by Heritage.
    Intangible assets are to be amortized over lives ranging from 1 to 40 years.

(x) To record interest  expense on acquisition  financing of $570,000 (under the
    Bank Credit  Agreement at 7 1/4%),  net of $780 of  commitment  fees for the
    available  but  unused  portion  of  the  revolving  credit  facility,   and
    eliminated interest expense of $16,924 recorded by Heritage.

(y) To record the interest  expense  reduction of $10,518 related to application
    of the Preferred Stock Offering  proceeds to the  outstanding  balance under
    the revolving  credit  facility  offset by an increase in commitment fees of
    $638 for the available but unused portion of the revolving  credit  facility
    assuming the Heritage Acquisiton has been consummated.

(z) To record the interest  expense  reduction of $10,077 related to application
    of the Common Stock Offering  proceeds to the outstanding  balance under the
    revolving  credit  facility offset by an increase in commitment fees of $521
    for the  available  but unused  portion  of the  revolving  credit  facility
    assuming the Heritage Acquisition has been consummated.



                                      S-22
<PAGE>

(aa) Weighted  average shares  outstanding on a pro forma basis assumes that the
     4,000,000  shares of Class A Common  Stock to be issued in the Common Stock
     Offering were outstanding as of the beginning of the period.

(bb) To record  amortization  expense on other  assets  that  resulted  from the
     HYTOPS Issuance for six months ($6,000 over 12 years).


<TABLE>
<S>                                                                                             <C>
          Amortization expense on other assets  ...........................................     $  250
          Amortization expense recorded by the Company   ..................................       (162)
                                                                                                ------
          Pro forma adjustment   ..........................................................     $   88
                                                                                                ======
</TABLE>

(cc) To  record  the  net  interest  expense   reduction  for  1997  related  to
     application  of the HYTOPS  Issuance  proceeds to the  outstanding  balance
     under the  revolving  credit  facility  offset by an increase in commitment
     fees for the available but unused portion of the revolving  credit facility
     for the quarter ended June 30, 1997.


<TABLE>
<S>                                                                                             <C>
          Interest on adjusted borrowing on the revolving credit facility    ...............    $3,235
          Commitment fee on available but unused borrowings of $250,000 of revolving credit
            facility at  1/2 of 1% for six months  .........................................      (625)
          Commitment fee on available borrowings recorded by the Company  ..................       284
                                                                                                ------
          Pro forma adjustment  ............................................................    $2,894
                                                                                                ======
</TABLE>

(dd) To record  subsidiary trust minority interest expense for the quarter ended
     June 30, 1997 ($200,000 aggregate liquidation value HYTOPS).


<TABLE>
<S>                                                                                             <C>
          Subsidiary trust minority interest expense for six months   ........................  $ (11,625)
          Subsidiary trust minority interest expense made by the Company during the quarter   .     7,007
                                                                                                ---------
          Pro forma adjustment ...............................................................  $  (4,618)
                                                                                                S=========
</TABLE>

(ee) To record amortization  expense on other assets for six months ($4,500 over
     10 years). See note (f) of notes to Pro Forma Consolidated Balance Sheet.

(ff) To record  interest  expense on the 1997 Notes for six months  ($200,000 at
     9%).

(gg) To adjust Heritage operating expenses for corporate overhead expenses which
     the Company does not expect to incur upon its  consummation of the Heritage
     Acquisition on a going-forward basis.

(hh) To record  depreciation  expenses  related to acquired  tangible  assets of
     $1,775 and eliminate  depreciation  expense of $2,225 recorded by Heritage.
     Tangible  assets are to be  depreciated  over lives  ranging from 5 to 29.5
     years.

(ii) To record  amortization  expense related to acquired  intangible  assets of
     $8,954 and eliminate  amortization  expense of $3,990 recorded by Heritage.
     Intangible  assets  are to be  amortized  over lives  ranging  from 1 to 40
     years.

(jj) To record interest expense on acquisition  financing of $570,000 (under the
     Bank Credit  Agreement at 7 1/4%),  net of $341 of commitment  fees for the
     available  but  unused  portion  of  the  revolving  credit  facility,  and
     eliminate interest expense of $9,554 recorded by Heritage.

(kk) To record the interest  expense  reduction of $5,259 related to application
     of the Preferred Stock Offering  proceeds to the outstanding  balance under
     the revolving  credit  facility offset by an increase in commitment fees of
     $319 for the available but unused portion of the revolving  credit facility
     assuming the Heritage Acquisition has been consummated.

(ll) To record the interest  expense  reduction of $5,039 related to application
     of the Common Stock Offering proceeds to the outstanding  balance under the
     revolving  credit facility offset by an increase in commitment fees of $261
     for the  available  but unused  portion of the  revolving  credit  facility
     assuming the Heritage Acquisition has been consummated.

(mm) There  can  be  no  assurance  that  the  Common  Stock  Offering  will  be
     consummated.  The  completion  of  the  Preferred  Stock  Offering  is  not
     conditioned upon the completion of the Common Stock Offering.


                                      S-23
<PAGE>

                    MANAGEMENT'S DISCUSSION AND ANALYSIS OF
           FINANCIAL CONDITION AND RESULTS OF OPERATIONS OF SINCLAIR


INTRODUCTION

     The Company is a  diversified  broadcasting  company  that owns or provides
programming  services  TO more  television  stations  than any other  commercial
broadcasting  group in the United States. The Company currently owns or provides
programming  services  pursuant  to  Local  Marketing  Agreements  (LMAs)  to 29
television  stations,  has pending  acquisitions of four  additional  television
stations,  and has pending  acquisitions of the right to provide  programming to
two additional stations. The Company believes it is also one of the top 20 radio
groups in the United States, when measured by the total number of radio stations
owned,  programmed or with which the Company has Joint Sales Agreements  (JSAs).
The  Company  owns 27  radio  stations,  has  pending  acquisitions  of 24 radio
stations, and has options to acquire an additional seven radio stations.

     The  operating  revenues of the Company are derived from local and national
advertisers and, to a much lesser extent, from television network  compensation.
The  Company's  primary  operating  expenses  involved in owning,  operating  or
programming  the television  and radio  stations are  syndicated  program rights
fees, commissions on revenues, employee salaries,  news-gathering and promotion.
Amortization  and  depreciation of costs  associated with the acquisition of the
stations and interest  carrying  charges are significant  factors in determining
the Company's overall profitability.

     Set forth below are the principal types of broadcast  revenues  received by
the Company's stations for the periods indicated and the percentage contribution
of each type to the Company's total gross broadcast revenues:


                              BROADCAST REVENUES
                            (DOLLARS IN THOUSANDS)


<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
                                                                YEARS ENDED DECEMBER 31,
                                     ------------------------------------------------------------------------------
                                               1994                       1995                       1996
                                     ------------------------   ------------------------   ------------------------
<S>                                  <C>           <C>          <C>           <C>          <C>           <C>
Local/regional advertising  ......   $ 67,881         48.6%     $ 104,299        47.5%     $ 199,029        49.4%
National advertising  ............     69,374         49.6       113,678         51.7       191,449         47.6
Network compensation  ............        302          0.2           442          0.2         3,907          1.0
Political advertising ............      1,593          1.1           197          0.1         6,972          1.7
Production   .....................        696          0.5         1,115          0.5         1,142          0.3
                                     --------       ------      --------       ------      --------       ------
Broadcast revenues ...............    139,846        100.0%      219,731        100.0%      402,499        100.0%
                                                    ======                     ======                     ======
Less: agency commissions .........    (21,235)                   (31,797)                   (56,040)
                                     --------                   --------                   --------
Broadcast revenues, net  .........    118,611                    187,934                    346,459
Barter revenues ..................     10,743                     18,200                     32,029
                                     --------                   --------                   --------
Total revenues  ..................  $ 129,354                  $ 206,134                  $ 378,488
                                     ========                   ========                   ========
</TABLE>

     The  Company's   primary  types  of  programming   and  their   approximate
percentages  of 1996 net broadcast  revenues were network  programming  (14.1%),
children's   programming  (7.4%)  and  other  syndicated   programming  (56.7%).
Similarly,  the Company's  three largest  categories  of  advertising  and their
approximate  percentages of 1996 net broadcast revenues were automotive (17.4%),
fast food advertising  (9.2%) and movies (5.5%). No other  advertising  category
accounted for more than 5% of the  Company's net broadcast  revenues in 1996. No
individual  advertiser  accounted  for  more  than  5% of any  of the  Company's
individual station's net broadcast revenues in 1996.


                                      S-24
<PAGE>

     The following  table sets forth certain  operating  data of the Company for
the years ended  December 31, 1994,  1995 and 1996 and the six months ended June
30, 1996 and 1997:


                                 OPERATING DATA
                            (DOLLARS IN THOUSANDS)


<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
                                                                                                         SIX MONTHS
                                                               YEARS ENDED DECEMBER 31,                ENDED JUNE 30,
                                                      ------------------------------------------ ---------------------------
                                                           1994          1995          1996          1996          1997
                                                      -------------- ------------- ------------- ------------- -------------
<S>                                                   <C>            <C>           <C>           <C>           <C>
Net broadcast revenues ..............................  $  118,611     $ 187,934     $ 346,459     $ 117,339     $ 219,701
Barter revenues  ....................................      10,743        18,200        32,029         9,571        19,870
                                                       ----------     ---------     ---------     ---------     ---------
Total revenues   ....................................     129,354       206,134       378,488       126,910       239,571
                                                       ----------     ---------     ---------     ---------     ---------
Operating expenses, excluding depreciation and
 amortization and special bonuses paid to executive
 officers  ..........................................      50,545        80,446       167,765        52,826       114,697
Depreciation and amortization   .....................      55,587        80,410       118,038        45,493        76,650
Amortization of deferred compensation ...............           -             -           739           506           233
Amortization of excess syndicated programming  ......           -             -         3,043             -             -
Special bonuses to executive officers ...............       3,638             -             -             -             -
                                                       ----------     ---------     ---------     ---------     ---------
Broadcast operating income   ........................  $   19,584     $  45,278     $  88,903     $  28,085     $  47,991
                                                       ==========     =========     =========     =========     =========
BROADCAST CASH FLOW (BCF) DATA:
Television BCF   ....................................  $   67,519     $ 111,124     $ 175,212     $  63,309     $  98,032
Radio BCF  ..........................................           -             -        14,004         1,770         7,568
                                                       ----------     ---------     ---------     ---------     ---------
Consolidated BCF (a)   ..............................  $   67,519     $ 111,124     $ 189,216     $  65,079     $ 105,600
                                                       ==========     =========     =========     =========     =========
Television BCF margin  ..............................        56.9%         59.1%         56.7%         56.3%         51.2%
Radio BCF margin ....................................           -             -          37.3%         36.4%         26.7%
Consolidated BCF margin (b)  ........................        56.9%         59.1%         54.6%         55.5%         48.1%
OTHER DATA:
Adjusted EBITDA(c)  .................................  $   64,547     $ 105,750     $ 180,272     $  62,013     $  98,615
Adjusted EBITDA margin (b)   ........................        54.4%         56.3%         52.0%         52.8%         44.9%
After-tax cash flow (d)   ...........................  $   24,948     $  51,288     $  76,745     $  30,441     $  32,737
Program contract payments ...........................      14,262        19,938        30,451        12,071        26,259
Corporate expense   .................................       2,972         5,374         8,944         3,066         6,985
</TABLE>

- ----------


(a) "Consolidated  BCF" is defined as broadcast  operating income plus corporate
    overhead expenses, special bonuses paid to executive officers,  depreciation
    and amortization  (including film  amortization and amortization of deferred
    compensation  and excess  syndicated  programming),  less cash  payments for
    program contract rights.  Cash program payments represent cash payments made
    for current program  payables and do not  necessarily  correspond to program
    usage.   Special   bonuses  paid  to  executive   officers  are   considered
    non-recurring  expenses. The Company has presented broadcast cash flow data,
    which the Company  believes  are  comparable  to the data  provided by other
    companies in the industry,  because such data are commonly used as a measure
    of performance for broadcast companies.  However,  Consolidated BCF does not
    purport to represent  cash provided by operating  activities as reflected in
    the  Company's  consolidated  statements  of cash flow,  is not a measure of
    financial  performance under generally  accepted  accounting  principles and
    should not be  considered  in isolation  or as a substitute  for measures of
    performance  prepared  in  accordance  with  generally  accepted  accounting
    principles.


(b) "Consolidated  BCF  margin" is defined as broadcast cash flow divided by net
    broadcast  revenues.  "Adjusted EBITDA margin" is defined as Adjusted EBITDA
    divided by net broadcast revenues.


(c) "Adjusted EBITDA" is defined as broadcast cash flow less corporate  expenses
    and is a commonly  used  measure of  performance  for  broadcast  companies.
    Adjusted  EBITDA does not purport to  represent  cash  provided by operating
    activities  as reflected in the  Company's  consolidated  statements of cash
    flows, is not a measure of financial  performance  under generally  accepted
    accounting  principles  and should not be  considered  in  isolation or as a
    substitute for measures of performance prepared in accordance with generally
    accepted accounting principles.


(d) "After-tax  cash flow" is defined as net income (loss) before  extraordinary
    items plus  depreciation  and  amortization of intangibles,  (excluding film
    amortization), amortization of deferred compensation, amortization of excess
    syndicated programming,  special bonuses paid to executive officers, and the
    deferred tax provision (or minus the deferred tax benefit).  After-tax  cash
    flow is presented  here not as a measure of  operating  results and does not
    purport to represent cash provided by operating  activities.  After-tax cash
    flow should not be considered  in isolation or as a substitute  for measures
    of performance  prepared in accordance  with generally  accepted  accounting
    principles.


                                      S-25
<PAGE>

RESULTS OF OPERATIONS


SIX MONTHS ENDED JUNE 30, 1996 AND 1997

     Total  revenues  increased to $239.6  million for the six months ended June
30, 1997 from $126.9  million for the six months ended June 30, 1996,  or 88.8%.
After  excluding  the effects of non-cash  barter  transactions,  net  broadcast
revenues for the six months ended June 30, 1997  increased by 87.2% over the six
months ended June 30, 1996. The increase in broadcast revenues was primarily the
result of acquisitions and LMA  transactions  consummated by the Company in 1996
(the "1996  Acquisitions") and, to a lesser extent,  market growth in television
broadcast revenue and television broadcast revenue on a same stations basis.

     Operating  expenses  excluding  depreciation,  amortization  of  intangible
assets and amortization of deferred compensation increased to $114.7 million for
the six months  ended June 30, 1997 from $52.8  million for the six months ended
June 30, 1996, or 117.2%. The increase in expenses for the six months ended June
30,  1997 as  compared  to the six  months  ended  June 30,  1996 was  primarily
attributable to operating costs associated with the 1996 Acquisitions  (92.9% of
increase  for the six  month  period)  and an  increase  in  corporate  overhead
expenses  (6.3% of increase for the six month period)  related  primarily to the
additional expense of managing a larger base of operations.

     Broadcast  operating  income  increased to $48.0 million for the six months
ended June 30, 1997 from $28.1  million for the six months  ended June 30, 1996,
or 70.8%.  The increase in broadcast  operating  income for the six months ended
June 30, 1997 as compared  to the six months  ended June 30, 1996 was  primarily
attributable to the 1996 Acquisitions.

     Interest  expense  increased to $52.0 million for the six months ended June
30, 1997 from $27.6  million for the six months ended June 30,  1996,  or 88.4%.
The  increase  in  interest  expense  for the six  months  ended  June 30,  1997
primarily  related to indebtedness  incurred by the Company to finance the River
City  Acquisition  on May 31,  1996,  other  subsequent  1996  acquisitions  and
acquisitions  consummated in 1997 (the "1997  Acquisitions").  Subsidiary  Trust
Minority Interest Expense of $7.0 million for the six months ended June 30, 1997
is  related  to  the  HYTOPS.   Subsidiary   Trust  Minority   Interest  Expense
distributions will be partially offset by reductions in interest expense because
a  portion  of the  proceeds  of the  sale of the  HYTOPS  was  used  to  reduce
indebtedness under the Company's Bank Credit Agreement.

     Interest  and other  income  decreased  to $1.1  million for the six months
ended June 30, 1997 from $3.2 million for the six months ended June 30, 1996, or
65.6%.  This  decrease was  primarily  due to lower  average  cash  balances and
related interest income.

     The net  deferred  tax asset  increased to $8.2 million as of June 30, 1997
from  $782,000 at December 31, 1996.  The increase in the Company's net deferred
tax asset as of June 30, 1997 as compared to December 31, 1996 primarily results
from the  anticipation  that the pre-tax losses incurred in the first six months
of 1997 will be used to offset future taxable income.

     Net loss for the six months ended June 30, 1997 was $5.8 million or $(0.17)
per share  compared to net income of $1.5 million or $0.04 per share for the six
months ended June 30, 1996.

     Broadcast  cash flow  increased to $105.6  million for the six months ended
June 30, 1997 from $65.1  million  for the six months  ended June 30,  1996,  or
62.2%. This increase in broadcast cash flow primarily resulted from the 1996 and
1997 Acquisitions and, to a lesser extent,  increases in net broadcast  revenues
on a same station basis.  The Company's  broadcast cash flow margin decreased to
48.1% for the six months ended June 30, 1997 from 55.5% for the six months ended
June 30,  1996.  Excluding  the  effect of radio  station  broadcast  cash flow,
television  broadcast  cash flow  margin  decreased  to 51.2% for the six months
ended  June 30,  1997 from 56.3% for the six months  ended  June 30,  1996.  The
decrease in  broadcast  cash flow margins for the six months ended June 30, 1997
as compared to the six months ended June 30, 1996  primarily  resulted  from the
lower  margins of the acquired  radio  broadcasting  assets and lower margins of
certain television stations acquired during 1996. For television stations owned,
operated or programmed for the six months ended June 30, 1996 and the six months
ending June 30,


                                      S-26
<PAGE>

1997,  broadcast cash flow margins increased from 55.5% to 57.0%,  respectively.
This  increase  primarily  resulted  from expense  savings  related to synergies
realized from the 1996  Acquisitions  combined  with  increases in net broadcast
revenue.

     Adjusted  EBITDA  increased to $98.6  million for the six months ended June
30, 1997 from $62.0  million for the six months ended June 30,  1996,  or 59.0%.
This  increase  in  Adjusted  EBITDA for the six months  ended June 30,  1997 as
compared to the six months ended June 30, 1996  resulted  from the 1996 and 1997
Acquisitions.  The Company's  Adjusted EBITDA margin  decreased to 44.9% for the
six  months  ended June 30,  1997 from  52.8% for the six months  ended June 30,
1996.  The decrease in Adjusted  EBITDA margin for the six months ended June 30,
1997 as compared to the six months ended June 30, 1996  primarily  resulted from
operating cost  structures at certain of the acquired  stations and increases in
corporate  overhead  expenses.  The  Company  has  begun to  implement  and will
continue to implement  operating and programming  expense savings resulting from
synergies  realized from the  businesses  acquired in and prior to 1996 and 1997
and  believes  that the  benefits of the  implementation  of these  methods will
result in improvement  in broadcast cash flow margin and Adjusted  EBITDA margin
over time.

     After-tax  cash flow  increased  to $32.7  million for the six months ended
June 30, 1997 from $30.4  million  for the six months  ended June 30,  1996,  or
7.6%. The increase in after-tax cash flow for the six months ended June 30, 1997
as compared to the six months ended June 30, 1996  primarily  resulted  from the
1996 and 1997  Acquisitions  and internal growth,  offset by increased  interest
expense on the debt incurred to consummate  the 1996 and 1997  Acquisitions  and
subsidiary trust minority interest expense related to the HYTOPS Issuance during
March 1997.


YEARS ENDED DECEMBER 31, 1996 AND 1995

     Total revenues  increased to $378.5 million for the year ended December 31,
1996 from  $206.1  million  for the year  ended  December  31,  1995,  or 83.6%.
Excluding the effects of non-cash barter  transactions,  net broadcast  revenues
for the year ended  December  31,  1996  increased  by 84.4% over the year ended
December 31, 1995.  The increase in broadcast  revenues was primarily the result
of  acquisitions  and LMA  transactions  consummated by the Company in 1995 (the
"1995  Acquisitions")  and 1996.  For  stations  owned,  operated or  programmed
throughout 1995 and 1996,  television  broadcast  revenue grew 2.1% for the year
ended  December 31, 1996 when compared to the year ended  December 31, 1995. For
stations  owned,  operated or programmed  throughout  1994 and 1995,  television
broadcast  revenue grew 12.8% for the year ended December 31, 1995 when compared
to the year ended  December  31, 1994.  The  decrease in 1996 revenue  growth as
compared to 1995 revenue growth primarily  resulted from the loss in 1996 of the
Fox  affiliation  at  WTTO  in the  Birmingham  market,  the  loss  of  the  NBC
affiliation  at WRDC in the Raleigh  market and decreases in ratings at WCGV and
WNUV in the Milwaukee and Baltimore markets, respectively.

     Operating  expenses  excluding  depreciation,  amortization  of  intangible
assets  and  amortization  of  deferred   compensation  and  excess   syndicated
programming  costs  increased to $167.8  million for the year ended December 31,
1996 from $80.4  million for the year ended  December 31, 1995,  or 108.7%.  The
increase in  expenses  for the year ended  December  31, 1996 as compared to the
year ended  December  31,  1995 was  largely  attributable  to  operating  costs
associated  with  the  1995  and  1996  Acquisitions,  an  increase  in LMA fees
resulting from LMA transactions and an increase in corporate overhead expenses.

     Broadcast  operating  income  increased to $88.9 million for the year ended
December 31, 1996,  from $45.3 million for the year ended  December 31, 1995, or
96.2%.  The increase in broadcast  operating  income for the year ended December
31,  1996 as  compared  to the  year  ended  December  31,  1995  was  primarily
attributable to the 1995 and 1996 Acquisitions.

     Interest expense increased to $84.3 million for the year ended December 31,
1996 from $39.3  million for the year ended  December 31, 1995,  or 114.5%.  The
increase in interest  expense for the year ended December 31, 1996 was primarily
related to senior bank indebtedness incurred by the Company to finance the River
City Acquisition and other acquisitions.


                                      S-27
<PAGE>

     Interest  and other  income  decreased  to $3.5  million for the year ended
December  31, 1996 from $4.2 million for the year ended  December  31, 1995,  or
16.7%.  The decrease for the year ended  December 31, 1996 was  primarily due to
lower cash balances and related  interest  income  resulting  from cash payments
made in February 1996 when the Company made a $34.4 million payment  relating to
the WSMH  acquisition  and April 1996 when the Company  made a $60 million  down
payment relating to the River City Acquisition.  The decrease in interest income
was  offset by an  increase  in other  income  resulting  from the 1995 and 1996
Acquisitions.

     For the reasons described above, net income for the year ended December 31,
1996 was $1.1 million or $0.03 per share  compared to net income of $5.0 million
or $0.15 per share for the year ended December 31, 1995 before the extraordinary
loss on early extinguishment of debt.

     Broadcast cash flow increased to $189.2 million for the year ended December
31, 1996 from $111.1 million for the year ended December 31, 1995, or 70.3%. The
increase in broadcast cash flow for the year ended December 31, 1996 as compared
to the year ended  December 31, 1995  primarily  resulted from the 1995 and 1996
Acquisitions.  For stations  owned,  operated or programmed  throughout 1995 and
1996,  broadcast  cash flow grew 1.3% for the year ended  December 31, 1996 when
compared to the year ended  December 31, 1995. For stations  owned,  operated or
programmed throughout 1994 and 1995, broadcast cash flow grew 23.7% for the year
ended  December 31, 1995 when compared to the year ended  December 31, 1994. The
decrease in 1996  broadcast  cash flow growth as compared to 1995 broadcast cash
flow growth  primarily  resulted from the loss in 1996 of the Fox affiliation at
WTTO in the Birmingham  market,  the loss of the NBC  affiliation at WRDC in the
Raleigh  market and  decreases in ratings at WCGV and WNUV in the  Milwaukee and
Baltimore  markets,  respectively.  The  Company's  broadcast  cash flow  margin
decreased to 54.6% for the year ended  December 31, 1996 from 59.1% for the year
ended  December 31, 1995.  Excluding the effect of radio station  broadcast cash
flow,  television  station broadcast cash flow margin decreased to 56.7% for the
year ended  December  31, 1996 as compared to 59.1% for the year ended  December
31,  1995.  The  decrease  in  broadcast  cash flow  margins  for the year ended
December  31,  1996 as compared to the year ended  December  31, 1995  primarily
resulted from the lower margins of the acquired  radio  broadcasting  assets and
lower  margins of certain of the  acquired  television  stations.  For  stations
owned,  operated or programmed  throughout  1996 and 1995,  broadcast  cash flow
margins were  unchanged  when  comparing  the years ended  December 31, 1996 and
1995. The Company believes that margins of certain of the acquired stations will
improve as operating and programming synergies are implemented.

     Adjusted EBITDA increased to $180.3 million for the year ended December 31,
1996 from $105.8  million for the year ended  December 31, 1995,  or 70.4%.  The
increase in Adjusted  EBITDA for the year ended December 31, 1996 as compared to
the year ended  December 31, 1995 resulted from the 1995 and 1996  Acquisitions.
The  Company's  Adjusted  EBITDA  margin  decreased  to 52.0% for the year ended
December 31, 1996 from 56.3% for the year ended  December 31, 1995. The decrease
in Adjusted  EBITDA  margins for the year ended December 31, 1996 as compared to
the year ended December 31, 1995 primarily  resulted from higher operating costs
at certain of the acquired stations. The Company has begun to implement and will
continue  to  implement  operating  and  programming  synergies  throughout  the
businesses acquired in and prior to 1996. The Company believes that the benefits
of the  implementation  of these methods will result in improvement in broadcast
cash flow and Adjusted EBITDA margins in future periods.

     After-tax  cash flow increased to $76.7 million for the year ended December
31, 1996 from $51.3 million for the year ended December 31, 1995, or 49.5%.  The
increase in after-tax cash flow for the year ended December 31, 1996 as compared
to the year ended  December 31, 1995  primarily  resulted from the 1995 and 1996
Acquisitions offset by interest expense on the debt incurred to consummate these
acquisitions.


YEARS ENDED DECEMBER 31, 1995 AND 1994

     Total revenues  increased to $206.1 million for the year ended December 31,
1995,  from $129.4 million for the year ended December 31, 1994, or 59.3%.  This
increase  includes  revenues  from  the  acquisitions  of WTVZ  and WLFL and the
entering into LMA agreements with WABM and WDBB.


                                      S-28
<PAGE>

This increase also includes the first full year of revenues from the acquisition
of WCGV and WTTO and the entering into LMA agreements  with WNUV,  WVTV and FSFA
(the "1994 Acquisitions"). Excluding the effect of non-cash barter transactions,
net broadcast  revenues  increased to $187.9 million for the year ended December
31, 1995 from $118.6 million for the year ended December 31, 1994, or 58.4%.

     These  increases in net broadcast  revenues were  primarily a result of the
1994 and 1995 Acquisitions and LMA transactions  consummated by the Company,  as
well as television  broadcast  revenue growth in each of the Company's  markets.
WPGH,  the  Pittsburgh  Fox  affiliate,  achieved in excess of 14% net broadcast
revenue  growth for the year ended  December  31,  1995 as  compared to the year
ended  December 31, 1994.  This  increase was  primarily  attributable  to a new
metered  rating  service  that  began in May 1995 which  significantly  improved
WPGH's market rating.  WBFF, the Fox affiliate in Baltimore and WCGV, the former
Fox affiliate, now a UPN affiliate in Milwaukee,  both achieved in excess of 10%
net broadcast  revenue  growth as these stations began to realize the advantages
of having an LMA in these markets.

     Operating  expenses  excluding  depreciation  and  amortization and special
bonuses paid to executive officers increased to $80.4 million for the year ended
December 31, 1995 from $50.5 million for the year ended December 31, 1994. These
increases  in expenses  were  primarily  attributable  to increases in operating
expenses  relating to the 1994 and 1995  Acquisitions,  including the payment of
LMA fees  which  increased  to  approximately  $5.6  million  for the year ended
December  31, 1995 as compared to $1.1  million for the year ended  December 31,
1994.  Corporate  overhead expenses  increased 80.8% for the year ended December
31, 1995 as compared to the year ended  December  31,  1994.  This  increase was
primarily  due to  expenses  associated  with  being  a  public  company  (i.e.,
directors and officers  insurance,  travel expenses and  professional  fees) and
executive  bonus  accruals  for bonuses  which were paid based on  achieving  in
excess of 20% growth  percentages in pro forma  broadcast cash flow for the year
1995 compared to 1994.

     Broadcast  operating  income  increased to $45.3 million for the year ended
December 31, 1995 from $19.6  million for the year ended  December 31, 1994,  or
131.1%.  This increase in broadcast  operating  income was primarily a result of
the 1994 and 1995 Acquisitions and an increase in television  broadcast revenues
in each of the Company's  markets,  partially  offset by increased  amortization
expenses related to these acquisitions.

     Interest expense increased to $39.3 million for the year ended December 31,
1995 from $25.4  million for the year ended  December  31, 1994,  or 54.7%.  The
major  component of this increase in interest  expense was increased  borrowings
under the Bank  Credit  Agreement  to  finance  the 1994 and 1995  Acquisitions.
During August 1995, the Company issued $300 million of Senior Subordinated Notes
and used a portion of the net proceeds to repay outstanding  indebtedness  under
the  Bank  Credit  Agreement  and the  remainder  provided  an  increase  to the
Company's cash balances of  approximately  $91.4 million.  The interest  expense
related to these notes was  approximately  $10.0 million in 1995.  This increase
was partially  offset by the  application  of the net proceeds of an offering of
Class A Common  Stock to reduce a  portion  of the  indebtedness  under the Bank
Credit Agreement during June 1995. Interest expense was also reduced as a result
of the  application  of net cash  flow  from  operating  activities  to  further
decrease borrowings under the Bank Credit Agreement.

     Interest  and other  income  increased  to $4.2  million for the year ended
December  31, 1995 from $2.4 million for the year ended  December  31, 1994,  or
75.0%.  This increase in interest income primarily  resulted from an increase in
cash  balances  that  remained  from the proceeds of Senior  Subordinated  Notes
issued in August 1995. Income (loss) before benefit (provision) for income taxes
and  extraordinary  item increased to income of $10.2 million for the year ended
December  31, 1995 from a loss of $3.4  million for the year ended  December 31,
1994.

     Net income available to common  shareholders  improved to income of $76,000
for the year ended  December  31, 1995 from a loss of $2.7  million for the year
ended  December 31, 1994. In August 1995,  the Company  consummated  the sale of
$300 million of Senior Subordinated Notes generating net proceeds to the Company
of $293.2  million.  The net proceeds of this  offering  were  utilized to repay
outstanding  indebtedness under the Bank Credit Agreement of $201.8 million with
the remainder being


                                      S-29
<PAGE>

retained for general corporate purposes including potential future acquisitions.
In  conjunction  with the early  retirement of the  indebtedness  under the Bank
Credit Agreement, the Company recorded an extraordinary loss of $4.9 million net
of a tax benefit of $3.4 million, related to the write-off of deferred financing
costs under the Bank Credit Agreement.

     Broadcast cash flow increased to $111.1 million for the year ended December
31, 1995 from $67.5 million for the year ended December 31, 1994, or 64.6%. This
increase  in  broadcast  cash  flow  was  primarily  due to the  1994  and  1995
Acquisitions, growth in market revenues and a reduction in program payments as a
percentage  of net broadcast  revenues to 10.6% for the year ended  December 31,
1995 from 12.0% for the year ended December 31, 1994.

     Adjusted EBITDA increased to $105.8 million for the year ended December 31,
1995  from  $64.6  million  for the year  ended  December  31,  1994,  or 63.8%,
consistent with the growth in broadcast cash flow. After tax cash flow increased
to $51.3 million for the year ended December 31, 1995 from $24.9 million for the
year ended December 31, 1994, or 106.0%.


LIQUIDITY AND CAPITAL RESOURCES

     As of June 30, 1997,  the Company had $2.7  million in cash  balances and a
working capital deficit of  approximately  $9.3 million.  The Company's  working
capital deficit primarily results from the accelerated method of amortization of
program  contract  costs  and the  even  payment  streams  of  program  contract
liabilities.  Excluding the effect of current program contract costs and current
program contract  liabilities,  the Company's  working capital at June 30, 1997,
would have been $5.7 million.  The Company's primary source of liquidity is cash
provided by operations and availability  under the Bank Credit Agreement.  As of
August 11, 1997,  the Company's  cash balances were  approximately  $1.9 million
with  approximately  $254 million  available for borrowing under the Bank Credit
Agreement.  In addition, the Bank Credit Agreement provides for a Tranche C term
loan in the amount of up to $400 million  which can be utilized upon approval by
the agent bank and the raising of sufficient  commitments from banks to fund the
additional loans. In July 1997, the Company entered into a purchase agreement to
acquire the license and non-license assets of the radio and television  stations
of Heritage for $630 million and made a cash down payment of $63.0 million.  The
Company  has  entered  into a  letter  of  intent  to sell  one of the  Heritage
television  stations for $60 million (the sale of which is required  pursuant to
the  acquisition  agreement  relating to the remaining  Heritage  television and
radio  properties).  The Company  anticipates  that it will finance the Heritage
acquisition through additional bank financing  (including a draw under Tranche C
described  above) or through a  combination  of  additional  bank  financing and
proceeds from an offering of securities.

     Net cash flows from operating activities increased to $42.5 million for the
six months ended June 30, 1997 from $26.4  million for the six months ended June
30,  1996.  The  Company  made income tax  payments of $5.3  million for the six
months  ended June 30, 1997 as compared to $5.6 million for the six months ended
June  30,  1996  due  to  anticipated   tax  benefits   generated  by  the  1996
Acquisitions.  The Company made interest payments on outstanding indebtedness of
$55.7  million  during the six months  ended June 30,  1997 as compared to $29.5
million for the six months ended June 30, 1996. Additional interest payments for
the six months  ended June 30, 1997 as compared to the six months ended June 30,
1996 primarily related to additional interest costs on indebtedness  incurred to
finance  the 1996  Acquisitions.  The Company  made  subsidiary  trust  minority
interest expense payments of $6.0 million for the six months ended June 30, 1997
related to the private placement of the HYTOPS completed in March 1997.  Program
rights  payments  increased  to $26.3  million for the six months ended June 30,
1997 from $12.1  million for the six months ended June 30, 1996,  primarily as a
result of the 1996 Acquisitions.

     Net cash flows used in investing activities decreased to $112.4 million for
the six months ended June 30, 1997 from $942.1  million for the six months ended
June 30,  1996.  During  January  1997,  the Company  purchased  the license and
non-license  assets of WWFH-FM and  WILP-AM in  Wilkes-Barre,  Pennsylvania  for
approximately  $770,000.  In  January  and March  1997,  the  Company  made cash
payments of $9.0 million and $1.5  million  relating to the  acquisition  of the
license and non-license assets of KUPN-TV and WGR-AM and WWWS-AM,  respectively,
utilizing  indebtedness  under  the Bank  Credit  Agreement  and  existing  cash
balances.  In May 1997, the Company made cash payments of $78 million to acquire
the


                                      S-30
<PAGE>

license and non-license assets of KUPN-TV utilizing  indebtedness under the Bank
Credit  Agreement and existing cash  balances.  During the six months ended June
30, 1997, the Company made purchase  option  extension  payments of $6.5 million
relating to WSYX-TV.  The Company made payments totaling $8.5 million during the
six months ended June 30, 1997 in order to exercise  options to acquire  certain
FCC  licenses.  The Company made  payments  for  property and  equipment of $8.3
million  for the six months  ended June 30,  1997.  In July  1997,  the  Company
entered into a purchase  agreement to acquire the license and non-license assets
of the television and radio stations of Heritage and made a cash down payment of
$63.0 million.  The Company  anticipates  that future  requirements  for capital
expenditures will also include other  acquisitions if suitable  acquisitions can
be identified on acceptable terms and capital  expenditures  incurred during the
ordinary course of business.

     Net cash flows provided by financing  activities decreased to $70.3 million
for the six months  ended June 30, 1997 from  $807.4  million for the six months
ended June 30, 1996. In March 1997, the Company completed a private placement of
the HYTOPS.  The  Company  utilized  $135  million of the  approximately  $193.4
million  net  proceeds  of the HYTOPS  Issuance  to repay  outstanding  debt and
retained the remainder for general corporate purposes. The Company made payments
totaling $4.6 million to repurchase  186,000  shares of Class A Common Stock for
the six months ended June 30, 1997.  In May 1997,  the Company made  payments of
$4.7  million  related to the  amendment  of its Bank Credit  Agreement.  In the
fourth  quarter of 1996,  the Company  negotiated  the  prepayment of syndicated
program contract  liabilities for excess syndicated  programming  assets. In the
first  quarter of 1997,  the Company  made final cash  payments of $1.4  million
related to these  negotiations.  In July 1997, the Company issued the 1997 Notes
using  $162.5  million  of the  approximately  $196  million  proceeds  to repay
outstanding  indebtedness  under the revolving  credit  facility  under the Bank
Credit  Agreement  and using the  remainder  to pay a portion of the $63 million
cash down payment relating to the Heritage Acquisition.

     The Company anticipates that funds from operations,  existing cash balances
and  availability  of the  revolving  credit  facility  under  the  Bank  Credit
Agreement will be sufficient to meet its working  capital,  capital  expenditure
commitments and debt service  requirements for the foreseeable future.  However,
to the  extent  such  funds are not  sufficient,  or if the  Company  commits to
additional capital expenditures (including additional acquisitions), the Company
may need to incur additional  indebtedness,  refinance existing  indebtedness or
raise funds from the sale of additional  equity.  The Bank Credit  Agreement and
the indentures  relating to the Company's 9% Senior Subordinated Notes due 2007,
10% Senior  Subordinated  Notes due 2003 and 10% Senior  Subordinated  Notes due
2005 restrict the incurrence of additional  indebtedness and the use of proceeds
of an equity issuance.  On August 22, 1997, the Company filed a $1 billion shelf
registration  statement  covering the issuance of the Company's debt securities,
preferred stock and common stock.  The shares of Class A Common Stock offered in
the Common Stock Offering and the shares of Convertible  Exchangeable  Preferred
Stock offered in the Preferred Stock Offering are offered pursuant to such shelf
registration  statement.  A portion of the net  proceeds to the Company from the
Offerings will be used to repay existing  borrowings  under the revolving credit
facility under the Bank Credit Agreement,  and the remainder of the net proceeds
will be  retained  by the Company  for  general  corporate  purposes,  including
funding the Heritage  Acquisition,  which is  anticipated  to close in the first
quarter  of  1998,  and  other  acquisitions  if  suitable  acquisitions  can be
identified on acceptable  terms. The Company has requested the lenders under the
Bank Credit  Agreement to approve an amendment  that would  recharacterize  $275
million of indebtedness  from the Tranche A term loan to amounts owing under the
revolving credit facility.  If this amendment is approved,  the Company will use
all of the net proceeds of the  Offerings to repay  indebtedness  under the Bank
Credit  Agreement.  See "Use of  Proceeds"  and  "Business  of  Sinclair  - 1997
Acquisitions." 


INCOME TAXES

     Income tax benefit  increased to $4.1 million for the six months ended June
30, 1997 from a  provision  of $2.1  million  for the six months  ended June 30,
1996.  The Company's  effective tax rate decreased to a benefit of 41.3% for the
six months  ended  June 30,  1997 from a  provision  of 58.2% for the six months
ended June 30, 1996. The net deferred tax asset  increased to $8.2 million as of
June 30, 1997 from $782,000 at December 31, 1996.  The increase in the Company's
net  deferred  tax asset as of June 30, 1997 as  compared  to December  31, 1996
primarily resulted from the anticipation that the pre-tax losses incurred in the
first six months of 1997 will be used to offset future taxable income.


                                      S-31
<PAGE>

     The Company's  income tax provision  increased to $6.9 million for the year
ended  December 31, 1996 from $5.2 million for the year ended December 31, 1995.
The Company's  effective tax rate  increased to 86% for the year ended  December
31, 1996 from 51% for the year ended  December  31,  1995.  The increase for the
year ended  December  31, 1996 as compared to the year ended  December  31, 1995
primarily  related to certain  financial  reporting  and income tax  differences
attributable  to certain 1995 and 1996  Acquisitions,  and state franchise taxes
which are independent of pre-tax income.

     The net  deferred  tax asset  decreased to $782,000 as of December 31, 1996
from $21.0  million at December 31,  1995.  The  decrease in the  Company's  net
deferred  tax asset as of December  31, 1996 as compared to December 31, 1995 is
primarily due to the Company recording deferred tax liabilities of $18.1 million
relating to the acquisition of all of the  outstanding  stock of Superior in May
1996,   adjustments   related  to  certain  1995  acquisitions,   and  resulting
differences between the book and tax basis of the underlying assets.

     A $1.8 million net tax provision and a $647,000 tax benefit was  recognized
for the years ended December 31, 1995 and December 31, 1994,  respectively.  The
provision  for the year ended  December  31, 1995 was  comprised of $5.2 million
provision relating to the Company's income before provision for income taxes and
extraordinary  item offset by a $3.4 million income tax benefit  relating to the
extraordinary  loss on early  extinguishment  of  debt.  The  $5.2  million  tax
provision  reflects a 51%  effective  tax rate for the year ended  December  31,
1995,   which  is  higher  than  the  statutory   rate   primarily  due  to  the
non-deductibility  of goodwill  relating to the  repurchase  of Common  Stock in
1990.  The income tax benefit for the year ended  December 31, 1994 was 19.1% of
the  Company's  loss  before  income  taxes,  which  is lower  than the  benefit
calculated  at  statutory  rates  primarily  due  to   non-deductible   goodwill
amortization.  After giving effect to these changes the Company had net deferred
tax assets of $21.0  million at December 31, 1995 and $12.5  million at December
31, 1994, respectively.


SEASONALITY

     The Company's results usually are subject to seasonal  fluctuations,  which
result in fourth quarter  broadcast  operating income usually being greater than
first,  second and third quarter broadcast operating income. This seasonality is
primarily  attributable to increased expenditures by advertisers in anticipation
of holiday season spending and an increase in viewership during this period.


                                      S-32
<PAGE>

                               INDUSTRY OVERVIEW


TELEVISION BROADCASTING

     Commercial   television   stations  in  the  United  States  are  typically
affiliated with one of six television networks, which are at different stages of
development.   The  networks  are  differentiated  in  part  by  the  amount  of
programming  they provide their  affiliates  each week and by the length of time
they have been in operation. These networks are ABC, CBS, NBC, FOX, WB, and UPN.
The ABC, CBS, and NBC networks (the  "Traditional  Networks") have a substantial
number of affiliated  stations,  have been in operation for the longest time and
provide the majority of their affiliates'  programming each day. Fox established
an affiliate  network in the mid-`80s and provides fewer hours of prime-time and
daytime  programming  than the  Traditional  Networks.  WB and UPN,  the  newest
television networks,  will soon increase their prime-time programming from three
to four nights and also provide a number of hours of children's programming each
week. Television stations affiliated with Fox, WB, or UPN have more hours of the
day to  program  and  consequently  have more  commercial  inventory  to sell to
advertisers.

     Each   Traditional   Network  provides  the  majority  of  its  affiliates'
programming  each day without  charge in exchange for a substantial  majority of
the  available  advertising  time in the  programs  supplied.  Each  Traditional
Network  sells this  advertising  time and retains the  revenue.  The  affiliate
receives  compensation from the Traditional Network and retains the revenue from
time sold during breaks in and between  network  programs and in programming the
affiliate produces or purchases from non-network sources.

     In contrast,  a station that is not affiliated  with a Traditional  Network
supplies  over-the-air  programming  by acquiring  rights to broadcast  programs
through syndication.  This syndicated  programming is generally acquired by such
stations for cash and barter.  Those  stations  that  acquire a program  through
syndication  are  usually  given  exclusive  rights to show the  program  in the
station's  market  for either a period of years or a number of  episodes  agreed
upon  between  the  station  and the  syndicator  of the  programming.  Types of
syndicated  programs aired on these  stations  include  feature  films,  popular
series  previously  shown on network  television and series  produced for direct
distribution to television stations.

     Fox has  established  a network of  television  stations that operates on a
basis similar to the  Traditional  Networks.  However,  the 15 hours per week of
prime-time  programming supplied by Fox to its affiliates are significantly less
than that of the Traditional  Networks and, as a result, Fox affiliates retain a
significantly  higher  portion of the available  inventory of broadcast time for
their own use than Traditional Network affiliates.  As of December 31, 1996, Fox
had 169 affiliated stations broadcasting to 95.0% of U.S. television households.

     During 1994, WB established  an  affiliation of independent  stations which
began  broadcasting  in January  1995 and  operates  on a basis  similar to Fox.
However, WB currently supplies only six hours of prime-time programming per week
to its affiliates (which will increase to eight hours per week in January 1998),
which is  significantly  less than that of Fox and, as a result,  WB  affiliates
retain a  significantly  higher portion of the available  inventory of broadcast
time for their own use than affiliates of Fox or the Traditional Networks. As of
December 31, 1996, WB had 96 affiliated  stations  broadcasting to 86.0% of U.S.
television households, including cable coverage provided by WGN-TV.

     During 1994, UPN  established  an  affiliation  of  independent  television
stations  that began  broadcasting  in January  1995.  The amount of  prime-time
programming  supplied by UPN to its affiliates in January 1997 was six hours per
week,  which will be  increased in the 1997 fall season to eight hours per week.
As of December 31, 1996, UPN had 91 affiliated stations broadcasting to 73.9% of
U.S. television households, excluding secondary affiliations.

     Television  stations  derive  their  revenues  primarily  from  the sale of
national,  regional  and local  advertising.  All  network-affiliated  stations,
including  those  affiliated  with Fox and  others,  are  required to carry spot
advertising  sold by their  networks.  This  reduces  the amount of  advertising
available  for  sale  directly  by  the  network-affiliated   stations.  Network
affiliates  generally are compensated for the broadcast of network  advertising.
The  compensation  paid  is  negotiated,  station-by-station,  based  on a fixed
formula,  subject  to certain  adjustments.  Stations  directly  sell all of the
remaining advertising to be


                                      S-33
<PAGE>

inserted  in  network  programming  and all of the  advertising  in  non-network
programming,  retaining  all  of the  revenues  received  from  these  sales  of
advertising,  less any  commissions  paid.  Through barter and  cash-plus-barter
arrangements,  however,  a national  syndicated  program  distributor  typically
retains a portion of the available advertising time for programming it supplies,
in exchange for no or reduced fees to the station for such programming.

     Advertisers  wishing to reach a national  audience  usually  purchase  time
directly  from  the  Traditional  Networks,  the Fox  network,  UPN,  or WB,  or
advertise nationwide on an ad hoc basis.  National advertisers who wish to reach
a particular regional or local audience buy advertising time directly from local
stations through national advertising sales representative firms.  Additionally,
local  businesses  purchase  advertising  time directly from the stations' local
sales staff.  Advertising rates are based upon factors which include the size of
the DMA in which the station operates,  a program's popularity among the viewers
that an advertiser  wishes to attract,  the number of advertisers  competing for
the  available  time,  demographic  characteristics  of the  DMA  served  by the
station,  the  availability  of  alternative   advertising  media  in  the  DMA,
aggressive  and  knowledgeable  sales  forces and the  development  of projects,
features and marketing  programs that tie  advertiser  messages to  programming.
Because broadcast television stations rely on advertising revenues,  declines in
advertising budgets, particularly in recessionary periods, will adversely affect
the  broadcast  business.  Conversely,  increases  in  advertising  budgets  may
contribute to an increase in the revenue and operating cash flow of a particular
broadcast television station.

     Information  regarding  competition in the television broadcast industry is
set forth under "Business of Sinclair - Competition."


RADIO BROADCASTING

     The  primary  source  of  revenues  for  radio  stations  is  the  sale  of
advertising  time to local and national spot  advertisers  and national  network
advertisers.  During the past decade,  local advertising revenue as a percentage
of  total  radio  advertising   revenue  in  a  given  market  has  ranged  from
approximately 79% to 82%. The growth in total radio advertising revenue tends to
be  fairly  stable  and has  generally  grown at a rate  faster  than the  Gross
Domestic Product ("GDP").  Total domestic radio  advertising  revenue reached an
all-time  record of $12.3 billion in 1996, as reported by the Radio  Advertising
Bureau (the "RAB").

     According to the RAB's Radio Marketing Guide and Fact Book for Advertisers,
1997, radio reaches  approximately 95% of all Americans over the age of 12 every
week.  More than one half of all radio  listening is done  outside the home,  in
contrast  to  other  advertising   media.  The  average  adult  listener  spends
approximately  three hours and 20 minutes per weekday  listening to radio.  Most
radio  listening  occurs  during the  morning,  particularly  between the time a
listener  wakes up and the time the listener  reaches work.  This "morning drive
time"  period  reaches  more  than 80% of  people  over the age of 12 and,  as a
result,  radio advertising sold during this period achieves premium  advertising
rates.  Radio  listeners  have  gradually  shifted  over the years from AM to FM
stations.  FM  reception,  as compared to AM, is generally  clearer and provides
greater total range and higher fidelity, except for so-called "clear channel" AM
radio  stations,  which have the maximum range of any type of station and can be
very  successful  in the  news/talk/sports  format.  In  comparison  to AM, FM's
listener  share is now in excess of 75%,  despite the fact that the number of AM
and FM commercial stations in the United States is approximately equal.

     Radio  is  considered  an  efficient,   cost-effective  means  of  reaching
specifically identified demographic groups. Stations are typically classified by
their on-air format, such as country, adult contemporary,  oldies and news/talk.
A  station's  format  and style of  presentation  enable  it to  target  certain
demographics.  By  capturing  a  specific  share of a market's  radio  listening
audience, with particular concentration in a targeted demographic,  a station is
able to market its broadcasting time to advertisers  seeking to reach a specific
audience.  Advertisers and stations utilize data published by audience measuring
services,  such as  Arbitron,  to  estimate  how many people  within  particular
geographical markets and demographics listen to specific stations.

     The number of  advertisements  that can be broadcast  without  jeopardizing
listening levels (and the resulting ratings) is limited in part by the format of
a particular station and the local competitive envi-


                                      S-34
<PAGE>

ronment.  Although the number of  advertisements  broadcast  during a given time
period may vary,  the total number of  advertisements  broadcast on a particular
station generally does not vary significantly from year to year.

     A  station's  local  sales staff  generates  the  majority of its local and
regional  advertising  sales through direct  solicitations of local  advertising
agencies and  businesses.  To generate  national  advertising  sales,  a station
usually will engage a firm that  specializes  in  soliciting  radio  advertising
sales on a national level.  National sales  representatives  obtain  advertising
principally from  advertising  agencies located outside the station's market and
receive commissions based on the revenue from the advertising obtained.

     Information  regarding  competition in the radio broadcast  industry is set
forth under "Business of Sinclair - Competition."


                                      S-35
<PAGE>

                             BUSINESS OF SINCLAIR

     The Company is a  diversified  broadcasting  company  that owns or provides
programming  services  to more  television  stations  than any other  commercial
broadcasting  group in the United States. The Company currently owns or provides
programming  services  pursuant  to  Local  Marketing  Agreements  (LMAs)  to 29
television  stations,  has pending  acquisitions of four  additional  television
stations,  and has pending  acquisitions of the rights to provide programming to
two additional  television stations.  The Company believes it is also one of the
top 20 radio groups in the United  States,  when measured by the total number of
radio  stations  owned.  The  Company  owns  27  radio  stations,   has  pending
acquisitions  of 24 radio  stations,  and has  options to acquire an  additional
seven radio stations.

     The 29  television  stations the Company owns or programs  pursuant to LMAs
are located in 21 geographically diverse markets, with 23 of the stations in the
top 51 television DMAs in the United States.  The Company's  television  station
group is diverse in network affiliation,  with ten stations affiliated with Fox,
12 with UPN, three with WB, two with ABC and one with CBS. One station  operates
as an  independent.  The Company has recently  entered into an agreement with WB
pursuant to which eight of its stations  would switch  affiliations  to, and one
independent  station would become affiliated with, WB. In addition,  the Company
has  notified  UPN of its  non-renewal  of  affiliation  with  respect  to three
additional stations, which will either operate as independents or enter into new
affiliation   agreements  with  UPN  or  another  network.   See  "-  Television
Broadcasting - Programming and Affiliations," below.

     The Company's  radio station  group is also  geographically  diverse with a
variety of  programming  formats  including  country,  urban,  news/talk/sports,
album/progressive  rock and adult contemporary.  Of the 27 stations owned by the
Company,  12  broadcast  on the AM band and 15 on the FM band.  The Company owns
from two to eight stations in all but one of the seven radio markets it serves.

     The Company has undergone rapid and  significant  growth over the course of
the last six years. Since 1991, the Company has increased the number of stations
it owns or provides services to from three television  stations to 29 television
stations and 27 radio  stations.  From 1991 to 1996, net broadcast  revenues and
Adjusted  EBITDA  increased  from $39.7 million to $346.5 million and from $15.5
million to $180.3 million, respectively. Pro forma for the 1996 Acquisitions and
the Heritage Acquisition,  1996 net broadcast revenues and Adjusted EBITDA would
have been $532.4 million and $246.3 million, respectively.


                                      S-36
<PAGE>

TELEVISION BROADCASTING

     The Company owns and  operates,  provides  programming  services to, or has
agreed to acquire the following television stations:


<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
                                                                                           NUMBER OF
                                                                                          COMMERCIAL                 EXPIRATION
                               MARKET                                                     STATIONS IN    STATION      DATE OF
           MARKET              RANK(A)   STATIONS   STATUS(B)    CHANNEL   AFFILIATION   THE MARKET(C)   RANK(D)    FCC LICENSE
- ----------------------------- --------- ---------- ------------ --------- ------------- --------------- --------- ----------------
<S>                              <C>       <C>         <C>         <C>         <C>             <C>        <C>         <C>
Pittsburgh, Pennsylvania  ...     19       WPGH        O&O         53          FOX             6           4           8/1/99
                                           WPTT        LMA         22          UPN                         5           8/1/99
Sacramento, California ......     20       KOVR        O&O         13          CBS             8           3           2/1/98
St. Louis, Missouri .........     21       KDNL        O&O         30          ABC             7           5           2/1/98
Baltimore, Maryland .........     23       WBFF        O&O         45          FOX             5           4          10/1/04
                                           WNUV        LMA         54          UPN                         5          10/1/04
Indianapolis, Indiana  ......     25       WTTV        LMA(e)       4          UPN             8           4           8/1/97 (f)
                                           WTTK        LMA(e)(g)   29          UPN                         4           8/1/97 (f)
Raleigh-Durham,
 North Carolina  ............     29       WLFL        O&O         22          FOX             5           3          12/1/04
                                           WRDC        LMA         28          UPN                         5          12/1/04
Cincinnati, Ohio ............     30       WSTR        O&O         64          UPN             5           5          10/1/97 (f)
Milwaukee, Wisconsin   ......     31       WCGV        O&O         24          UPN             6           4          12/1/97 (f)
                                           WVTV        LMA         18          WB                          5          12/1/97 (f)
Kansas City, Missouri  ......     32       KSMO        O&O         62          UPN             5           5           2/1/98
Columbus, Ohio   ............     34       WTTE        O&O         28          FOX             5           4          10/1/97 (f)
Asheville, North Carolina
 and Greenville/
 Spartanburg/Anderson,
 South Carolina     .........     35       WFBC        LMA         40          IND(h)          6           5          12/1/04
                                           WLOS        O&O         13          ABC             6           3          12/0/04
San Antonio, Texas  .........     38       KABB        O&O         29          FOX             7           4           8/1/98
                                           KRRT        LMA         35          UPN                         6           8/1/98
Norfolk, Virginia   .........     40       WTVZ        O&O         33          FOX             6           4          10/1/04
Oklahoma City,
 Oklahoma  ..................     43       KOCB        O&O         34          UPN             7           5           6/1/98
Birmingham, Alabama .........     51       WTTO        O&O         21          WB              5           4           4/1/05
                                           WABM        LMA         68          UPN                         5           4/1/05
Charleston and Hunting-
 ton, West Virginia               56       WCHS        Pending      8          ABC             4           3          10/01/04
Mobile, Alabama and
 Pensacola, Florida .........     61       WEAR        Pending      3          ABC             6           2           2/01/05
                                           WFGX        Pending(i)  35          WB                          6           2/01/05
Flint/Saginaw/Bay City,
 Michigan  ..................     62       WSMH        O&O         66          FOX             5           4           10/1/97 (f)
Las Vegas, Nevada   .........     64       KUPN        O&O         21          UPN             8           5           10/1/98
Lexington, Kentucky .........     68       WDKY        O&O         56          FOX             5           4            8/1/05
Des Moines, Iowa ............     71       KDSM        O&O         17          FOX             4           4            2/1/98
Burlington, Vermont and
 Plattsburgh, New York       .    91       WPTZ        Pending      5          NBC             4           2            6/1/99
                                           WNNE        Pending(j)  31          NBC                         3            4/1/99
                                           WFFF        Pending(i)  44          FOX                          (k)               (k)
Peoria/Bloomington,
 Illinois  ..................    110       WYZZ        O&O         43          FOX             4           4           12/1/97 (f)
Tuscaloosa, Alabama .........    185       WDBB        LMA(l)      17          WB              2           2            4/1/05
</TABLE>

                          (footnotes on following page)


- ----------

                                      S-37
<PAGE>

(a) Rankings  are based on the  relative  size of a station's  DMA among the 211
    generally recognized DMAs in the United States as estimated by Nielsen.

(b) "O&O" refers to stations owned and operated by the Company,  "LMA" refers to
    stations to which the Company provides  programming  services pursuant to an
    LMA and "Pending" refers to stations the Company has agreed to acquire.
    See "- 1997 Acquisitions."

(c) Represents  the  number of  television  stations  designated  by  Nielsen as
    "local" to the DMA, excluding public television  stations and stations which
    do not meet the  minimum  Nielsen  reporting  standards  (weekly  cumulative
    audience of at least 2.5%) for the Sunday-Saturday, 6:00 a.m.
    to 2:00 a.m. time period.

(d) The rank of each  station  in its  market is based  upon the  November  1996
    Nielsen  estimates of the percentage of persons tuned to each station in the
    market from 6:00 a.m. to 2:00 a.m., Sunday-Saturday.

(e) Non-License  Assets  acquired  from River City  Broadcasting,  L.P.  ("River
    City") and option  exercised to acquire License Assets will become owned and
    operated  upon FCC  approval of  transfer  of License  Assets and closing of
    acquisition of License Assets.

(f) License renewal application pending.

(g) WTTK  currently  simulcasts  all of the  programming  aired  on WTTV and the
    station rank applies to the combined viewership of these stations.

(h) "IND" or  "Independent"  refers to a station that is not affiliated with any
  of ABC, CBS, NBC, Fox, WB or UPN.

(i)  The  Company  will  provide  programming  services  to  this  station  upon
completion of the Heritage Acquisition.

(j) WNNE currently simulcasts the programming broadcast on WPTZ.

(k) This station began  broadcast  operations in August 1997 pursuant to program
    test  authority  and does not yet have a license.  This  station has not yet
    established a rank.

(l) WDBB simulcasts the programming broadcast on WTTO.


Operating Strategy

     The  Company's  television  operating  strategy  includes the following key
elements:


Attracting Viewership

     The  Company  seeks to attract  viewership  and expand its  audience  share
through selective, high-quality programming.

     Popular  Programming.  The Company  believes  that an  important  factor in
attracting  viewership to its stations is their network  affiliations  with Fox,
WB, ABC, CBS and UPN. These  affiliations  enable the Company to attract viewers
by  virtue of the  quality  first-run  original  programming  provided  by these
networks and the networks' promotion of such programming. The Company also seeks
to  obtain,  at  attractive  prices,  popular  syndicated  programming  that  is
complementary  to  the  station's  network  affiliation.   Examples  of  popular
syndicated  programming obtained by the Company for broadcast on its Fox, WB and
UPN affiliates and  Independent  stations are "Mad About You,"  "Frasier,"  "The
Simpsons,"   "Home   Improvement"   and   "Seinfeld."  In  addition  to  network
programming,  the Company's ABC and CBS affiliates broadcast news magazine, talk
show, and game show  programming such as "Hard Copy,"  "Entertainment  Tonight,"
"Regis and Kathie Lee," "Wheel of Fortune" and "Jeopardy."

     Children's  Programming.  The  Company  seeks to be a leader in  children's
programming in each of its respective DMAs. The Company's nationally  recognized
"Kids  Club" was the  forerunner  and model for the Fox  network-wide  marketing
efforts promoting  children's  programming.  Sinclair carries the Fox Children's
Network ("FCN") and WB's and UPN's children's programming,  all of which include
significant  amounts  of  animated  programming  throughout  the week.  In those
markets  where the Company owns or programs ABC or CBS  affiliates,  the Company
broadcasts those networks' animated programming during weekends.  In addition to
this  animated  programming,  the Company  broadcasts  other forms of children's
programming, which may be produced by the Company or by an affiliated network.

     Counter-Programming.  The  Company's  programming  strategy on its Fox, WB,
UPN   and   Independent  stations  also  includes  "counter-programming,"  which
consists  of  broadcasting  programs  that  are  alternatives  to  the  types of
programs being shown concurrently on competing stations. This strategy is


                                      S-38
<PAGE>

designed to attract  additional  audience share in demographic groups not served
by  concurrent  programming  on competing  stations.  The Company  believes that
implementation  of this  strategy  enables its  stations to achieve  competitive
rankings in households in the 18-49 and 25-54  demographics and to offer greater
diversity of programming in each of its DMAs.

     Local News. The Company  believes that the production and  broadcasting  of
local news can be an important link to the community and an aid to the station's
efforts to expand its  viewership.  In  addition,  local  news  programming  can
provide access to advertising  sources targeted  specifically to local news. The
Company carefully assesses the anticipated benefits and costs of producing local
news prior to introduction at a Company station because a significant investment
in capital equipment is required and substantial operating expenses are incurred
in  introducing,  developing and producing local news  programming.  The Company
currently provides local news programming at WBFF and WNUV in Baltimore, WLFL in
Raleigh/Durham, KDNL in St. Louis, KABB in San Antonio, KOVR in Sacramento, WPGH
in Pittsburgh and WLOS in Asheville.  The Company also  broadcasts news programs
on WDKY in  Lexington,  which are  produced  in part by the  Company and in part
through the purchase of production  services from an independent third party and
on WTTV in  Indianapolis,  which are produced by a third party in exchange for a
limited  number of  advertising  spots.  River City  provides  the Company  news
production  services with respect to the production of news  programming  and on
air  talent on WTTE.  Pursuant  to an  agreement,  River City  provides  certain
services to the Company in return for a fee equal to approximately  $416,000 per
year. The possible  introduction of local news at the other Company  stations is
reviewed  periodically.   The  Company's  policy  is  to  institute  local  news
programming  at a specific  station only if the expected  benefits of local news
programming at the station are believed to exceed the associated  costs after an
appropriate start-up period.

     Popular  Sporting  Events.  The  Company  attempts  to capture a portion of
advertising  dollars  designated to sports  programming  in selected  DMAs.  The
Company's WB and UPN affiliated and  independent  stations  generally face fewer
restrictions  on   broadcasting   live  local  sporting  events  than  do  their
competitors  that are affiliates of the major networks and Fox since  affiliates
of the major networks and Fox are subject to prohibitions against preemptions of
network  programming.  The Company has been able to acquire the local television
broadcast rights for certain sporting  events,  including NBA basketball,  Major
League Baseball, NFL football, NHL hockey, ACC basketball,  Big Ten football and
basketball,   and  SEC  football.   The  Company  seeks  to  expand  its  sports
broadcasting  in  DMAs as  profitable  opportunities  arise.  In  addition,  the
Company's  stations that are affiliated with Fox, ABC and CBS broadcast  certain
Major League Baseball games,  NFL football games and NHL hockey games as well as
other popular sporting events.


Innovative Local Sales and Marketing

     The  Company  believes  that it is able to attract new  advertisers  to its
stations and increase its share of existing  customers'  advertising  budgets by
creating a sense of partnership  with those  advertisers.  The Company  develops
such relationships by training its sales forces to offer new marketing ideas and
campaigns to  advertisers.  These  campaigns  often involve the  sponsorship  by
advertisers of local  promotional  events that capitalize on the station's local
identity  and  programming  franchises.  For example,  several of the  Company's
stations  stage local "Kids Fairs" which allow station  advertisers to reinforce
their on-air  advertising with their target  audience.  Through its strong local
sales and marketing  focus,  the Company seeks to capture an increasing share of
its revenues from local  sources,  which are generally more stable than national
advertising.


Control of Operating and Programming Costs

     By employing a disciplined approach to managing programming acquisition and
other  costs,  the Company has been able to achieve  operating  margins that the
Company believes are among the highest in the television broadcast industry. The
Company has sought and will continue to seek to acquire quality  programming for
prices  at or  below  prices  paid in the  past.  As an  owner  or  provider  of
programming  services to 29 stations in 21 DMAs  reaching  approximately  15% of
U.S. television households (without giving effect to the Heritage  Acquisition),
the  Company  believes  that it is able to  negotiate  favorable  terms  for the
acquisition of programming.  Moreover, the Company emphasizes control of each of
its stations'  programming and operating costs through  program-specific  profit
analysis,  detailed  budgeting,  tight control over staffing levels and detailed
long-term planning models.


                                      S-39
<PAGE>

Attract and Retain High Quality Management

     The  Company  believes  that much of its  success is due to its  ability to
attract and retain highly skilled and motivated managers,  both at the corporate
and local  station  levels.  A portion of the  compensation  provided to general
managers,  sales managers and other station managers is based on their achieving
certain operating  results.  The Company also provides its corporate and station
managers with deferred  compensation  plans offering  options to acquire Class A
Common Stock.


Community Involvement

     Each of the Company's  stations actively  participates in various community
activities and offers many community services.  The Company's activities include
broadcasting  programming  of local  interest and  sponsorship  of community and
charitable  events.  The Company also encourages its station employees to become
active members of their communities and to promote  involvement in community and
charitable  affairs.  The Company believes that active community  involvement by
its stations  provides its stations with increased  exposure in their respective
DMAs and ultimately increases viewership and advertising support.


Establish LMAs

     The Company  believes  that it can attain  significant  growth in operating
cash flow through the utilization of LMAs. By expanding its presence in a market
in which it owns a station,  the Company can  improve its  competitive  position
with respect to a  demographic  sector.  In addition,  by providing  programming
services to an  additional  station in a market,  the Company is able to realize
significant economies of scale in marketing,  programming,  overhead and capital
expenditures. The Company provides programming services pursuant to an LMA to an
additional  station in seven of the 21  television  markets in which the Company
owns or programs a station.


Programming and Affiliations

     The Company  continually  reviews its existing  programming  inventory  and
seeks to purchase the most  profitable and  cost-effective  syndicated  programs
available  for each time period.  In  developing  its  selection  of  syndicated
programming, the Company balances the cost of available syndicated programs with
their  potential to increase  advertising  revenue and the risk of their reduced
popularity  during  the  term of the  program  contract.  The  Company  seeks to
purchase only those programs with  contractual  periods that permit  programming
flexibility and which complement a station's  overall  programming  strategy and
counter-programming  strategy.  Programs that can perform  successfully  in more
than  one  time  period  are  more  attractive  due to the  long  lead  time and
multi-year commitments inherent in program purchasing.

     Twenty-eight  of the 29 television  stations owned or provided  programming
services by the Company  currently  operate as affiliates of Fox (ten stations),
UPN (twelve  stations),  ABC (two  stations),  WB (three  stations)  or CBS (one
station).  The networks produce and distribute  programming in exchange for each
station's  commitment  to  air  the  programming  at  specified  times  and  for
commercial announcement time during the programming. In addition, networks other
than Fox and UPN pay each  affiliated  station a fee for each  network-sponsored
program broadcast by the stations.

     On August 21, 1996,  the Company  entered  into an agreement  with Fox (the
"Fox  Agreement")  which,  among other  things,  provides  that the  affiliation
agreements between Fox and eight stations owned or provided programming services
by the Company  (except as noted below)  would be amended to have new  five-year
terms commencing on the date of the Fox Agreement.  Fox has the option to extend
the affiliation agreements for additional five-year terms and must extend all of
the  affiliation  agreements if it extends any (except that Fox may  selectively
renew  affiliation  agreements  if any  station  has  breached  its  affiliation
agreement). The Fox Agreement also provides that the Company will have the right
to  purchase,  for fair  market  value,  any  station  Fox  acquires in a market
currently  served by a Company-owned  Fox affiliate  (other than the Norfolk and
Raleigh-Durham markets) if Fox determines to terminate the affiliation agreement
with the  Company's  station in that market and operate the station  acquired by
Fox as a Fox  affiliate.  The  Fox  Agreement  confirmed  that  the  affiliation
agreements for WTVZ-TV (Norfolk, Virginia) and WLFL-TV


                                      S-40
<PAGE>

(Raleigh, North Carolina) will terminate August 31, 1998. The Fox Agreement also
includes  provisions  limiting  the  ability  of  the  Company  to  preempt  Fox
programming  except  where it has  existing  programming  conflicts or where the
Company preempts to serve a public purpose.

     The  Company's  affiliation  agreements  with  ABC for KDNL and WLOS in St.
Louis and  Asheville,  respectively,  have ten-year  terms  expiring in 2005 and
2004,  respectively.  Each of the Company's  current UPN affiliation  agreements
expires in January 1998 unless renewed by the Company.

     On July 4, 1997, the Company entered into an agreement with WB, pursuant to
which the Company agreed that certain  stations  currently  affiliated  with UPN
would  terminate  their  affiliations  with  UPN  at  the  end  of  the  current
affiliation  term in January 1998, and would enter into  affiliation  agreements
with WB  effective  as of that  date.  The  Company  has  advised  UPN  that the
following  stations owned or provided  programming  services by the Company will
not renew their  affiliation  agreements  with UPN when the  current  agreements
expire  on  January  15,  1998:  WPTT-TV,  Pittsburgh,   Pennsylvania,  WNUV-TV,
Baltimore,  Maryland.  WSTR-TV,  Cincinnati,  Ohio, KRRT-TV, San Antonio, Texas,
KOCB-TV, Oklahoma City, Oklahoma,  KSMO-TV, Kansas City, Missouri,  KUPN-TV, Las
 Vegas, Nevada, WCGV-TV, Milwaukee,  Wisconsin, WABM-TV, Birmingham, Alabama,
and WTTV-TV/WTTK-TV,  Indianapolis, Indiana. These stations (other than WCGV-TV,
KSMO-TV and WABM-TV, which will either operate as independents or enter into new
affiliation  agreements  with UPN or another  network)  will enter into ten-year
affiliation  agreements  with WB  beginning  on January  16,  1998  (other  than
WTTV-TV/WTTK-TV,  with  respect to which the  affiliation  agreement  will begin
January 11, 1999 and end January 15, 2008). Pursuant to the WB Agreement, the WB
affiliation   agreements  of  WVTV-TV,   Milwaukee,   Wisconsin,   and  WTTO-TV,
Birmingham,  Alabama (whose  programming is simulcasted on WDBB-TV,  Tuscaloosa,
Alabama),  have been  extended  to January 16,  2008.  In  addition,  WFBC-TV in
Greenville,  South Carolina will become  affiliated  with WB on November 1, 1999
when WB's  current  affiliation  with  another  station in that market  expires.
WTVZ-TV,  Norfolk,  Virginia and WLFL-TV,  Raleigh, North Carolina,  will become
affiliated  with  WB  when  their  affiliations  with  Fox  expire.   These  Fox
affiliations are scheduled to expire on August 31, 1998. 

     Under the terms of the WB  Agreement,  WB has agreed to pay the Company $64
million in aggregate amount in monthly installments during the first eight years
commencing on January 16, 1998 in  consideration  for entering into  affiliation
agreements  with WB. In addition,  WB will be obligated to pay an additional $10
million  aggregate  amount in monthly  installments in each of the following two
years  provided  that  WB is in  the  business  of  supplying  programming  as a
television network during each of those years.

     In August 1997,  UPN filed an action in Los Angeles  Superior Court against
the Company,  seeking  declaratory  relief and specific  performance  or, in the
alternative,  unspecified  damages and alleging that neither the Company nor its
affiliates  provided  proper notice of their intention not to extend the current
UPN affiliations  beyond January 15, 1998.  Certain  subsidiaries of the Company
have filed an action in the Circuit Court for Baltimore City seeking declaratory
relief that their notice was effective to terminate the  affiliations on January
15, 1998.

     Each of the  affiliation  agreements  relating to stations  involved in the
River City  Acquisition  (other  than River  City's Fox and ABC  affiliates)  is
terminable  by the network upon  transfer of the License  Assets of the station.
Since transfer of the License  Assets,  no such  affiliation  agreement has been
terminated.


                                      S-41
<PAGE>

RADIO BROADCASTING

     The  following  table sets forth  certain  information  regarding the radio
stations (i) owned and operated by the Company, or (ii) which the Company has an
option or has agreed to acquire:



<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
                           RANKING OF                                              STATION RANK    EXPIRATION
       GEOGRAPHIC          STATION'S             STATION              PRIMARY       IN PRIMARY       DATE OF
         MARKET            MARKET BY           PROGRAMMING          DEMOGRAPHIC    DEMOGRAPHIC         FCC
        SERVED(A)          REVENUE(B)            FORMAT              TARGET(C)      TARGET(D)        LICENSE
- ------------------------- ------------ --------------------------- -------------- -------------- ---------------
<S>                          <C>        <C>                         <C>                 <C>           <C>
Los Angeles, California       1
 KBLA-AM(e)                             Korean                         N/A(e)           N/A(e)        12/1/97(f)
St. Louis, Missouri          18
 KPNT-FM                                Alternative Rock            Adults 18-34          2            2/1/05
 WVRV-FM                                Modern Adult Contemporary   Adults 18-34          3           12/1/04
 WRTH-AM(g)                             Adult Standards             Adults 25-54         20            2/1/05
 WIL-FM(g)                              Country                     Adults 25-54          7            2/1/05
 KIHT-FM(g)                             70s Rock                    Adults 25-54         11            2/1/05
Portland, Oregon             22
 KKSN-AM(g)                             Adult Standards             Adults 25-54         28            2/1/98
 KKSN-FM(g)                             60s Oldies                  Adults 25-54          5            2/1/98
 KKRH-FM(g)                             70s Rock                    Adults 25-54          7            2/1/98
Kansas City, Missouri        29
 KCAZ-AM(g)(h)                          Children's                     N/A(h)           N/A(h)         6/1/97(f)
 KCFX-FM(g)                             70s Rock                    Adults 25-54          1            6/1/97(f)
 KQRC-FM(g)                             Active Rock                 Adults 18-34          2            6/1/05
 KCIY-FM(g)                             Smooth Jazz                 Adults 25-54         11            2/1/05
 KXTR-FM(g)                             Classical                   Adults 25-54         18            2/1/05
Milwaukee, Wisconsin         32
 WEMP-AM(g)                             60s Oldies                  Adults 25-54         26           12/1/04
 WMYX-FM(g)                             Adult Contemporary          Adults 25-54          6           12/1/04
 WAMG-FM(g)                             Rhythmic                    Adults 25-54         15           12/1/04
Nashville, Tennessee         34
 WLAC-FM (i)                            Adult Contemporary          Women 25-54           5            8/1/04
 WJZC-FM(i)                             Smooth Jazz                 Women 25-54           9            8/1/04
 WLAC-AM(i)                             News/Talk/Sports            Adults 35-64          9            8/1/04
New Orleans, Louisiana       38
 WLMG-FM                                Adult Contemporary          Women 25-54           4            6/1/04
 KMEZ-FM                                Urban Oldies                Women 25-54           6            6/1/04
 WWL-AM                                 News/Talk/Sports            Adults 35-64          1            6/1/04
 WSMB-AM                                Talk/Sports                 Adults 35-64         17            6/1/04
 WBYU-AM(g)                             Adult Standards             Adults 25-54         19            6/1/98
 WEZB-FM(g)(j)                          Adult Contemporary          Adults 25-54         10            6/1/05
 WRNO-FM(g)                             70s Rock                    Adults 25-54          8            6/1/01
Memphis, Tennessee           40
 WRVR-FM                                Soft Adult Contemporary     Women 25-54           2            8/1/04
 WJCE-AM                                Urban Oldies                Women 25-54          13            8/1/04
 WOGY-FM                                Country                     Adults 25-54          7            8/1/04
Norfolk, Virginia            41
 WGH-AM(g)                              Sports Talk                 Adults 25-54         18           10/1/03
 WGH-FM(g)                              Country                     Adults 25-54          3           10/1/03
 WVCL-FM(g)(k)                          60s Oldies                  Adults 25-54         10           10/1/03
Buffalo, New York            42
 WMJQ-FM                                Adult Contemporary          Women 25-54           2            6/1/98
 WKSE-FM                                Contemporary Hit Radio      Women 18-49           1            6/1/98
 WBEN-AM                                News/Talk/Sports            Adults 35-64          6            6/1/98
 WWKB-AM                                Country                     Adults 35-64         18            6/1/98
 WGR-AM                                 Sports                      Adults 25-54          9            6/1/98
 WWWS-AM                                Urban Oldies                Women 25-54          11            6/1/98

                                                                 (continued on following page)
</TABLE>

                                      S-42
<PAGE>


<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
                              RANKING OF                                            STATION RANK   EXPIRATION
         GEOGRAPHIC           STATION'S            STATION             PRIMARY       IN PRIMARY     DATE OF
           MARKET             MARKET BY          PROGRAMMING         DEMOGRAPHIC    DEMOGRAPHIC       FCC
         SERVED(A)           REVENUE(B)            FORMAT             TARGET(C)      TARGET(D)      LICENSE
- ---------------------------- ------------ ------------------------- -------------- -------------- ------------
<S>                            <C>          <C>                       <C>                 <C>            <C>
Rochester, New York            53
 WBBF-AM(g)                                Adult Standards            Adults 25-54        23          6/1/98
 WBEE-FM(g)                                Country                    Adults 25-54         1          6/1/98
 WKLX-FM(g)                                60s Oldies                 Adults 25-54         7          6/1/98
 WQRV-FM(g)                                Classic Hits               Adults 25-54         9          6/1/98
Asheville, North Carolina/     60
 Greenville/Spartanburg,
 South Carolina
 WFBC-FM(l)                                Contemporary Hit Radio     Women 18-49          4         12/1/03
 WORD-AM(l)                                News/Talk                  Adults 35-64         9         12/1/03
 WYRD-AM(l)                                News/Talk                  Adults 35-64        10         12/1/03
 WSPA-AM(l)                                Full Service/Talk          Adults 35-64        15         12/1/03
 WSPA-FM(l)                                Soft Adult Contemporary    Women 25-54          4         12/1/03
 WOLI-FM(l)                                Oldies                     Adults 25-54         9         12/1/03
 WOLT-FM(l)                                Oldies                     Adults 25-54        11         12/1/03
Wilkes-Barre/Scranton,         68
 Pennsylvania
 WKRZ-FM(m)                                Contemporary Hit Radio     Adults 18-49         1          8/1/98
 WGGY-FM                                   Country                    Adults 25-54         2          8/1/98
 WILK-AM(n)                                News/Talk/Sports           Adults 35-64         8          8/1/98
 WGBI-AM(n)                                News/Talk/Sports           Adults 35-64        20          8/1/98
 WWSH-FM(o)                                Soft Hits                  Women 25-54          7          8/1/98
 WILP-AM(n)                                News/Talk/Sports           Adults 35-64        19          8/1/98
 WWFH-FM(o)                                Soft Hits                  Women 25-54         10          8/1/98
 WKRF-FM(m)                                Contemporary Hit Radio     Adults 18-49        17          8/1/98
</TABLE>

- ----------
(a)  Actual city of license may differ from the geographic market served.


(b)  Ranking of the principal  radio market served by the station among all U.S.
     radio markets by 1996 aggregate gross radio broadcast  revenue according to
     Duncan's Radio Market Guide - 1997 Edition.

(c)  Due to variations that may exist within  programming  formats,  the primary
     demographic  target of  stations  with the same  programming  format may be
     different.

(d)  All information  concerning ratings and audience  listening  information is
     derived  from the Spring  1997  Arbitron  Metro Area  Ratings  Survey  (the
     "Spring 1997 Arbitron"). Arbitron is the generally accepted industry source
     for statistical  information concerning audience ratings. Due to the nature
     of listener  surveys,  other radio  ratings  services may report  different
     rankings;  however,  the Company  does not believe  that any radio  ratings
     service  other than  Arbitron is accorded  significant  weight in the radio
     broadcast  industry.  "Station Rank in Primary  Demographic  Target" is the
     ranking of the  station  among all radio  stations  in its market  that are
     ranked  in its  target  demographic  group  and is based  on the  station's
     average persons share in the primary  demographic  target in the applicable
     Metro Survey Area. Source:  Average Quarter Hour Estimates,  Monday through
     Sunday, 6:00 a.m. to midnight, Spring 1997 Arbitron.

(e)  Programming  is  provided to this  station by a third party  pursuant to an
     LMA.

(f)  License renewal application pending.

(g)  The  Company  has the right to acquire  the  assets of this  station in the
     Heritage Acquisition.

(h)  This station is being  programmed by a third party  pursuant to an LMA. The
     third  party has an option to  acquire  this  station  for  $550,000  which
     expires on September 30, 1997.

(i)  The Company has agreed to sell this station to a third party.

(j)  A  petition  for  reconsideration  of the grant of this  station's  license
     renewal is pending.

(k)  EEO reporting conditions were placed on this station's license renewals for
     1997, 1998 and 1999.

(l)  The  Company has an option to acquire  Keymarket  of South  Carolina,  Inc.
     ("Keymarket" or "KSC").  Keymarket owns and operates  WYRD-AM,  WORD-AM and
     WFBC-FM,  and has exercised its option to acquire WSPA-AM and WSPA-FM,  and
     provides  sales  services  pursuant  to a JSA and has an option to  acquire
     WOLI-FM and WOLT-FM.

(m)  WKRZ-FM and WKRF-FM simulcast their programming.

(n)  WILK-AM, WGBI-AM and WILP-AM simulcast their programming.

(o)  WWSH-FM and WWFH-FM simulcast their programming.

                                      S-43
<PAGE>

Radio Operating Strategy


     The Company's  radio  strategy is to operate a cluster of radio stations in
selected  geographic markets throughout the country.  In each geographic market,
the  Company  employs  broadly  diversified  programming  formats to appeal to a
variety of demographic groups within the market. The Company seeks to strengthen
the identity of each of its stations  through its  programming  and  promotional
efforts,  and emphasizes that identity to a far greater degree than the identity
of any local radio personality.

     The Company believes that its strategy of appealing to diverse  demographic
groups in selected  geographic  markets allows it to reach a larger share of the
overall  advertising  market  while  realizing  economies  of scale and avoiding
dependence  on one  demographic  or  geographic  market.  The  Company  realizes
economies  of scale  by  combining  sales  and  marketing  forces,  back  office
operations and general  management in each geographic  market. At the same time,
the  geographic  diversity of its portfolio of radio  stations  helps lessen the
potential impact of economic  downturns in specific markets and the diversity of
target  audiences  served  helps  lessen  the  impact of  changes  in  listening
preferences.  In addition,  the geographic and demographic  diversity allows the
Company to avoid dependence on any one or any small group of advertisers.

     The  Company's  group of radio  stations  includes the top billing  station
group in two markets and one of the top three billing  station groups in each of
its markets other than Los Angeles,  St. Louis and Nashville.  Through ownership
or LMAs, the group also includes duopolies in six of its seven markets and, upon
exercise of options to acquire stations in the  Asheville/Greenville/Spartanburg
market, the Company will have duopolies in seven of its eight markets.

     Depending on the programming  format of a particular  station,  there are a
predetermined  number  of  advertisements   broadcast  each  hour.  The  Company
determines the optimum number of  advertisements  available for sale during each
hour without jeopardizing listening levels (and the resulting ratings). Although
there may be shifts from time to time in the number of advertisements  available
for sale during a particular  time of day,  the total  number of  advertisements
available for sale on a particular station normally does not vary significantly.
Any  change in net  radio  broadcasting  revenue,  with the  exception  of those
instances  where  stations  are  acquired or sold,  is  generally  the result of
pricing adjustments made to ensure that the station effectively uses advertising
time  available  for sale,  an increase in the number of  commercials  sold or a
combination of these two factors.

     Large,  well-trained  local sales forces are  maintained  by the Company in
each of its radio markets.  The Company's principal goal is to utilize its sales
efforts to develop long-standing  customer relationships through frequent direct
contacts,  which the Company believes provides it with a competitive  advantage.
Additionally,  in some radio  markets,  duopolies  permit  the  Company to offer
creative advertising packages to local, regional and national advertisers.  Each
radio  station  programmed  by the Company also  engages a national  independent
sales  representative to assist it in obtaining national  advertising  revenues.
These  representatives  obtain advertising through national advertising agencies
and receive a commission  from the radio station based on its gross revenue from
the advertising obtained.


BROADCASTING ACQUISITION STRATEGY

     On February 8, 1996,  the  Telecommunications  Act of 1996 (the "1996 Act")
was signed into law. The 1996 Act represents  the most sweeping  overhaul of the
country's  telecommunications  laws  since the  Communications  Act of 1934,  as
amended (the "Communications Act"). The 1996 Act relaxes the broadcast ownership
rules and simplifies the process for renewal of broadcast station licenses.

     The Company  believes  that the enactment of the 1996 Act presents a unique
opportunity  to  build a  larger  and  more  diversified  broadcasting  company.
Additionally,  the Company  expects  that the  opportunity  to act as one of the
consolidators  of the  industry  will  enable  the  Company  to gain  additional
influence  with program  suppliers,  television  networks,  other  vendors,  and
alternative  delivery media. The additions to the Company's management team as a
result of the River City Acquisition have given it additional  resources to take
advantage of these developments.


                                      S-44
<PAGE>

     In implementing its acquisition strategy, the Company seeks to identify and
pursue favorable  station or group  acquisition  opportunities  primarily in the
15th to 75th  largest  DMAs and  Metro  Service  Areas  ("MSAs").  In  assessing
potential  acquisitions,  the Company examines  opportunities to improve revenue
share, audience share and/or cost control.  Additional factors considered by the
Company in a potential  acquisition  include  geographic  location,  demographic
characteristics  and  competitive  dynamics  of the  market.  The  Company  also
considers the opportunity for  cross-ownership  of television and radio stations
and the opportunity it may provide for cross-promotion and cross-selling.

     In  conjunction  with its  acquisitions,  the  Company may  determine  that
certain  of the  acquired  stations  may not be  consistent  with the  Company's
strategic plan. In such an event, the Company reviews opportunities for swapping
such  stations  with third  parties for other  stations or selling such stations
outright. The Heritage Acquisition may provide such opportunities.

     Since the 1996 Act became  effective,  the Company has  acquired,  obtained
options  to  acquire or has  acquired  the right to  program  or  provide  sales
services to 18 television and 34 radio  stations for an aggregate  consideration
of approximately $1.3 billion. Certain terms of these acquisitions are described
below:


     River  City  Acquisition.  On May 31,  1996,  pursuant  to an  amended  and
restated asset purchase  agreement,  the Company acquired all of the Non-License
Assets of River  City other than the  assets  relating  to WSYX-TV in  Columbus,
Ohio.  Simultaneously,  the Company  entered  into a 10-year LMA with River City
with respect to all of River City's  License  Assets (with the  exception of the
License Assets relating to WSYX-TV). The Company has since acquired all of River
City's  License  Assets (and four radio  stations  to which River City  provided
programming or sales services) other than License Assets relating to WTTV-TV and
WTTK-TV in  Indianapolis,  Indiana,  WSYX-TV in  Columbus,  Ohio and  WFBC-TV in
Greenville,  South Carolina.  Glencairn  acquired the License Assets of WFBC-TV,
and the Company provides programming services to WFBC-TV pursuant to an LMA. The
Company has a 10-year  option (the  "License  Assets  Option") to acquire  River
City's License Assets relating to WTTV-TV and WTTK-TV,  and a three-year  option
to acquire  the assets  relating to WSYX-TV  (both the  License and  Non-License
Assets,  collectively the "Columbus Option"). The exercise price for the License
Assets  Option for  WTTV-TV  and  WTTK-TV  is $1.9  million  and the  Company is
required to pay a quarterly  extension  fee with  respect to the License  Assets
Option of 15% of the option  exercise  price  through May 3, 1998 and 25% of the
option exercise price thereafter.  Acquisition of the License Assets relating to
WTTV-TV and WTTK-TV is now subject to FCC  approval of transfer of such  License
Assets.  There can be no  assurance  that this  approval  will be  obtained.  An
application  for transfer of the License Assets of WTTV-TV and WTTK-TV was filed
in November  1996.  A petition  was filed to deny this  application  and, at the
Company's  request,  the FCC  has  withheld  action  on  this  application.  The
petitioner has appealed the withholding of action on the application. 

     At the time of the River City  Acquisition,  the Company also acquired from
another  party the  Non-License  Assets  relating to one  additional  television
station (KRRT-TV in Kerrville,  Texas) to which River City provided  programming
pursuant  to  an  LMA.  On  June  27,  1997,  the  FCC  granted  the  assignment
applications for WLOS-TV, KABB-TV, KRRT-TV and WFBC-TV subject to the outcome of
its  cross-interest  policy  rulemaking  proceeding and certain other conditions
relating  to  certain  trusts  that  have  non-voting   ownership  interests  in
Glencairn.  The Company has acquired the License  Assets of KABB-TV and WLOS-TV.
Glencairn has acquired the License Assets of KRRT-TV and WFBC-TV and the Company
provides programming services to KRRT-TV and WFBC-TV pursuant to LMAs.



     On July 17, 1997, the Company and Glencairn  acquired the License Assets of
WLOS-TV and WFBC-TV,  respectively.  Applications  for review have been filed by
third parties which appeal the FCC's grants of (i) the Company's  application to
acquire WLOS-TV in the Asheville, North Carolina/ Greenville/Spartanburg,  South
Carolina  market and  Glencairn's  application to acquire WFBC-TV in that market
and (ii) the Company's application to acquire KABB-TV in the San Antonio market.
The Company has filed oppositions to both applications for review.

     The  Company  paid an  aggregate  of  approximately  $1.0  billion  for the
Non-License  Assets and the options to acquire the License  Assets in connection
with the  River  City  Acquisition  consisting  of  $847.6  million  in cash and
1,150,000  shares of Series A  Preferred  Stock of the  Company  and  options to
acquire 1,382,435 shares of Class A Common Stock at an exercise price of $30.11.
The Series A Preferred Stock has been exchanged for 1,150,000 shares of Series B
Preferred Stock of the Company, which at issuance 


                                      S-45
<PAGE>

had an aggregate  liquidation  value of $115 million and are  convertible at any
time,  at the option of the holders,  into an  aggregate of 4,181,818  shares of
Class A Common Stock of the Company (which had a market value on May 31, 1996 of
approximately  $125.1  million).  The exercise price for the Columbus  Option is
approximately  $130 million plus the amount of indebtedness  secured by the WSYX
assets on the date of exercise (not to exceed the amount outstanding on the date
of closing of $105  million) and the Company is required to pay an extension fee
with respect to the Columbus  Option as follows:  (i) 8% of $130 million for the
first year following the closing of the River City Acquisition; (ii) 15% of $130
million for the second year following the closing; and (iii) 25% of $130 million
for each  following  year.  The extension  fee accrues  beginning on the date of
closing,  and is  payable  (beginning  December  31,  1996)  at the  end of each
calendar  quarter until such time as the option is exercised or River City sells
WSYX-TV  to a third  party,  which  River  City has the  right to do in  certain
limited  circumstances.  The Company paid the extension  fees due March 31, 1997
and June 30, 1997. The Company has acquired all of the River City License Assets
except  those  related to WTTV-TV  and  WTTK-TV,  and the Company  continues  to
provide  programming  services to WTTV-TV  and  WTTK-TV  pursuant to an LMA with
River  City.  Pursuant  to the LMA with River  City,  the Company is required to
provide at least 166 hours per week of  programming  to WTTV-TV and WTTK-TV and,
subject  to  certain  exceptions,  River  City  is  required  to  broadcast  all
programming  provided by the Company.  The Company is required to pay River City
monthly  fees under the LMA with  respect to  WTTV-TV  and  WTTK-TV in an amount
sufficient to cover  specified  expenses of operating the stations.  The Company
has the  right  to  sell  advertising  time on the  stations  during  the  hours
programmed by the Company.

     The  Company  and River City  filed  notification  under the HSR Act,  with
respect to the Company's  acquisition  of all River City assets prior to closing
the acquisition.  After the United States Justice  Department  ("DOJ") indicated
that  it  would   request   additional   information   regarding  the  antitrust
implications  of the  acquisition  of  WSYX-TV  by the  Company  in light of the
Company's  ownership  of  WTTE-TV,  the  Company and River City agreed to submit
separate  notifications  with respect to the WSYX-TV  assets and the other River
City assets.  The DOJ then granted early  termination of the waiting period with
respect to the transfer of the River City assets other than WSYX-TV,  permitting
the acquisition of those assets to proceed. The Company and River City agreed to
notify the DOJ 30 days before  entering  into an LMA or similar  agreement  with
respect to WSYX-TV and agreed not to enter into such an agreement  until 20 days
after  substantially  complying  with  any  request  for  information  from  DOJ
regarding  the  transaction.  The  Company  is in the  process  of  preparing  a
submission to the DOJ regarding the competitive  effects of entering into an LMA
arrangement  in Columbus.  The Company has agreed to sell the License  Assets of
WTTE-TV  to  Glencairn  and to  enter  into an LMA  with  Glencairn  to  provide
programming services to WTTE-TV. The FCC has approved this transaction,  but the
Company does not believe  that this  transaction  will be  completed  unless the
Company acquires WSYX-TV.

     In the River City Acquisition,  the Company also acquired an option held by
River  City to  purchase  either  (i) all of the  assets of  Keymarket  of South
Carolina,  Inc. for the  forgiveness of debt held by the Company in an aggregate
principal  amount of  approximately  $7.4  million as of August 22,  1997,  plus
payment of approximately  $1,000,000 less certain adjustments or (ii) all of the
stock of KSC for  $1,000,000  less  certain  adjustments.  KSC owns and operates
three radio stations in the Asheville,  North Carolina/  Greenville/Spartanburg,
South  Carolina MSA (WFBC-FM,  WFBC-AM and  WORD-AM).  The option to acquire the
assets or stock of KSC expire on  December  31,  1997.  The  Company  intends to
exercise this option in the fourth  quarter of 1997. KSC also holds an option to
acquire  from  Spartan  Radiocasting,   Inc.  certain  assets  relating  to  two
additional   stations   (WSPA-AM   and   WSPA-FM)   in  the   Asheville,   North
Carolina/Greenville/Spartanburg, South Carolina MSA which KSC currently programs
pursuant to an LMA.  KSC's  option to acquire  these assets is  exercisable  for
$5.15  million and expires in January  2000,  subject to extension to the extent
the  applicable  LMA is  extended  beyond  that date.  KSC also has an option to
acquire assets of Palm  Broadcasting  Company,  L.P.,  which owns two additional
stations in the Asheville, North Carolina/Greenville/Spartanburg, South Carolina
MSA (WOLI-FM and  WOLT-FM) in an amount  equal to the  outstanding  debt of Palm
Broadcasting Company, L.P. to the Company, which was approximately $3.03 million
as of March 31, 1997. This option expires in April 2001. KSC has a JSA with Palm
Broadcasting Company, L.P., but does not provide programming for WOLI or WOLT.


                                      S-46
<PAGE>

     Superior  Acquisition.  On  May  8,  1996,  the  Company  acquired  WDKY-TV
(Lexington,  Kentucky)  and  KOCB-TV  (Oklahoma City, Oklahoma) by acquiring the
stock of Superior Communications Group, Inc. for approximately $63.5 million.

     Flint Acquisition.  On February 27, 1996 the Company acquired the assets of
WSMH-TV (Flint,  Michigan) for approximately $35.8 million by exercising options
granted in 1995.

     Cincinnati/Kansas City Acquisitions.  On July 1, 1996, the Company acquired
the assets of KSMO-TV (Kansas City, Missouri) and on August 1, 1996, it acquired
the assets of WSTR-TV (Cincinnati, Ohio) for approximately $34.2 million.

     Peoria/Bloomington  Acquisition.  On July 1, 1996, the Company acquired the
assets  of  WYZZ-TV  (Peoria/Bloomington,   Illinois)  for  approximately  $21.2
million.


1997 ACQUISITIONS

     Las Vegas  Acquisition.  On January 30, 1997,  the Company  entered into an
agreement  to acquire the assets of  KUPN-TV,  the UPN  affiliate  in Las Vegas,
Nevada,  for $87.0 million.  The Company  completed this  acquisition on May 30,
1997.

     Heritage  Acquisition.  On July 16,  1997,  the  Company  entered  into the
Heritage Acquisition Agreements with certain subsidiaries of Heritage.  Pursuant
to the Heritage Acquisition Agreements, the Company has the right to acquire the
assets of five television stations (the interests in one of which the Company is
required  to  dispose),  programming  rights  under  LMAs  with  respect  to two
additional television stations, and the assets of 24 radio stations. The Company
will   acquire   the   assets   of   one   television    station   serving   the
Charleston/Huntington, West Virginia market, one station in the Mobile, Alabama/
Pensacola,  Florida  market  and  rights  under an LMA with  respect  to another
station  in that  market,  and the  assets of two  stations  in the  Burlington,
Vermont/Plattsburgh, New York market and the right to provide programming to one
station in that market.  The radio  stations to be acquired serve the St. Louis,
Missouri market (three stations), the Portland,  Oregon market (three stations),
the Kansas City,  Missouri  market (five  stations),  the  Milwaukee,  Wisconsin
market (three stations), the Norfolk,  Virginia market (three stations), the New
Orleans,  Louisiana market (three  stations) and the Rochester,  New York market
(four  stations).  The  Heritage  Acquisition  Agreements  also  provide for the
acquisition of the assets  relating to the operation of a television  station in
Oklahoma  City,  Oklahoma,  but the  Company is required  by the  agreements  to
dispose of its  interest in that  station,  and the  Company has entered  into a
letter of intent to sell that station for $60 million in cash.

     The aggregate  purchase  price of the Heritage  Acquisition is $630 million
payable in cash at closing,  less a deposit of $63  million  paid at the time of
signing the Heritage Acquisition Agreements.  The Company intends to finance the
purchase  price  from some  combination  of the  proceeds  of the  Common  Stock
Offering,  the proceeds of the Preferred Stock  Offering,  funds available under
the Bank Credit Agreement, and the expected proceeds ($60 million) from the sale
of interests in the Oklahoma City station.

     The  Heritage  Acquisition  is  conditioned  on,  among other  things,  FCC
approval and the expiration of the applicable waiting period under the HSR Act.


     Additional Radio Acquisitions and Dispositions. The Company entered into an
agreement  on January  29,  1997 to acquire  the assets of WGR-AM and WWWS-AM in
Buffalo,  New York,  for $1.5 million.  The Company's  acquisition of WGR-AM and
WWWS-AM was  consummated  on April 18, 1997.  On January 31,  1997,  the Company
completed  the  acquisition  of the  assets  of  WWFH-FM  and  WILP-AM,  each in
Wilkes-Barre,   Pennsylvania,   for  aggregate  consideration  of  approximately
$773,000.  On March 12, 1997,  the Company  entered into an agreement to acquire
the assets of radio station WKRF-FM in the  Wilkes-Barre/Scranton,  Pennsylvania
market.  The Company completed this acquisition on July 31, 1997. In April 1997,
the Company  entered into an  agreement  to acquire the assets of radio  station
WWSH-FM  in  the  Wilkes-Barre/Scranton   market.  The  Company  completed  this
acquisition on August 29, 1997.


                                      S-47
<PAGE>

     In  August,   1997,  the  Company   entered  into  an  agreement  with  SFX
Broadcasting,  Inc.  ("SFX")  pursuant to which the Company will sell to SFX the
assets relating to the operations of Nashville radio stations  WJZC-FM,  WLAC-FM
and  WLAC-AM  (the "SFX  Stations").  Under the  agreement,  SFX will pay to the
Company an aggregate  consideration  of $35 million in cash for the SFX Stations
or, at the Company's  option,  transfer to the Company  assets that both SFX and
the Company agree have a fair market value equal to $35 million. The sale of the
SFX Stations is conditioned on the approval of each of the Department of Justice
and the Federal Communications Commission and is expected to close in 1998.

     Ongoing  Discussions.  In  furtherance  of its  acquisition  strategy,  the
Company routinely reviews,  and conducts  investigations of potential television
and  radio  station   acquisitions.   When  the  Company  believes  a  favorable
opportunity  exists, the Company seeks to enter into discussions with the owners
of such stations regarding the possibility of an acquisition by the Company.  At
any given time, the Company may be in discussions  with one or more such station
owners. The Company is in serious  negotiations with various parties relating to
the acquisition of television and radio  properties  which would be acquired for
aggregate  consideration of approximately $85 million. There can be no assurance
that any of these or other negotiations will lead to definitive agreements or if
agreements are reached that any transactions would be consummated.


LOCAL MARKETING AGREEMENTS

     The Company  currently has LMA arrangements  with stations in seven markets
in  which  it  owns  a  television  station:  Pittsburgh,  Pennsylvania  (WPTT),
Baltimore,  Maryland (WNUV),  Raleigh/Durham,  North Carolina (WRDC), Milwaukee,
Wisconsin  (WVTV),  Birmingham,  Alabama (WABM),  San Antonio,  Texas (KRRT) and
Asheville/Greenville/Spartanburg,   South  Carolina  (WFBC).  In  addition,  the
Company has an LMA arrangement with a station in the Tuscaloosa,  Alabama market
(WDBB),  which is adjacent to Birmingham.  In each of these markets,  other than
Pittsburgh and Tuscaloosa, the LMA arrangement is with Glencairn and the Company
owns the Non-License Assets of the stations.  The Company owns the assets of one
radio station (KBLA-AM in Los Angeles) which an independent third party programs
pursuant to an LMA.

     The Company  believes  that it is able to increase its revenues and improve
its margins by providing  programming  services to stations in selected DMAs and
MSAs where the Company  already  owns a station.  In certain  instances,  single
station  operators and stations operated by smaller ownership groups do not have
the management expertise or the operating  efficiencies available to the Company
as a multi-station  broadcaster.  The Company seeks to identify such stations in
selected markets and to provide such stations with programming services pursuant
to  LMAs.  In  addition  to  providing  the  Company  with  additional   revenue
opportunities,  the Company believes that these LMA  arrangements  have assisted
certain  stations  whose  operations  may have  been  marginally  profitable  to
continue to air popular  programming  and contribute to diversity of programming
in their respective DMAs and MSAs.

     In cases where the Company enters into LMA  arrangements in connection with
a station whose acquisition by the Company is pending FCC approval,  the Company
(i) obtains an option to acquire the station assets essential for broadcasting a
television or radio signal in compliance with regulatory  guidelines,  generally
consisting  of the  FCC  license,  transmitter,  transmission  lines,  technical
equipment,  call letters and  trademarks,  and certain  furniture,  fixtures and
equipment  (the "License  Assets") and (ii)  acquires the remaining  assets (the
"Non-License  Assets")  at  the  time  it  enters  into  the  option.  Following
acquisition of the Non-License  Assets,  the License Assets continue to be owned
by the  owner-operator  and holder of the FCC license,  which enters into an LMA
with the  Company.  After FCC  approval  for  transfer of the License  Assets is
obtained,  the Company  exercises  its option to acquire the License  Assets and
become the owner-operator of the station, and the LMA arrangement is terminated.

     In connection  with the River City  Acquisition,  the Company  entered into
LMAs with  River  City and the owner of KRRT  with  respect  to each of the nine
television  and 21 radio  stations  with  respect to which the Company  acquired
Non-License Assets. The Company or Glencairn has now acquired the License Assets
of all of the  television  and radio  stations with respect to which the Company
initially acquired Non-License Assets in the River City Acquisition,  other than
WTTV and WTTK in  Indianapolis,  Indiana.  The LMA with River City for these two
stations is in effect for a ten-year term, which corresponds with the term


                                      S-48
<PAGE>

of the option  the  Company  holds to acquire  the  related  River City  License
Assets.  Pursuant  to the LMA,  the  Company  pays River City fees in return for
which  the  Company  acquires  all of the  inventory  of  broadcast  time of the
stations and the right to sell 100% of each  station's  inventory of advertising
time.  Upon grant of FCC approval of the transfer of License Assets with respect
to WTTV and WTTK,  the  Company  intends  to acquire  the  License  Assets,  and
thereafter the LMA will terminate and the Company will operate the stations.  At
the Company's  request,  the FCC has withheld  action on the application for the
Company's   acquisition  of  WTTV  and  WTTK  in  Indianapolis  (and  a  pending
application  for the  Controlling  Stockholders  to  divest  their  attributable
interests  in  WIIB  in  Indianapolis)  until  the  FCC  completes  its  pending
rulemaking proceeding considering the cross-interest policy.


USE OF DIGITAL TELEVISION TECHNOLOGY

     The  Company   believes  that  television   broadcasting  may  be  enhanced
significantly   by  the  development  and  increased   availability  of  digital
broadcasting service technology. This technology has the potential to permit the
Company to provide viewers multiple channels of digital  television over each of
its  existing  standard  channels,  to  provide  certain  programming  in a high
definition  television  format and to deliver  various forms of data,  including
data  on  the  Internet,  to  home  and  business  computers.  These  additional
capabilities  may provide the Company with  additional  sources of revenue.  The
Company is currently  considering  plans to provide high  definition  television
("HDTV"),  to provide multiple channels of television including the provision of
additional  broadcast  programming and transmitted data on a subscription basis,
and to continue its current TV program channels without subscription fees on its
allocated  portions of the  broadcast  spectrum.  The 1996 Act allows the FCC to
charge a spectrum  fee to  broadcasters  who use the  digital  spectrum to offer
subscription-based  services.  The FCC is expected to open a  rulemaking  in the
fall of 1997 to consider the  spectrum  fees to be charged to  broadcasters  for
such use. In addition,  Congress is holding hearings on broadcasters'  plans for
the use of their  digital  spectrum.  The  Company  cannot  predict  what future
actions the FCC or Congress  might take with  respect to DTV, nor can it predict
the effect of the FCC's present DTV  implementation  plan or such future actions
on the Company's business.  This digital  broadcasting service technology is not
currently  available to the viewing public and a successful  transition from the
current analog broadcast  format to a digital format may take many years.  There
can be no  assurance  that the  Company's  efforts to take  advantage of the new
technology will be commercially successful.


FEDERAL REGULATION OF TELEVISION AND RADIO BROADCASTING

     The  ownership,  operation  and sale of television  and radio  stations are
subject to the  jurisdiction of the FCC, which acts under  authority  granted by
the Communications  Act. Among other things, the FCC assigns frequency bands for
broadcasting;  determines  the particular  frequencies,  locations and operating
power of  stations;  issues,  renews,  revokes and  modifies  station  licenses;
regulates  equipment  used by stations;  adopts and implements  regulations  and
policies  that  directly  or  indirectly  affect the  ownership,  operation  and
employment  practices of  stations;  and has the power to impose  penalties  for
violations of its rules or the Communications Act.

     The   following  is  a  brief   summary  of  certain   provisions   of  the
Communications  Act,  the 1996 Act and specific FCC  regulations  and  policies.
Reference should be made to the Communications  Act, the 1996 Act, FCC rules and
the public notices and rulings of the FCC for further information concerning the
nature and extent of federal regulation of broadcast stations.

     License Grant and Renewal.  Television and radio stations  operate pursuant
to broadcasting  licenses that are granted by the FCC for maximum terms of eight
years.

     Television  and  radio  station   licenses  are  subject  to  renewal  upon
application to the FCC.  During certain  periods when renewal  applications  are
pending,  competing  applicants  may file for the radio or television  frequency
being used by the renewal applicant.  During the same periods, petitions to deny
license  renewal  applications  may be filed by  interested  parties,  including
members of the public.  Prior to the 1996 Act, the FCC was generally required to
hold  hearings  on renewal  applications  if a competing  application  against a
renewal  application  was filed, if the FCC was unable to determine that renewal
of a license would serve the public interest, convenience and necessity, or if a
petition to deny raised a


                                      S-49
<PAGE>

"substantial  and  material  question  of fact" as to  whether  the grant of the
renewal  application would be prima facie inconsistent with the public interest,
convenience and necessity.

     The 1996 Act does not  prohibit  either  the  filing of  petitions  to deny
license  renewals or the filing of competing  applications.  Under the 1996 Act,
the FCC is still  required  to hold  hearings on renewal  applications  if it is
unable to determine  that renewal of a license would serve the public  interest,
convenience  or necessity,  or if a petition to deny raises a  "substantial  and
material  question of fact" as to whether  the grant of the renewal  application
would be prima facie  inconsistent  with the public  interest,  convenience  and
necessity.  Pursuant  to the  1996  Act,  however,  the FCC is  prohibited  from
considering competing applications for a renewal applicant's  frequency,  and is
required  to grant  the  renewal  application,  if the FCC  finds:  (i) that the
station has served the public  interest,  convenience  and necessity;  (ii) that
there have been no serious  violations by the licensee of the Communications Act
or the rules and  regulations  of the FCC;  and (iii)  there  have been no other
violations  by  the  licensee  of  the  Communications  Act  or  the  rules  and
regulations of the FCC that, when taken together,  would constitute a pattern of
abuse.

     All of the stations that the Company (i) owns and operates, (ii) intends to
acquire  pursuant  to  pending   acquisitions,   or  (iii)  currently   provides
programming  services to  pursuant  to an LMA,  are  presently  operating  under
regular  licenses,  which expire as to each station on the dates set forth under
"- Television  Broadcasting" and "- Radio Broadcasting," above. Although renewal
of license is granted in the vast majority of cases even when  petitions to deny
are filed,  there can be no assurance that the licenses of such stations will be
renewed.


Ownership Matters

General

     The  Communications  Act prohibits the assignment of a broadcast license or
the transfer of control of a broadcast  licensee  without the prior  approval of
the FCC. In determining  whether to permit the assignment or transfer of control
of, or the grant or renewal of, a broadcast license,  the FCC considers a number
of factors pertaining to the licensee,  including  compliance with various rules
limiting common ownership of media  properties,  the "character" of the licensee
and those persons holding "attributable"  interests therein, and compliance with
the Communications Act's limitations on alien ownership.

     To obtain the FCC's prior consent to assign a broadcast license or transfer
control of a broadcast licensee, appropriate applications must be filed with the
FCC. If the application involves a "substantial change" in ownership or control,
the application must be placed on public notice for a period of approximately 30
days during which  petitions to deny the  application may be filed by interested
parties,  including members of the public. If the application does not involve a
"substantial  change" in ownership or control,  it is a "pro forma" application.
The  "pro  forma"  application  is  nevertheless   subject  to  having  informal
objections  filed  against  it. If the FCC  grants  an  assignment  or  transfer
application, interested parties have approximately 30 days from public notice of
the grant to seek reconsideration of that grant. Generally,  parties that do not
file initial  petitions to deny or informal  objections  against the application
face difficulty in seeking  reconsideration  of the grant.  The FCC normally has
approximately  an  additional 10 days to set aside such grant on its own motion.
When passing on an  assignment  or transfer  application,  the FCC is prohibited
from considering whether the public interest might be served by an assignment or
transfer to any party other than the  assignee or  transferee  specified  in the
application.

     The FCC generally applies its ownership limits to "attributable"  interests
held by an individual,  corporation,  partnership or other  association.  In the
case of corporations  holding, or through  subsidiaries  controlling,  broadcast
licenses,  the  interests  of  officers,  directors  and those who,  directly or
indirectly, have the right to vote 5% or more of the corporation's stock (or 10%
or more of such stock in the case of insurance  companies,  investment companies
and  bank  trust   departments   that  are  passive   investors)  are  generally
attributable, except that, in general, no minority voting stock interest will be
attributable  if there is a single  holder of more  than 50% of the  outstanding
voting power of the  corporation.  The FCC has a pending  rulemaking  proceeding
that,  among other  things,  seeks  comment on whether the FCC should modify its
attribution rules by (i) raising the attribution stock benchmark from 5% to 10%;
(ii) raising the attribution  stock benchmark for passive  investors from 10% to
20%; (iii)  restricting  the  availability  of the single  majority  shareholder
exemption; and (iv) attributing certain interests such as


                                      S-50
<PAGE>

non-voting stock, debt and certain holdings by limited liability corporations in
certain circumstances.  More recently, the FCC has solicited comment on proposed
rules that would (i) treat an otherwise  nonattributable equity or debt interest
in a licensee as an attributable interest where the interest holder is a program
supplier or the owner of a  broadcast  station in the same market and the equity
and/or debt holding is greater than a specified benchmark; (ii) treat a licensee
of a television  station which,  under an LMA, brokers more than 15% of the time
on another television station serving the same market, as having an attributable
interest in the brokered station; and (iii) in certain circumstances,  treat the
licensee of a broadcast  station that sells  advertising time on another station
in the same market pursuant to a JSA as having an  attributable  interest in the
station whose advertising is being sold.

     The Controlling  Stockholders hold  attributable  interests in two entities
owning media properties,  namely:  Channel 63, Inc.,  licensee of WIIB-TV, a UHF
television station in Bloomington,  Indiana, and Bay Television,  Inc., licensee
of WTTA-TV,  a UHF television  station in St.  Petersburg,  Florida.  All of the
issued and  outstanding  shares of Channel 63, Inc. are owned by the Controlling
Stockholders.  All the issued and outstanding shares of Bay Television, Inc. are
owned by the  Controlling  Stockholders  (75%) and Robert L.  Simmons  (25%),  a
former stockholder of the Company.  The Controlling  Stockholders have agreed to
divest their attributable interests in Channel 63, Inc. and the Company believes
that, after doing so, such holdings will not materially  restrict its ability to
acquire or program additional broadcast stations.

     Under its  "cross-interest"  policy, the FCC considers certain "meaningful"
relationships  among  competing  media  outlets in the same market,  even if the
ownership  rules do not  specifically  prohibit  the  relationship.  Under  this
policy,  the FCC may consider  significant  equity  interests  combined  with an
attributable interest in a media outlet in the same market, joint ventures,  and
common key  employees  among  competitors.  The  cross-interest  policy does not
necessarily prohibit all of these interests,  but requires that the FCC consider
whether,  in  a  particular  market,  the  "meaningful"   relationships  between
competitors  could have a significant  adverse effect upon economic  competition
and program  diversity.  Heretofore,  the FCC has not applied its cross-interest
policy to LMAs and JSAs between broadcast  stations.  In its ongoing  rulemaking
proceeding  concerning  the  attribution  rules,  the FCC has sought comment on,
among other things, (i) whether the cross-interest policy should be applied only
in smaller markets, and (ii) whether non-equity financial  relationships such as
debt, when combined with multiple business  interrelationships  such as LMAs and
JSAs,  raise concerns under the  cross-interest  policy.  Moreover,  in its most
recent proposals in its ongoing attribution rulemaking  proceeding,  the FCC has
proposed  treating  television  LMAs,  JSAs,  and debt or  equity  interests  as
attributable   interests  in  certain   circumstances   without  regard  to  the
cross-interest policy.

     The  Communications Act prohibits the issuance of broadcast licenses to, or
the holding of a broadcast license by, any corporation of which more than 20% of
the  capital  stock is owned of record or voted by  non-U.S.  citizens  or their
representatives  or by a foreign government or a representative  thereof,  or by
any corporation  organized  under the laws of a foreign  country  (collectively,
"Aliens"). The Communications Act also authorizes the FCC, if the FCC determines
that it would be in the public interest, to prohibit the issuance of a broadcast
license to, or the holding of a broadcast  license by, any corporation  directly
or indirectly  controlled by any other corporation of which more than 25% of the
capital  stock is owned of  record  or voted by  Aliens.  The  Company  has been
advised that the FCC staff has  interpreted  this provision to require a finding
that such grant or holding  would be in the public  interest  before a broadcast
license may be granted to or held by any such corporation and that the FCC staff
has made  such a  finding  only in  limited  circumstances.  The FCC has  issued
interpretations  of existing law under which these restrictions in modified form
apply to other forms of business  organizations,  including  partnerships.  As a
result of these provisions,  the licenses granted to Subsidiaries of the Company
by the FCC could be revoked  if,  among other  restrictions  imposed by the FCC,
more than 25% of the Company's stock were directly or indirectly  owned or voted
by Aliens. The Company and the Subsidiaries are domestic  corporations,  and the
Controlling  Stockholders  are all  United  States  citizens.  The  Amended  and
Restated  Articles of Incorporation  of the Company (the "Amended  Certificate")
contain  limitations  on Alien  ownership  and  control  that are  substantially
similar to those contained in the  Communications  Act.  Pursuant to the Amended
Certificate, the Company has the right to repurchase Alien-owned shares


                                      S-51
<PAGE>

at their fair market value to the extent necessary, in the judgment of the Board
of Directors, to comply with the Alien ownership restrictions.


Television

     National  Ownership  Rule.  Prior  to the 1996  Act,  FCC  rules  generally
prohibited an individual or entity from having an attributable  interest in more
than 12 television stations nationwide,  or in television stations reaching more
than 25% of the national television viewing audience.  Pursuant to the 1996 Act,
the FCC has  modified  its rules to eliminate  any  limitation  on the number of
television  stations an individual or entity may own nationwide,  subject to the
restriction  that no individual or entity may have an  attributable  interest in
television  stations reaching more than 35% of the national  television  viewing
audience.  Historically, VHF stations have shared a larger portion of the market
than UHF stations.  Therefore, only half of the households in the market area of
any UHF station are included  when  calculating  whether an entity or individual
owns  television  stations  reaching  more than 35% of the  national  television
viewing  audience.  All but  three of the  stations  owned and  operated  by the
Company, or to which the Company provides programming services, are UHF.

     Duopoly Rule. On a local level,  the  television  "duopoly"  rule generally
prohibits a single individual or entity from having an attributable  interest in
two or more television  stations with overlapping  Grade B service areas.  While
the 1996 Act has not  eliminated  the TV duopoly rule, it does direct the FCC to
initiate a rulemaking  proceeding  to determine  whether to retain,  modify,  or
eliminate the rule. The FCC has pending a rulemaking  proceeding in which it has
proposed to modify the television duopoly rule to permit the common ownership of
television stations in different DMAs, so long as the Grade A signal contours of
the stations do not overlap.  Pending  resolution of its rulemaking  proceeding,
the FCC has adopted an interim  waiver policy that permits the common  ownership
of  television  stations in different  DMAs with no  overlapping  Grade A signal
contours, conditioned on the final outcome of the rulemaking proceeding. The FCC
has also sought comment on whether common  ownership of two television  stations
in a market  should be  permitted  (i) where one or more of the  commonly  owned
stations is UHF, (ii) where one of the stations is in bankruptcy or has been off
the air for a  substantial  period of time and (iii)  where the  commonly  owned
stations have very small audience or advertising  shares,  are located in a very
large  market,  and/or a specified  number of  independently  owned media voices
would remain after the acquisition.

     Local Marketing Agreements. Over the past few years, a number of television
stations,  including certain of the Company's  stations,  have entered into what
have commonly been referred to as LMAs.  While these agreements may take varying
forms,  pursuant to a typical  LMA,  separately  owned and  licensed  television
stations agree to enter into cooperative  arrangements of varying sorts, subject
to compliance  with the  requirements of antitrust laws and with the FCC's rules
and policies. Under these types of arrangements, separately owned stations could
agree to function  cooperatively  in terms of  programming,  advertising  sales,
etc.,  subject  to the  requirement  that the  licensee  of each  station  shall
maintain  independent  control over the  programming  and  operations of its own
station.  One  typical  type  of  LMA is a  programming  agreement  between  two
separately owned television  stations serving a common service area, whereby the
licensee of one station  programs  substantial  portions of the broadcast day on
the other licensee's  station,  subject to ultimate editorial and other controls
being exercised by the latter licensee,  and sells  advertising time during such
program  segments.  Such  arrangements  are an extension of the concept of "time
brokerage" agreements,  under which a licensee of a station sells blocks of time
on its  station to an entity or  entities  which  program the blocks of time and
which  sell  their own  commercial  advertising  announcements  during  the time
periods in question. The staff of the FCC's Mass Media Bureau has held that LMAs
are not contrary to the  Communications  Act,  provided that the licensee of the
station  which is being  substantially  programmed by another  entity  maintains
complete  responsibility  for and control over programming and operations of its
broadcast station and assures compliance with applicable FCC rules and policies.

     At present, FCC rules permit television station LMAs, and the licensee of a
television   station  brokering  time  on  another  television  station  is  not
considered to have an attributable interest in the brokered station. However, in
connection  with its ongoing  rulemaking  proceeding  regarding  the  television
duopoly rule, the FCC has proposed to adopt rules providing that the licensee of
a television station


                                      S-52
<PAGE>

which brokers more than 15% of the time on another  television  station  serving
the same market would be deemed to have an attributable interest in the brokered
station for purposes of the  national and local  multiple  ownership  rules.  In
connection with this proceeding, the FCC has solicited detailed information from
parties to television LMAs as to the terms and characteristics of such LMAs.

     The 1996 Act provides that nothing  therein "shall be construed to prohibit
the  origination,  continuation,  or renewal of any television  local  marketing
agreement  that  is in  compliance  with  the  regulations  of the  [FCC]."  The
legislative history of the 1996 Act reflects that this provision was intended to
grandfather  television  LMAs that were in existence  upon enactment of the 1996
Act, and to allow  television LMAs consistent with the FCC's rules subsequent to
enactment of the 1996 Act. In its pending  rulemaking  proceeding  regarding the
television  duopoly rule, the FCC has proposed to adopt a grandfathering  policy
providing that, in the event that television LMAs become attributable interests,
LMAs that are in  compliance  with  existing  FCC rules  and  policies  and were
entered  into before  November 5, 1996,  would be permitted to continue in force
until the original term of the LMA expires. Under the FCC's proposal, television
LMAs that are entered  into or renewed  after  November 5, 1996 would have to be
terminated  if LMAs  are made  attributable  interests  and the LMA in  question
resulted  in a  violation  of  the  television  multiple  ownership  rules.  The
Company's LMAs with television stations WPTT in Pittsburgh,  Pennsylvania,  WNUV
in Baltimore,  Maryland, WVTV in Milwaukee,  Wisconsin,  WRDC in Raleigh/Durham,
North Carolina,  WABM in Birmingham,  Alabama, and WDBB in Tuscaloosa,  Alabama,
were in  existence on both the date of enactment of the 1996 Act and November 5,
1996. The Company's LMAs with television stations WTTV and WTTK in Indianapolis,
Indiana were entered  into  subsequent  to the date of enactment of the 1996 Act
but prior to November 5, 1996. The Company's LMA with television station KRRT-TV
in  Kerrville,  Texas was in existence on the date of enactment of the 1996 Act,
but was assumed by the Company  subsequent to that date but prior to November 5,
1996. The licensee's rights under the Company's LMA with KRRT-TV were assumed by
Glencairn  subsequent  to November 5, 1996.  The  Company's  LMA with WFBC-TV in
Asheville/Greenville/Spartanburg,  South  Carolina,  was  entered  into  by  the
Company  subsequent  to the  date of  enactment  of the  1996  Act but  prior to
November  5, 1996,  and the  licensee's  rights  under that LMA were  assumed by
Glencairn  subsequent to November 5, 1996.  The Company cannot predict if any or
all of its LMAs will be grandfathered.

     The Conference Agreement adopted as part of the Balanced Budget Act of 1997
recently  signed into law by  President  Clinton  (the  "Balanced  Budget  Act")
clarifies  Congress'  intent with respect to LMAs and duopolies.  The Conference
Agreement  states as follows:  "The conferees do not intend that the duopoly and
television-newspaper  cross-ownership  relief  provided  herein  should have any
bearing upon the [FCC's]  current  proceedings,  which  concerns more  immediate
relief.  The  conferees  expect  that  the  [FCC]  will  proceed  with  its  own
independent  examination in these matters.  Specifically,  the conferees  expect
that the [FCC] will provide additional relief (e.g., VHF/UHF  combinations) that
it  finds  to be in the  public  interest,  and  will  implement  the  permanent
grandfather  requirement  for local  marketing  agreements  as  provided  in the
Telecommunications Act of 1996."

     The TV duopoly  rule  currently  prevents the Company  from  acquiring  the
licenses of  television  stations  with which it has LMAs in those markets where
the Company owns a television  station.  As a result,  if the FCC were to decide
that the  provider of  programming  services  under a  television  LMA should be
treated as having an attributable  interest in the brokered  station,  and if it
did not relax its  television  duopoly  rule,  the Company  could be required to
modify or terminate  those of its LMAs that were not in existence on the date of
enactment of the 1996 Act or on November 5, 1996. Furthermore, if the FCC adopts
its present proposal with respect to the  grandfathering of television LMAs, the
Company could be required to terminate even those LMAs that were in effect prior
to the date of enactment of the 1996 Act or prior to November 5, 1996, after the
initial  term of the LMA or upon  assignment  of the LMA. In such an event,  the
Company  could be required to pay  termination  penalties  under certain of such
LMAs.  Further, if the FCC were to find, in connection with any of the Company's
LMAs, that the  owners/licensees of the stations with which the Company has LMAs
failed to maintain  control over their  operations  as required by FCC rules and
policies,  the licensee of the LMA station  and/or the Company could be fined or
set for hearing,  the outcome of which could be a monetary  forfeiture or, under
certain circumstances, loss of the applicable FCC license. The Company is unable
to


                                      S-53
<PAGE>

predict  the  ultimate  outcome of  possible  changes to these FCC rules and the
impact such FCC rules may have on its broadcasting operations.

     On June 1, 1995, the Chief of the FCC's Mass Media Bureau released a Public
Notice  concerning  the  processing  of  television  assignment  and transfer of
control  applications  proposing  LMAs.  Due to  the  pendency  of  the  ongoing
rulemaking proceeding concerning attribution of ownership, the Mass Media Bureau
has  placed  certain  restrictions  on the types of  television  assignment  and
transfer of control applications  involving LMAs that it will approve during the
pendency of the rulemaking.  Specifically, the Mass Media Bureau has stated that
it will not approve  arrangements where a time broker seeks to finance a station
acquisition  and hold an option to  purchase  the  station  in the  future.  The
Company  believes that none of the Company's  LMAs fall within the ambit of this
Public Notice.


Radio

     National  Ownership Rule. Prior to the 1996 Act, the FCC's rules limited an
individual or entity from holding attributable  interests in more than 20 AM and
20 FM radio stations nationwide.  Pursuant to the 1996 Act, the FCC has modified
its rules to eliminate any  limitation on the number of radio  stations a single
individual or entity may own nationwide.

     Local  Ownership  Rule.  Prior to the 1996 Act,  the FCC's rules  generally
permitted an individual or entity to hold attributable interests in no more than
four radio stations in a local market (no more than two of which could be in the
same service (AM or FM)),  and then only if the aggregate  audience share of the
commonly  owned  stations  did not exceed  25%.  In  markets  with fewer than 15
commercial  radio  stations,  an individual or entity could hold an attributable
interest in no more than three radio stations in the market (no more than two of
which could be in the same service), and then only if the number of the commonly
owned  stations  did not  exceed  50% of the total  number of  commercial  radio
stations in the market.

     Pursuant to the 1996 Act,  the limits on the number of radio  stations  one
entity may own locally have been  increased as follows:  (i) in a market with 45
or more  commercial  radio  stations,  an entity may own up to eight  commercial
radio stations,  not more than five of which are in the same service (AM or FM);
(ii) in a market with between 30 and 44 (inclusive)  commercial  radio stations,
an entity may own up to seven commercial  radio stations,  not more than four of
which  are in the  same  service;  (iii)  in a  market  with  between  15 and 29
(inclusive)  commercial  radio stations,  an entity may own up to six commercial
radio stations, not more than four of which are in the same service; and (iv) in
a market with 14 or fewer  commercial  radio  stations,  an entity may own up to
five  commercial  radio  stations,  not more than three of which are in the same
service, except that an entity may not own more than 50% of the stations in such
market.  These numerical limits apply regardless of the aggregate audience share
of the stations  sought to be commonly  owned.  FCC ownership  rules continue to
permit an entity to own one FM and one AM station in a local  market  regardless
of market size.  Irrespective of FCC rules governing radio  ownership,  however,
the DOJ and the Federal Trade Commission have the authority to determine, and in
certain  recent radio  transactions  not involving the Company have  determined,
that a particular transaction presents antitrust concerns.

     Local Marketing  Agreements.  As in television,  a number of radio stations
have entered into LMAs. The FCC's multiple ownership rules  specifically  permit
radio station LMAs to be entered into and  implemented,  so long as the licensee
of the  station  which is being  programmed  under  the LMA  maintains  complete
responsibility  for and control over programming and operations of its broadcast
station and assures  compliance with applicable FCC rules and policies.  For the
purposes of the multiple  ownership  rules,  in general,  a radio  station being
programmed  pursuant to an LMA by an entity is not  considered  an  attributable
ownership  interest of that  entity  unless  that  entity  already  owns a radio
station in the same market.  However,  a licensee that owns a radio station in a
market,  and brokers  more than 15% of the time on another  station  serving the
same market,  is considered to have an  attributable  ownership  interest in the
brokered  station  for  purposes of the FCC's  multiple  ownership  rules.  As a
result, in a market in which the Company owns a radio station, the Company would
not be permitted to enter into an LMA with another  local radio station which it
could not own under the local ownership rules, unless the Company's  programming
constituted 15% or less of the other local station's program-


                                      S-54
<PAGE>

ming time on a weekly basis. The FCC's rules also prohibit a broadcast  licensee
from  simulcasting  more than 25% of its  programming on another  station in the
same broadcast  service  (i.e.,  AM-AM or FM-FM) through a time brokerage or LMA
arrangement  where the brokered and brokering  stations serve  substantially the
same area.

     Joint  Sales  Agreements.  Over the past few years,  a number of radio (and
television) stations have entered into cooperative  arrangements  commonly known
as joint sales  agreements,  or JSAs.  While these  agreements  may take varying
forms,  under the typical JSA, a station licensee obtains,  for a fee, the right
to sell  substantially all of the commercial  advertising on a  separately-owned
and  licensed  station in the same  market.  The  typical  JSA also  customarily
involves the provision by the selling licensee of certain sales, accounting, and
"back  office"  services to the station  whose  advertising  is being sold.  The
typical JSA is distinct  from an LMA in that a JSA (unlike an LMA) normally does
not involve programming.

     The FCC has  determined  that issues of joint  advertising  sales should be
left to enforcement by antitrust  authorities,  and therefore does not generally
regulate joint sales practices between stations. Currently, stations for which a
licensee  sells time  under a JSA are not  deemed by the FCC to be  attributable
interests of that licensee.  However,  in connection with its ongoing rulemaking
proceeding concerning the attribution rules, the FCC is considering whether JSAs
should be  considered  attributable  interests  or within the scope of the FCC's
cross-interest policy,  particularly when JSAs contain provisions for the supply
of programming services and/or other elements typically associated with LMAs. If
JSAs become attributable  interests as a result of changes in the FCC rules, the
Company may be required to terminate  any JSA it might have with a radio station
which the Company could not own under the FCC's multiple ownership rules.


Other Ownership Matters

     There  remain  in  place  after  the  1996  Act  a  number  of   additional
cross-ownership rules and prohibitions pertaining to licensees of television and
radio stations. FCC rules, the Communications Act, or both generally prohibit an
individual or entity from having an  attributable  interest in both a television
station and a radio station,  a daily newspaper,  or a cable  television  system
that is located in or serves the same market area.

     Antitrust  Regulation.  The DOJ  and  the  Federal  Trade  Commission  have
increased their scrutiny of the television and radio industry since the adoption
of the 1996 Act, and have indicated their intention to review matters related to
the  concentration  of ownership  within markets  (including LMAs and JSAs) even
when  the  ownership  or LMA or JSA in  question  is  permitted  under  the laws
administered by the FCC or by FCC rules and regulations.


     Radio/Television   Cross-Ownership   Rule.   The   FCC's   radio/television
cross-ownership  rule (the "one to a market" rule) generally  prohibits a single
individual  or entity  from  having an  attributable  interest  in a  television
station and a radio station serving the same market.  However, in each of the 25
largest local markets in the United States,  provided that there are at least 30
separately owned stations in the particular  market,  the FCC has  traditionally
employed a policy that presumptively  allows waivers of the one to a market rule
to permit  the  common  ownership  of one AM,  one FM and one TV  station in the
market. The 1996 Act directs the FCC to extend this policy to each of the top 50
markets.  Moreover,  the FCC has pending a rulemaking proceeding in which it has
solicited  comment  on whether  the one to a market  rule  should be  eliminated
altogether.  The  Company  has  pending  several  requests  for  waivers  of the
"one-to-a-market"  rule in  connection  with its  applications  to acquire radio
stations in the Heritage  Acquisition Markets where the Company owns or proposes
to own a television station. 

     However,  the FCC does not apply  its  presumptive  waiver  policy in cases
involving the common ownership of one television station,  and two or more radio
stations in the same service (AM or FM), in the same market. Pending its ongoing
rulemaking  proceeding to reexamine the one to a market rule, the FCC has stated
that it will consider  waivers of the rule in such  instances on a  case-by-case
basis,  considering  (i) the public  service  benefits  that will arise from the
joint operation of the facilities  such as economies of scale,  cost savings and
programming and service benefits;  (ii) the types of facilities involved;  (iii)
the number of media outlets owned by the applicant in the relevant market;  (iv)
the financial  difficulties of the stations involved;  and (v) the nature of the
relevant market in light of the level of


                                      S-55
<PAGE>

competition  and diversity  after joint  operation is  implemented.  The FCC has
stated  that  it  expects  that  any  such  waivers  that  are  granted  will be
conditioned on the outcome of the rulemaking proceeding.

     In its ongoing rulemaking proceeding to reexamine the one to a market rule,
the FCC has proposed the  following  options for modifying the rule in the event
it is not  eliminated:  (i)  extending  the  presumptive  waiver  policy  to any
television  market in which a specified  number of  independently  owned  voices
would  remain after  common  ownership  of a television  station and one or more
radio stations is effectuated;  (ii) extending the presumptive  waiver policy to
entities  that seek to own more than one FM and/or one AM radio  station;  (iii)
reducing the minimum number of independently owned voices that must remain after
a transaction is effectuated;  and (iv) modifying the  five-factor  case-by-case
test for waivers.

     Local Television/Cable  Cross-Ownership Rule. While the 1996 Act eliminates
a previous  statutory  prohibition  against the common ownership of a television
broadcast station and a cable system that serve the same local market,  the 1996
Act leaves the current  FCC rule in place.  The  legislative  history of the Act
indicates  that the repeal of the  statutory ban should not prejudge the outcome
of any FCC review of the rule.

     Broadcast Network/Cable  Cross-Ownership Rule. The 1996 Act directs the FCC
to  eliminate  its rules which  formerly  prohibited  the common  ownership of a
broadcast  network and a cable  system,  subject to the  provision  that the FCC
revise its rules as  necessary  to ensure  carriage,  channel  positioning,  and
non-discriminatory  treatment  of  non-affiliated  broadcast  stations  by cable
systems  affiliated with a broadcast  network.  In March 1996, the FCC issued an
order implementing this legislative change.

     Broadcast/Daily  Newspaper  Cross-Ownership  Rule. The FCC's rules prohibit
the common  ownership  of a radio or  television  broadcast  station and a daily
newspaper  in the same  market.  The 1996 Act does not  eliminate or modify this
prohibition. In October 1996, however, the FCC initiated a rulemaking proceeding
to  determine  whether it should  liberalize  its waiver  policy with respect to
cross-ownership  of a daily newspaper and one or more radio stations in the same
market.

     Dual  Network  Rule.  The 1996 Act directs the FCC to repeal its rule which
formerly  prohibited an entity from operating more than one television  network.
In March 1996, the FCC issued an order  implementing  this  legislative  change.
Under the modified  rule, a network entity is permitted to operate more than one
television  network,  provided,  however,  that ABC,  CBS,  NBC,  and/or Fox are
prohibited  from  merging  with each other or with  another  network  television
entity such as WB or UPN.

     Expansion  of the  Company's  broadcast  operations  on  both a  local  and
national level will continue to be subject to the FCC's  ownership rules and any
changes the FCC or Congress may adopt. Concomitantly,  any further relaxation of
the FCC's  ownership  rules may increase the level of competition in one or more
of the markets in which the Company's stations are located, more specifically to
the extent that any of the Company's  competitors may have greater resources and
thereby be in a superior position to take advantage of such changes.


Must-Carry/Retransmission Consent

     Pursuant to the Cable Act of 1992, television  broadcasters are required to
make   triennial   elections  to  exercise   either  certain   "must-carry"   or
"retransmission  consent"  rights in  connection  with their  carriage  by cable
systems in each broadcaster's local market. By electing the must-carry rights, a
broadcaster  demands carriage on a specified channel on cable systems within its
Area of  Dominant  Influence,  in general as  defined  by the  Arbitron  1991-92
Television  Market Guide.  These must-carry  rights are not absolute,  and their
exercise is dependent on variables such as (i) the number of activated  channels
on a cable system;  (ii) the location and size of a cable system;  and (iii) the
amount of programming on a broadcast  station that duplicates the programming of
another broadcast station carried by the cable system. Therefore,  under certain
circumstances,   a  cable   system  may  decline  to  carry  a  given   station.
Alternatively,  if a  broadcaster  chooses to  exercise  retransmission  consent
rights,  it can prohibit  cable  systems  from  carrying its signal or grant the
appropriate  cable system the authority to retransmit the broadcast signal for a
fee or other  consideration.  In October 1996, the Company elected must-carry or
retransmission  consent  with  respect  to  each  of its  markets  based  on its
evaluation of the respective  markets and the position of the Company's  station
within  the  market.  The  Company's  stations  continue  to be  carried  on all
pertinent cable systems,


                                      S-56
<PAGE>

and the  Company  does not  believe  that its  elections  have  resulted  in the
shifting of its stations to less desirable cable channel  locations.  Certain of
the Company's stations affiliated with Fox are required to elect  retransmission
consent  because  Fox's  retransmission  consent  negotiations  on behalf of the
Company  resulted in agreements which extend into 1998.  Therefore,  the Company
will   need  to   negotiate   retransmission   consent   agreements   for  these
Fox-affiliated  stations to attain  carriage on those relevant cable systems for
the balance of this  triennial  period (i.e.,  through  December 31, 1999).  For
subsequent  elections beginning with the election to be made by October 1, 1999,
the  must-carry  market will be the station's  DMA, in general as defined by the
Nielsen DMA Market and Demographic Rank Report of the prior year.

     The must-carry rules have been subject to judicial scrutiny. In April 1993,
the United States District Court for the District of Columbia  summarily  upheld
the  constitutionality  of the legislative  must-carry  provisions under a First
Amendment challenge.  However, in June 1994, the Supreme Court remanded the case
to the  lower  court  with  instructions  to test the  constitutionality  of the
must-carry rules under an "intermediate scrutiny" standard. In a decision issued
in December 1995, a closely divided three-judge  District Court panel ruled that
the record showed that there was substantial evidence before Congress from which
it could  draw the  reasonable  inferences  that (1) the  must-carry  rules were
necessary to protect the local broadcast industry;  and (2) the burdens on cable
systems  with  rapidly   increasing  channel  capacity  would  be  quite  small.
Accordingly,  the District  Court panel ruled that Congress had not violated the
First  Amendment in enacting the  "must-carry"  provisions.  In March 1997,  the
Supreme Court,  by a 5-4 majority,  affirmed the District  Court's  decision and
thereby let stand the must-carry rules.


Syndicated Exclusivity/Territorial Exclusivity

     The FCC has imposed  syndicated  exclusivity  rules and  expanded  existing
network  nonduplication  rules.  The  syndicated  exclusivity  rules allow local
broadcast   television  stations  to  demand  that  cable  operators  black  out
syndicated  non-network  programming carried on "distant signals" (i.e., signals
of broadcast stations,  including so-called  "superstations,"  which serve areas
substantially  removed from the cable  system's  local  community).  The network
non-duplication  rules allow local broadcast  network  television  affiliates to
require that cable operators black out duplicating  network  programming carried
on distant signals. However, in a number of markets in which the Company owns or
programs stations  affiliated with a network,  a station that is affiliated with
the same network in a nearby market is carried on cable systems in the Company's
market.  This is not in violation  of the FCC's  network  nonduplication  rules.
However,  the  carriage of two network  stations on the same cable  system could
result in a decline  of  viewership  adversely  affecting  the  revenues  of the
Company owned or programmed station.


Restrictions on Broadcast Advertising

     Advertising of cigarettes  and certain other tobacco  products on broadcast
stations has been banned for many years. Various states restrict the advertising
of  alcoholic  beverages.   Congressional   committees  have  recently  examined
legislation  proposals which may eliminate or severely  restrict the advertising
of beer and wine. Although no prediction can be made as to whether any or all of
the present  proposals will be enacted into law, the elimination of all beer and
wine advertising would have an adverse effect upon the revenues of the Company's
stations,  as well as the revenues of other  stations  which carry beer and wine
advertising.

     The FCC has imposed  commercial time  limitations in children's  television
programming pursuant to legislation. In television programs designed for viewing
by  children  of 12 years of age and under,  commercial  matter is limited to 12
minutes per hour on weekdays and 10.5 minutes per hour on weekends.  In granting
renewal of the  license  for  WBFF-TV,  the FCC imposed a fine of $10,000 on the
Company  alleging that the station had exceeded these  limitations.  The Company
has appealed this fine and the appeal is pending.

     The  Communications  Act and  FCC  rules  also  place  restrictions  on the
broadcasting  of  advertisements  by legally  qualified  candidates for elective
office.  Among other things, (i) stations must provide  "reasonable  access" for
the purchase of time by legally  qualified  candidates for federal office;  (ii)
stations  must provide  "equal  opportunities"  for the  purchase of  equivalent
amounts  of  comparable  broadcast  time by  opposing  candidates  for the  same
elective office; and (iii) during the 45 days preceding a


                                      S-57
<PAGE>

primary or primary  run-off  election and during the 60 days preceding a general
or special  election,  legally  qualified  candidates for elective office may be
charged no more than the  station's  "lowest  unit charge" for the same class of
advertisement, length of advertisement, and daypart.


Programming and Operation

     General. The Communications Act requires  broadcasters to serve the "public
interest."  The FCC  gradually  has  relaxed  or  eliminated  many  of the  more
formalized  procedures  it had developed in the past to promote the broadcast of
certain types of programming responsive to the needs of a station's community of
license. FCC licensees continue to be required,  however, to present programming
that is responsive to their communities' issues, and to maintain certain records
demonstrating  such   responsiveness.   Complaints  from  viewers  concerning  a
station's  programming  may be considered  by the FCC when it evaluates  renewal
applications  of a licensee,  although such  complaints may be filed at any time
and generally  may be considered by the FCC at any time.  Stations also must pay
regulatory and application  fees, and follow various rules promulgated under the
Communications  Act that regulate,  among other things,  political  advertising,
sponsorship  identifications,  the  advertisement  of  contests  and  lotteries,
obscene and indecent broadcasts,  and technical operations,  including limits on
radiofrequency  radiation.  In addition,  licensees  must develop and  implement
affirmative action programs designed to promote equal employment  opportunities,
and must submit  reports to the FCC with  respect to these  matters on an annual
basis and in connection with a renewal application.  Failure to observe these or
other rules and  policies  can result in the  imposition  of various  sanctions,
including monetary  forfeitures,  or the grant of a "short" (i.e., less than the
full) license renewal term or, for particularly egregious violations, the denial
of a license renewal application or the revocation of a license.

     Children's Television Programming. Pursuant to legislation enacted in 1991,
all  television  stations  have  been  required  to  broadcast  some  television
programming designed to meet the educational and informational needs of children
16 years of age and under.  In August  1996,  the FCC adopted new rules  setting
forth  more  stringent  children's   programming   requirements.   Specifically,
television  stations  are now required to broadcast a minimum of three hours per
week of "core"  children's  educational  programming,  which the FCC  defines as
programming  that (i) has serving the  educational  and  informational  needs of
children 16 years of age and under as a significant  purpose;  (ii) is regularly
scheduled,  weekly  and at least 30  minutes  in  duration;  and  (iii) is aired
between the hours of 7:00 a.m.  and 10:00 p.m.  Furthermore,  "core"  children's
educational programs, in order to qualify as such, are required to be identified
as  educational  and  informational  programs  over the air at the time they are
broadcast,  and are  required to be  identified  in the  children's  programming
reports   required  to  be  placed  in  stations'   public   inspection   files.
Additionally,   television   stations  are  required  to  identify  and  provide
information  concerning "core"  children's  programming to publishers of program
guides and listings.

     Television Violence.  The 1996 Act contains a number of provisions relating
to television violence. First, pursuant to the 1996 Act, the television industry
has  developed  a ratings  system,  and the FCC has  recently  solicited  public
comment on that system.  Furthermore,  the 1996 Act provides that all television
sets larger than 13 inches that are manufactured one year after enactment of the
1996 Act must  include  the  so-called  "V-chip,"  a computer  chip that  allows
blocking of rated  programming.  In  addition,  the 1996 Act  requires  that all
television  license  renewal  applications  filed  after  May  1,  1995  contain
summaries of written  comments and suggestions  received by the station from the
public regarding violent programming.

     Closed  Captioning.  The 1996 Act directs the FCC to adopt rules  requiring
closed  captioning  of  all  broadcast  television  programming,   except  where
captioning would be "economically burdensome." The FCC has recently adopted such
rules.  The rules require  generally that (i) 95% of all new  programming  first
published  or  exhibited  on or after  January 1, 1998 must be closed  captioned
within eight years, and (ii) 75% of "old" programming which first aired prior to
January  1, 1998 must be closed  captioned  within 10 years,  subject to certain
exemptions.


Digital Television

     The FCC has taken a number of steps to implement digital television ("DTV")
broadcasting  service in the United States.  In December 1996, the FCC adopted a
DTV broadcast standard and, in April 1997,


                                      S-58
<PAGE>

adopted  decisions in several  pending  rulemaking  proceedings  that  establish
service  rules and a plan for  implementing  DTV. The FCC adopted a DTV Table of
Allotments  that  provides  all  authorized  television  stations  with a second
channel on which to broadcast a DTV signal. The FCC has attempted to provide DTV
coverage areas that are comparable to stations'  existing service areas. The FCC
has ruled that television broadcast licensees may use their digital channels for
a wide variety of services such as high-definition television, multiple standard
definition   television   programming,   audio,   data,   and  other   types  of
communications,  subject to the  requirement  that each  broadcaster  provide at
least one free video channel equal in quality to the current technical standard.

     Initially,  DTV  channels  will be  located in the range of  channels  from
channel 2 through  channel 51. The FCC is requiring that affiliates of ABC, CBS,
Fox and NBC in the top 10 television  markets begin digital  broadcasting by May
1, 1999 (the stations  affiliated with these networks in the top 10 markets have
voluntarily  committed to begin digital broadcasting within 18 months), and that
affiliates of these networks in markets 11 through 30 begin digital broadcasting
by November 1999.  The FCC's plan calls for the DTV transition  period to end in
the year  2006,  at which time the FCC  expects  that (i) DTV  channels  will be
clustered either in the range of channels 2 through 46 or channels 7 through 51;
and  (ii)  television  broadcasters  will  have  ceased  broadcasting  on  their
non-digital  channels,  allowing that spectrum to be recovered by the government
for other uses. Under the Balanced Budget Act, however, the FCC is authorized to
extend the December 31, 2006 deadline for reclamation of a television  station's
non-digital  channel if, in any given case: (i) one or more television  stations
affiliated with one of the four major networks in a market are not  broadcasting
digitally,  and the FCC  determines  that  such  stations  have  "exercised  due
diligence" in attempting to convert to digital broadcasting;  (ii) less than 85%
of the television households in the station's market subscribe to a multichannel
video service  (cable,  wireless cable or DBS) that carries at least one digital
channel from each of the local  stations in that market;  or (iii) less than 85%
of the television households in the station's market can receive digital signals
off the air using either a set-top converter box for an analog television set or
a new DTV  television  set.  The  Balanced  Budget Act also  directs  the FCC to
auction the non-digital  channels by September 30, 2002 even though they are not
to be reclaimed by the government until at least December 31, 2006. The Balanced
Budget Act also  permits  broadcasters  to bid on the  non-digital  channels  in
cities with populations greater than 400,000, provided the channels are used for
DTV. Thus, it is possible a broadcaster could own two channels in a market.  The
FCC has opened a separate  proceeding  in which it has  proposed  to  reallocate
television  channels 60 through 69 to other services while  protecting  existing
television   stations  on  those  channels  from  interference  during  the  DTV
transition  period.  Additionally,  the FCC will open a separate  proceeding  to
consider  to what  extent the cable  must-carry  requirements  will apply to DTV
signals.

     Implementation of digital  television will improve the technical quality of
television signals received by viewers.  Under certain  circumstances,  however,
conversion to digital operation may reduce a station's  geographic coverage area
or result in some increased interference.  The FCC's DTV allotment plan may also
result in UHF  stations  having  considerably  less signal  power  within  their
service areas than present VHF stations  that move to DTV channels.  The Company
has filed with the FCC a petition for reconsideration of the FCC's DTV allotment
plan because of its concerns  with respect to the relative DTV signal  powers of
VHF/UHF and UHF/UHF  stations.  Implementation  of digital  television will also
impose substantial  additional costs on television  stations because of the need
to replace  equipment  and because some  stations will need to operate at higher
utility  costs.  The  FCC is  also  considering  imposing  new  public  interest
requirements  on  television  licensees  in  exchange  for their  receipt of DTV
channels. The Company is currently considering plans to provide HDTV, to provide
multiple channels of television, including the provision of additional broadcast
programming and transmitted  data on a subscription  basis,  and to continue its
current TV program channels without  subscription fees on its allocated portions
of the broadcast spectrum.  The 1996 Act allows the FCC to charge a spectrum fee
to  broadcasters  who use  the  digital  spectrum  to  offer  subscription-based
services.  The FCC is  expected  to  open a  rulemaking  in the  fall of 1997 to
consider  the  spectrum  fees to be charged  to  broadcasters  for such use.  In
addition,  Congress is holding  hearings on  broadcasters'  plans for the use of
their digital  spectrum.  The Company cannot predict what future actions the FCC
or Congress might take with respect to DTV, nor can it predict the effect of the
FCC's present DTV  implementation  plan or such future  actions on the Company's
business. 


                                      S-59
<PAGE>

Proposed Changes

     The  Congress and the FCC have under  consideration,  and in the future may
consider and adopt, new laws,  regulations and policies regarding a wide variety
of matters that could affect, directly or indirectly,  the operation,  ownership
and  profitability of the Company's  broadcast  stations,  result in the loss of
audience share and advertising  revenues for the Company's  broadcast  stations,
and affect the ability of the Company to acquire  additional  broadcast stations
or finance such  acquisitions.  In addition to the changes and proposed  changes
noted above, such matters may include, for example, the license renewal process,
spectrum use fees, political  advertising rates,  potential  restrictions on the
advertising of certain products (beer, wine and hard liquor,  for example),  and
the rules and  policies to be applied in  enforcing  the FCC's equal  employment
opportunity regulations. Other matters that could affect the Company's broadcast
properties  include   technological   innovations  and  developments   generally
affecting competition in the mass communications  industry, such as direct radio
and television  broadcast  satellite  service,  the continued  establishment  of
wireless cable systems and low power television stations, digital television and
radio  technologies,  and the advent of telephone  company  participation in the
provision of video programming service.


Other Considerations

     The foregoing  summary does not purport to be a complete  discussion of all
provisions  of the  Communications  Act or  other  congressional  acts or of the
regulations and policies of the FCC. For further  information,  reference should
be made to the Communications Act, other congressional acts, and regulations and
public  notices  promulgated  from time to time by the FCC. There are additional
regulations  and  policies  of the FCC and other  federal  agencies  that govern
political broadcasts, public affairs programming,  equal employment opportunity,
and other matters affecting the Company's business and operations.



ENVIRONMENTAL REGULATION

     Prior to the Company's ownership or operation of its facilities, substances
or  waste  that  are  or  might  be  considered   hazardous   under   applicable
environmental  laws may have been  generated,  used,  stored or  disposed  of at
certain of those facilities.  In addition,  environmental conditions relating to
the soil and groundwater at or under the Company's facilities may be affected by
the proximity of nearby properties that have generated, used, stored or disposed
of hazardous  substances.  As a result,  it is possible  that the Company  could
become subject to  environmental  liabilities  in the future in connection  with
these facilities under applicable  environmental laws and regulations.  Although
the  Company   believes  that  it  is  in  substantial   compliance   with  such
environmental  requirements,  and have not in the past  been  required  to incur
significant  costs in connection  therewith,  there can be no assurance that the
Company's  costs to  comply  with such  requirements  will not  increase  in the
future.  The Company  presently  believes that none of its  properties  have any
condition  that is likely to have a  material  adverse  effect on the  Company's
financial condition or results of operations.


COMPETITION

     The Company's  television and radio stations compete for audience share and
advertising revenue with other television and radio stations in their respective
DMAs or MSAs,  as well as with  other  advertising  media,  such as  newspapers,
magazines,  outdoor advertising,  transit advertising,  yellow page directories,
direct mail and local cable and wireless cable  systems.  Some  competitors  are
part of larger organizations with substantially greater financial, technical and
other resources than the Company.

     Television Competition. Competition in the television broadcasting industry
occurs  primarily in  individual  DMAs.  Generally,  a  television  broadcasting
station in one DMA does not compete with  stations in other DMAs.  The Company's
television stations are located in highly competitive DMAs. In addition, certain
of the Company's DMAs are overlapped by both  over-the-air and cable carriage of
stations in adjacent  DMAs,  which tends to spread  viewership  and  advertising
expenditures over a larger number of television stations.


                                      S-60
<PAGE>

     Broadcast  television  stations compete for advertising  revenues primarily
with other  broadcast  television  stations,  radio  stations  and cable  system
operators serving the same market.  Traditional  Network  programming  generally
achieves higher  household  audience levels than Fox, WB and UPN programming and
syndicated programming aired by independent stations.  This can be attributed to
a combination of factors, including the Traditional Networks' efforts to reach a
broader audience,  generally better signal carriage  available when broadcasting
over VHF channels 2 through 13 versus  broadcasting over UHF channels 14 through
69 and the  higher  number of hours of  Traditional  Network  programming  being
broadcast weekly. However, greater amounts of advertising time are available for
sale during Fox, UPN and WB programming and non-network syndicated  programming,
and as a result the Company  believes that the Company's  programming  typically
achieves a share of  television  market  advertising  revenues  greater than its
share of the market's audience.

     Television  stations  compete for audience share  primarily on the basis of
program  popularity,  which has a direct effect on  advertising  rates.  A large
amount of the  Company's  prime time  programming  is  supplied  by Fox and to a
lesser extent WB, UPN, ABC and CBS. In those periods,  the Company's  affiliated
stations are totally dependent upon the performance of the networks' programs in
attracting  viewers.  Non-network  time  periods are  programmed  by the station
primarily  with  syndicated  programs  purchased for cash,  cash and barter,  or
barter-only,  and also  through  self-produced  news,  public  affairs and other
entertainment programming.

     Television  advertising rates are based upon factors which include the size
of the DMA in which the  station  operates,  a  program's  popularity  among the
viewers  that an  advertiser  wishes  to  attract,  the  number  of  advertisers
competing for the available  time, the  demographic  makeup of the DMA served by
the  station,  the  availability  of  alternative  advertising  media in the DMA
(including radio and cable), the aggressiveness and knowledge of sales forces in
the DMA and  development of projects,  features and programs that tie advertiser
messages to  programming.  The Company  believes that its sales and  programming
strategies allow it to compete effectively for advertising within its DMAs.

     Other  factors  that are  material to a  television  station's  competitive
position include signal coverage, local program acceptance, network affiliation,
audience  characteristics and assigned broadcast  frequency.  Historically,  the
Company's UHF broadcast  stations  have suffered a competitive  disadvantage  in
comparison   to  stations  with  VHF   broadcast   frequencies.   This  historic
disadvantage has gradually declined through (i) carriage on cable systems,  (ii)
improvement   in  television   receivers,   (iii)   improvement   in  television
transmitters, (iv) wider use of all channel antennae, (v) increased availability
of  programming,  and (vi) the  development  of new networks such as Fox, WB and
UPN.

     The broadcasting  industry is continuously faced with technical changes and
innovations, the popularity of competing entertainment and communications media,
changes in labor conditions, and governmental restrictions or actions of federal
regulatory  bodies,  including  the FCC,  any of  which  could  possibly  have a
material  effect on a television  station's  operations  and profits.  There are
sources of video service other than conventional  television stations,  the most
common being cable  television,  which can increase  competition for a broadcast
television station by bringing into its market distant  broadcasting signals not
otherwise available to the station's audience,  serving as a distribution system
for national satellite-delivered programming and other non-broadcast programming
originated on a cable system and selling  advertising time to local advertisers.
Other  principal   sources  of  competition   include  home  video   exhibition,
direct-to-home broadcast satellite television ("DBS") entertainment services and
multichannel  multipoint  distribution services ("MMDS").  Moreover,  technology
advances and regulatory  changes  affecting  programming  delivery through fiber
optic telephone lines and video  compression  could lower entry barriers for new
video channels and encourage the development of increasingly specialized "niche"
programming.   The  1996  Act  permits  telephone  companies  to  provide  video
distribution  services via radio  communication,  on a common carrier basis,  as
"cable  systems"  or  as  "open  video  systems,"  each  pursuant  to  different
regulatory   schemes.   The  Company  is  unable  to  predict  the  effect  that
technological  and  regulatory  changes  will have on the  broadcast  television
industry and on the future  profitability  and value of a  particular  broadcast
television station.

     The FCC  authorizes DBS services  throughout the United States.  Currently,
two FCC permitees,  DirecTV and United States  Satellite  Broadcasting,  provide
subscription DBS services via high-power


                                      S-61
<PAGE>

communications  satellites and small dish receivers, and other companies provide
direct-to-home   video  service  using  lower  powered   satellites  and  larger
receivers.   Additional  companies  are  expected  to  commence   direct-to-home
operations in the near future.  DBS and MMDS, as well as other new technologies,
will further increase competition in the delivery of video programming.

     The Company  cannot  predict what other  matters might be considered in the
future,  nor can it judge in advance what impact, if any, the  implementation of
any of these proposals or changes might have on its business.

     The  Company   believes  that  television   broadcasting  may  be  enhanced
significantly   by  the  development  and  increased   availability  of  digital
broadcasting service technology. This technology has the potential to permit the
Company to provide viewers multiple channels of digital  television over each of
its  existing  standard  channels,  to  provide  certain  programming  in a high
definition  television  format and to deliver  various forms of data,  including
data  on  the  Internet,  to  home  and  business  computers.  These  additional
capabilities  may provide the Company with  additional  sources of revenue.  The
Company is currently  considering  plans to provide  HDTV,  to provide  multiple
channels  of  television   including  the  provision  of  additional   broadcast
programming and transmitted  data on a subscription  basis,  and to continue its
current TV program channels without  subscription fees on its allocated portions
of the broadcast spectrum.  The 1996 Act allows the FCC to charge a spectrum fee
to  broadcasters  who use  the  digital  spectrum  to  offer  subscription-based
services.  The FCC is  expected  to  open a  rulemaking  in the  fall of 1997 to
consider  the  spectrum  fees to be charged  to  broadcasters  for such use.  In
addition,  Congress is holding  hearings on  broadcasters'  plans for the use of
their digital  spectrum.  The Company cannot predict what future actions the FCC
or Congress might take with respect to DTV, nor can it predict the effect of the
FCC's present DTV  implementation  plan or such future  actions on the Company's
business.   This  digital  broadcasting  service  technology  is  not  currently
available  to the viewing  public and a successful  transition  from the current
analog broadcast format to a digital format may take many years. There can be no
assurance  that the Company's  efforts to take  advantage of the new  technology
will be commercially successful.

     The Company also competes for programming,  which involves negotiating with
national  program  distributors  or  syndicators  that sell  first-run and rerun
packages of programming.  The Company's stations compete for exclusive access to
those programs against in-market  broadcast  station  competitors for syndicated
products.  Cable  systems  generally  do not  compete  with local  stations  for
programming,  although  various  national  cable networks from time to time have
acquired  programs that would have  otherwise  been offered to local  television
stations.   Public  broadcasting  stations  generally  compete  with  commercial
broadcasters for viewers but not for advertising dollars.

     Historically,  the cost of programming has increased because of an increase
in the number of new Independent stations and a shortage of quality programming.
However,  the  Company  believes  that over the past five years  program  prices
generally have stabilized.

     The  Company  believes  it  competes  favorably  against  other  television
stations  because of its  management  skill and  experience,  the ability of the
Company  historically to generate revenue share greater than its audience share,
the network  affiliations  and its local program  acceptance.  In addition,  the
Company  believes  that it benefits  from the  operation  of multiple  broadcast
properties,   affording  it  certain  nonquantifiable  economies  of  scale  and
competitive advantages in the purchase of programming.

     Radio Competition. Radio broadcasting is a highly competitive business, and
each of the radio stations  operated by the Company  competes for audience share
and  advertising  revenue  directly with other radio  stations in its geographic
market,  as well as with other media,  including  television,  cable television,
newspapers,  magazines,  direct mail and  billboard  advertising.  The  audience
ratings and advertising  revenue of each of such stations are subject to change,
and any adverse  change in a  particular  market  could have a material  adverse
effect on the revenue of such radio stations  located in that market.  There can
be no assurance  that any one of the  Company's  radio  stations will be able to
maintain or increase its current audience ratings and radio advertising  revenue
market share.

     The  Company  will  attempt to improve  each  radio  station's  competitive
position  with  promotional  campaigns  designed  to enhance and  reinforce  its
identities with the listening public.  Extensive market research is conducted in
order to identify specific demographic groups and design a programming format


                                      S-62
<PAGE>

for those groups.  The Company seeks to build a strong listener base composed of
specific  demographic  groups in each market,  and thereby  attract  advertisers
seeking to reach these listeners.  Aside from building its stations'  identities
and  targeting  its  programming  at  specific  demographic  groups,  management
believes  that the Company  also  obtains a  competitive  advantage by operating
duopolies or multiple stations in the nation's larger mid-size markets.

     The radio  broadcasting  industry is also subject to  competition  from new
media technologies that are being developed or introduced,  such as the delivery
of  audio  programming  by  cable  television   systems  and  by  digital  audio
broadcasting  ("DAB"). DAB may provide a medium for the delivery by satellite or
terrestrial  means of  multiple  new  audio  programming  formats  to local  and
national   audiences.   The  FCC  has  issued  licenses  for  two  DAB  systems.
Historically,  the  radio  broadcasting  industry  has  grown  in terms of total
revenues  despite  the  introduction  of new  technologies  for the  delivery of
entertainment   and  information,   such  as  television   broadcasting,   cable
television,  audio tapes and compact disks. There can be no assurance,  however,
that the development or  introduction in the future of any new media  technology
will not have an adverse effect on the radio broadcast industry.


EMPLOYEES

     As of September 17, 1997, the Company had  approximately  2,300  employees.
With the exception of certain of the employees of KOVR-TV,  KDNL-TV, WBEN-AM and
WWL-AM,  none of the  employees  are  represented  by  labor  unions  under  any
collective  bargaining  agreement.  No  significant  labor  problems  have  been
experienced  by the  Company,  and  the  Company  considers  its  overall  labor
relations to be good. 


LEGAL PROCEEDINGS

     On July 14,  1997,  Sinclair  publicly  announced  that it had  reached  an
agreement for certain of its owned and/or programmed  television  stations which
are currently affiliated with UPN to become affiliated with WB beginning January
16,  1998.  On August 1, 1997,  UPN  informed  Sinclair  that it did not believe
Sinclair or its  affiliates  had provided  proper notice of its intention not to
extend the UPN affiliation agreements beyond January 15, 1998, and, accordingly,
that these agreements had been automatically renewed through January 15, 2001.

     In August 1997,  UPN filed an action in Los Angeles  Superior Court against
the Company,  seeking  declaratory  relief and specific  performance  or, in the
alternative,  unspecified  damages and alleging that neither the Company nor its
affiliates  provided  proper notice of their intention not to extend the current
UPN affiliations  beyond January 15, 1998.  Certain  subsidiaries of the Company
have filed an action in the Circuit Court for Baltimore City seeking declaratory
relief that their notice was effective to terminate the  affiliations on January
15, 1998.  Although the Company  believes that proper notice of intention not to
extend was provided to UPN,  there can be no assurance  that the Company and its
subsidiaries  will  prevail in these  proceedings  or that the  outcome of these
proceedings,  if adverse to the  Company and its  subsidiaries,  will not have a
material adverse effect on the Company.

     The  Company  currently  and from time to time is  involved  in  litigation
incidental  to the  conduct of its  business.  Except as  described  above,  the
Company is not a party to any lawsuit or  proceeding  that in the opinion of the
Company will have a material adverse effect.


                                      S-63
<PAGE>

                                  MANAGEMENT

     Set forth below is certain information  relating to the Company's executive
officers,  directors,  certain  key  employees  and  persons  expected to become
executive officers, directors or key employees.


<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
           NAME                 AGE                          TITLE
- -----------------------------   -----   -------------------------------------------------
<S>                             <C>     <C>
David D. Smith   ............   46      President, Chief Executive Officer, Director and
                                        Chairman of the Board
Frederick G. Smith  .........   48      Vice President and Director
J. Duncan Smith  ............   43      Vice President, Secretary and Director
Robert E. Smith  ............   34      Vice President, Treasurer and Director
David B. Amy  ...............   44      Chief Financial Officer
Barry Drake   ...............   45      Chief Operating Officer, SCI Radio
Alan B. Frank ...............   47      Regional Director, SCI
Robert Gluck  ...............   39      Regional Director, SCI
Michael Granados ............   42      Regional Director, SCI
Steven M. Marks  ............   40      Regional Director, SCI
John T. Quigley  ............   54      Regional Director, SCI
Frank Quitoni ...............   52      Regional Director, SCI
M. William Butler   .........   44      Vice President/Group Program Director, SCI
Michael Draman   ............   48      Vice President/TV Sales and Marketing, SCI
Stephen A. Eisenberg   ......   55      Vice President/Director of National Sales, SCI
Nat Ostroff   ...............   56      Vice President/New Technology
Delbert R. Parks, III  ......   44      Director of Operations and Engineering, SCI
Robert E. Quicksilver  ......   42      Vice President/General Counsel, SCI
Thomas E. Severson  .........   34      Corporate Controller
Michael E. Sileck   .........   37      Vice President/Finance, SCI
Robin A. Smith   ............   41      Chief Financial Officer, SCI Radio
Patrick J. Talamantes  ......   33      Director of Corporate Finance
Lawrence E. McCanna .........   53      Director
Basil A. Thomas  ............   82      Director
</TABLE>


     In addition to the foregoing, the following persons have agreed to serve as
executive  officers and/or directors of the Company as soon as permissible under
the rules of the FCC and applicable  laws.  See "Risk Factors - Dependence  Upon
Key  Personnel;  Employment  Agreements  with  Key  Personnel"  in the  attached
Prospectus.



<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
           NAME                AGE                         TITLE
- ----------------------------   -----   -----------------------------------------------
<S>                             <C>    <C>
Barry Baker  ...............    45     Executive Vice President of the Company, Chief
                                       Executive Officer of SCI and Director
Kerby Confer ...............    56     Chief Executive Officer, SCI Radio
Roy F. Coppedge, III  ......    49     Director
</TABLE>

     In  connection  with the River  City  Acquisition,  the  Company  agreed to
increase  the size of the  Board of  Directors  from  seven  members  to nine to
accommodate  the  prospective  appointment  of each of  Barry  Baker  and Roy F.
Coppedge,  III or such other designee as Boston  Ventures may select.  Mr. Baker
and Mr. Confer currently serve as consultants to the Company.

     Members of the Board of Directors are elected for one-year  terms and until
their  successors  are  duly  elected  and  qualified.  Executive  officers  are
appointed  by the Board of Directors  annually to serve for  one-year  terms and
until their successors are duly appointed and qualified.

     On  July  30,  1997 William E. Brock submitted and the Company accepted his
resignation  from  the  Company's  Board  of Directors. Currently, no action has
been taken by the Board of Directors to identify a replacement for Mr. Brock.

     David  D.  Smith  has  served  as  President,  Chief  Executive Officer and
Chairman  of the Board since September 1990. Prior to that, he served as General
Manager   of   WPTT  from  1984,  and  assumed  the  financial  and  engineering
responsibility for the Company, including the construction of WTTE in 1984. In


                                      S-64
<PAGE>

1980,  Mr. Smith  founded  Comark  Television,  Inc.,  which applied for and was
granted the permit for WPXT-TV in Portland, Maine and which purchased WDSI-TV in
Chattanooga, Tennessee. WPXT-TV was sold one year after construction and WDSI-TV
was  sold two  years  after  its  acquisition.  From  1978 to  1986,  Mr.  Smith
co-founded and served as an officer and director of Comark Communications, Inc.,
a  company  engaged  in the  manufacture  of  high  power  transmitters  for UHF
television stations.  His television career began with WBFF in Baltimore,  where
he helped in the  construction  of the  station  and was in charge of  technical
maintenance until 1978. David D. Smith,  Frederick G. Smith, J. Duncan Smith and
Robert E. Smith are brothers.

     Frederick G. Smith has served as Vice  President of the Company  since 1990
and as a Director  since 1986.  Prior to joining the Company in 1990,  Mr. Smith
was an oral and  maxillofacial  surgeon  engaged  in  private  practice  and was
employed by Frederick G. Smith, M.S., D.D.S.,  P.A., a professional  corporation
of which Mr. Smith was the sole officer, director and stockholder.

     J. Duncan Smith has served as Vice  President,  Secretary and a Director of
the Company since 1988. Prior to that, he worked for Comark Communications, Inc.
installing  UHF  transmitters.  In addition,  he also worked  extensively on the
construction  of WPTT in Pittsburgh,  WTTE in Columbus,  WIIB in Bloomington and
WTTA in St. Petersburg,  as well as on the renovation of the new studio, offices
and news facility for WBFF in Baltimore.

     Robert E. Smith has served as Vice  President,  Secretary and a Director of
the Company  since 1988.  Prior to that,  he served as Program  Director at WBFF
from 1986 to 1988.  Prior to that, he assisted in the  construction  of WTTE and
also worked for Comark Communications, Inc. installing UHF transmitters.

     David B. Amy has served as Chief Financial Officer ("CFO") since October of
1994. In addition, he serves as Secretary of Sinclair Communications,  Inc., the
Company subsidiary which owns and operates the broadcasting operations. Prior to
his appointment as CFO Mr. Amy served as the Corporate Controller of the Company
beginning in 1986 and has been the Company's Chief Accounting Officer since that
time. Mr. Amy has over thirteen years of broadcast experience, having joined the
Company as a business  manager for WPTT in  Pittsburgh.  Mr. Amy received an MBA
degree from the University of Pittsburgh in 1981.

     Barry  Drake  has  served as Chief  Operating  Officer  of SCI Radio  since
completion  of the River  City  Acquisition.  Prior to that  time,  he was Chief
Operating  Officer -  Keymarket  Radio  Division  of River City since July 1995.
Prior to that time, he was President  and Chief  Operating  Officer of Keymarket
since 1988.  From 1985  through  1988,  Mr.  Drake  performed  the duties of the
President of each of the Keymarket  broadcasting  entities,  with responsibility
for three stations located in Houston, St. Louis and Detroit.

     Alan  B.  Frank  has  served as Regional Director for the Company since May
1994.  As  Regional  Director,  Mr.  Frank is responsible for the Pittsburgh and
Kansas  City  markets.  Prior to his appointment to Regional Director, Mr. Frank
served as General Manager of WPGH beginning in September 1991.


     Robert  Gluck  has  served as Regional Director of the Company since August
1997.  As  Regional  Director,  Mr.  Gluck  is responsible for the Milwaukee and
Raleigh/Durham  markets.  Prior  to  joining  the  Company,  Mr. Gluck served as
General  Manager  at  WTIC-TV in the Hartford-New Haven market. Prior to joining
WTIC-TV  in  1988,  Mr.  Gluck  served as National Sales Manager and Local Sales
Manager  of  WLVI-TV  in  Boston.  Before  joining  WLVI-TV, Mr. Gluck served in
various   sales   and   management  capacities  with  New  York  national  sales
representative firms.


     Michael  Granados  has served as a Regional  Director of the Company  since
July 1996.  As a Regional  Director,  Mr.  Granados is  responsible  for the San
Antonio,  Des  Moines,  Peoria and Las Vegas  markets.  Prior to July 1996,  Mr.
Granados has served in various  positions with the Company and, before the River
City  Acquisition,  with River City.  He served as the General  Sales Manager of
KABB from 1989 to 1993,  the Station  Manager and Director of Sales of WTTV from
1993 to 1994  and the  General  Manager  of WTTV  prior  to his  appointment  as
Regional Director in 1996.

     Steven M. Marks has  served as  Regional  Director  for the  Company  since
October 1994. As Regional Director,  Mr. Marks is responsible for the Baltimore,
Norfolk,  Flint and  Birmingham  markets.  Prior to his  appointment as Regional
Director,  Mr.  Marks served as General  Manager for WBFF since July 1991.  From
1986 until  joining WBFF in 1991,  Mr. Marks served as General  Sales Manager at
WTTE. Prior to that time, he was national sales manager for WFLX-TV in West Palm
Beach, Florida.


                                      S-65
<PAGE>

     John T. Quigley has served as a Regional Director of the Company since June
1996.  As  Regional  Director,  Mr.  Quigley is  responsible  for the  Columbus,
Cincinnati, and Oklahoma City markets. Prior to that time, Mr. Quigley served as
general  manager of WTTE since July 1985.  Prior to joining  WTTE,  Mr.  Quigley
served in  broadcast  management  positions at WCPO-TV in  Cincinnati,  Ohio and
WPTV-TV in West Palm Beach, Florida.

     Frank  Quitoni  has  served  as a Regional Director since completion of the
River  City  Acquisition.  As  Regional Director, Mr. Quitoni is responsible for
the St. Louis, Sacramento, Indianapolis and Asheville/  Greenville/Spartanburg
markets.  Prior  to joining the Company, he was Vice President of Operations for
River  City since 1995. Mr. Quitoni had served as the Director of Operations and
Engineering  for  River  City  since 1994. Prior thereto Mr. Quitoni served as a
consultant  to  CBS  beginning  in 1989. Mr. Quitoni was the Director of Olympic
Operations  for  CBS Sports for the 1992 Winter Olympic Games and consulted with
CBS  for  the  1994  Winter Olympic Games. Mr. Quitoni was awarded the Technical
Achievement Emmy for the 1992 and 1994 CBS Olympic broadcasts.

     M. William Butler has served as Vice President/Group  Program Director, SCI
since 1997.  From 1995 to 1997,  Mr. Butler served as Director of Programming at
KCAL, the Walt Disney Company station in Los Angeles,  California.  From 1991 to
1995,  he was Director of Marketing  and  Programming  at WTXF in  Philadelphia,
Pennsylvania  and  prior to that he held the same  position  at WLVI in  Boston,
Massachusetts.   Mr.  Butler  attended  the  Graduate  Business  School  of  the
University of Cincinnati from 1975 to 1976.

     Michael  Draman  has  served  as Vice President/TV Sales and Marketing, SCI
since  1997.  From  1995  until  joining  the Company, Mr. Draman served as Vice
President  of  Revenue  Development for New World Television. From 1983 to 1995,
he  was  Director  of Sales and Marketing for WSVN in Miami, Florida. Mr. Draman
attended  The  American  University  and  The Harvard Business School and served
with the U.S. Marine Corps in Vietnam.

     Stephen A.  Eisenberg has served as Director of National  Sales,  SCI since
November  1996.  Prior to joining the  Company,  he worked since 1975 in various
capacities   at   Petry   Television,    including   most   recently   as   Vice
President/Director of Sales with total national sales responsibility for KTTV in
Los Angeles, California,  KCPQ-TV in Seattle, Washington,  WTNH-TV in New Haven,
Connecticut,  WKYC-TV  in  Cleveland,  Ohio,  WBIR-TV in  Knoxville,  Tennessee,
WKEF-TV in Dayton,  Ohio and  WTMJ-TV in  Milwaukee,  Wisconsin.  Mr.  Eisenberg
received an MS degree in Journalism from  Northwestern's  Medill School and a BA
degree from Brooklyn College.


     Nat Ostroff has served as Vice President for New  Technology  since joining
the Company in January of 1996. From 1984 until joining the Company,  he was the
President and CEO of Comark  Communication  Inc., a leading  manufacturer of UHF
transmission equipment. While at Comark, Mr. Ostroff was nominated and awarded a
Prime  Time  Emmy  Award  for  outstanding   engineering   achievement  for  the
development of new UHF  transmitter  technologies  in 1993. In 1968, Mr. Ostroff
founded Acrodyne Industries Inc., a manufacturer of TV transmitters and a public
company and served as its first  President  and CEO.  Mr.  Ostroff  holds a BSEE
degree from Drexel University and an MEEE degree from New York University. He is
a member of several industry organizations, including, AFCCE, IEEE and SBE. 

     Delbert  R.  Parks  III has  served as Vice  President  of  Operations  and
Engineering  since the completion of the River City  Acquisition.  Prior to that
time, he was Director of Operations and  Engineering for WBFF and Sinclair since
1985,  and has  been  with the  Company  for 25  years.  He is  responsible  for
planning,  organizing and implementing  operational and engineering policies and
strategies as they relate to television and computer systems.  Currently,  he is
consolidating  facilities  for  Sinclair's  television  stations  and  has  just
completed a digital  facility for  Sinclair's  news and  technical  operation in
Pittsburgh. Mr. Parks is also a Lieutenant Colonel in the Maryland Army National
Guard and commands the 1st Battalion, 175th Infantry (Light).

     Robert  E.  Quicksilver  has  served as Vice President/General Counsel, SCI
since  completion of the River City Acquisition. Prior to that time he served as
General  Counsel  of  River  City  since  September 1994. From 1988 to 1994, Mr.
Quicksilver   was   a  partner  of  the  law  firm  of  Rosenblum,  Goldenhersh,
Silverstein  and  Zafft,  P.C.  in  St. Louis. Mr. Quicksilver holds a B.A. from
Dartmouth College and a J.D. from the University of Michigan.


                                      S-66
<PAGE>

     Thomas E. Severson has served as Corporate  Controller  since January 1997.
Prior to that time, Mr. Severson  served as Assistant  Controller of the Company
since 1995.  Prior to joining the Company,  Mr.  Severson held  positions in the
audit  departments  of KPMG Peat Marwick LLP and Deloitte & Touche LLP from 1991
to 1995.  Mr.  Severson is a graduate of the  University  of Baltimore  and is a
Certified Public Accountant.

     Michael  E.  Sileck  has  served  as  Vice  President/Finance  of SCI since
completion  of  the  River City Acquisition. Prior to that time he served as the
Director  of  Finance for River City since 1993. Mr. Sileck joined River City in
July  1990  as  Director of Finance and Business Affairs for KDNL-TV. Mr. Sileck
is  an  active  member  of  the Broadcast Cable Financial Management Association
("BCFM")  and  was a Director of BCFM from 1993 to 1996. Mr. Sileck, a Certified
Public  Accountant,  received  a  B.S.  degree  in  Accounting  from Wayne State
University and an M.B.A. in Finance from Oklahoma City University.


     Robin A. Smith has served as Chief Financial Officer,  SCI Radio since June
1996.  From 1993 until joining the Company,  Ms. Smith served as Vice  President
and Chief  Financial  Officer of the Park Lane Group of Menlo Park,  California,
which owned and operated  small market radio  stations.  From 1982 to 1993,  she
served as Vice President and Treasurer of Edens  Broadcasting,  Inc. in Phoenix,
Arizona, which owns and operates radio stations in major markets. Ms. Smith is a
graduate of the Arizona State University and is a Certified Public Accountant.


     Patrick J.  Talamantes  has served as  Director  of  Corporate  Finance and
Treasurer of SCI since completion of the River City  Acquisition.  Prior to that
time, he served as Treasurer for River City since April 1995. From 1991 to 1995,
he was a Vice President with Chemical  Bank,  where he completed  financings for
clients in the cable, broadcasting, publishing and entertainment industries. Mr.
Talamantes holds a B.A. degree from Stanford  University and an M.B.A.  from the
Wharton School at the University of Pennsylvania.


     Lawrence  E.  McCanna  has  served  as a Director of the Company since July
1995.  Mr.  McCanna  has  been  a  partner  of  the  accounting  firm  of Gross,
Mendelsohn  &  Associates,  P.A.,  since  1972  and  has  served as its managing
partner  since  1982.  Mr.  McCanna  has  served  on  various  committees of the
Maryland  Association  of  Certified  Public Accountants and was chairman of the
Management  of  the Accounting Practice Committee. He is also a former member of
the  Management of an Accounting Practice Committee of the American Institute of
Certified  Public Accountants. Mr. McCanna is a member of the board of directors
of Maryland Special Olympics.


     Basil A.  Thomas has served as a Director  of the  Company  since  November
1993. He is of counsel to the Baltimore law firm of Thomas & Libowitz,  P.A. and
has been in the private  practice of law since  1983.  From 1961 to 1968,  Judge
Thomas  served as an Associate  Judge on the Municipal  Court of Baltimore  City
and, from 1968 to 1983, he served as an Associate  Judge of the Supreme Bench of
Baltimore  City.  Judge Thomas is a trustee of the University of Baltimore and a
member of the American Bar Association  and the Maryland State Bar  Association.
Judge Thomas attended the College of William & Mary and received his L.L.B. from
the University of Baltimore.  Judge Thomas is the father of Steven A. Thomas,  a
senior attorney and founder of Thomas & Libowitz, counsel to the Company.


     Barry Baker has been the Chief Executive  Officer of River City since 1989,
and is the President of the corporate  general  partner of River City and Better
Communications,  Inc. ("BCI"). The principal business of both River City and BCI
is  television  and  radio  broadcasting.  In  connection  with the  River  City
Acquisition, the Company agreed to appoint Mr. Baker Executive Vice President of
the  Company  and to elect him as a Director  at such time as he is  eligible to
hold those positions under applicable FCC regulations.  He currently serves as a
consultant to the Company.


     Kerby Confer served as a member of the Board of  Representatives  and Chief
Executive  Officer -  Keymarket  Radio  Division  of River City since July 1995.
Prior  thereto,  Mr. Confer served as Chairman of the Board and Chief  Executive
Officer of Keymarket  since its founding in December 1981.  Prior to engaging in
the  acquisition  of various radio stations in 1975, Mr. Confer held a number of
jobs in the broadcast business, including serving as Managing Partner of a radio
station in Annapolis, Maryland from 1969 to 1975. From 1966 to 1969, he hosted a
pop music television show on WBAL-TV (Baltimore) and


                                      S-67
<PAGE>

WDCA-TV (Washington, D.C.). Prior thereto, Mr. Confer served as program director
or  producer/director  for radio and  television  stations  owned by Susquehanna
Broadcasting and Plough Broadcasting Company, Inc. Mr. Confer currently provides
services to the Company and is expected to become Chief Executive Officer of SCI
Radio at such time as he is eligible to hold this position under  applicable FCC
regulations.

     Roy F. Coppedge, III is a general partner of the general partner of each of
the Boston Ventures partnerships, limited partnerships primarily involved in the
business of investments.  Mr. Coppedge is a director of Continental Cablevision,
Inc., and American Media, Inc. and a member of the Board of  Representatives  of
Falcon Holding Group,  L.P. In connection with the River City  Acquisition,  the
Company  agreed  to elect  Mr.  Coppedge  as a  Director  at such  time as he is
eligible to hold that position under applicable FCC regulations.

EMPLOYMENT AGREEMENTS

     The Company has entered into an employment  agreement  with David D. Smith,
President and Chief Executive Officer of the Company.  David Smith's  employment
agreement  has an initial  term of three years and is renewable  for  additional
one-year terms, unless either party gives notice of termination not less than 60
days  prior  to  the   expiration  of  the  then  current  term.  The  Company's
Compensation   Committee   has  approved  an  increase  in  Mr.   Smith's  total
compensation  to  $1,200,000.  Mr. Smith is also entitled to  participate in the
Company's  Executive Bonus Plan based upon the performance of the Company during
the year. The employment  agreement  provides that the Company may terminate Mr.
Smith's  employment  prior to expiration of the agreement's  term as a result of
(i) a breach  by Mr.  Smith  of any  material  covenant,  promise  or  agreement
contained in the employment  agreement;  (ii) a dissolution or winding up of the
Company;  (iii) the disability of Mr. Smith for more than 210 days in any twelve
month period (as determined under the employment agreement);  or (iv) for cause,
which includes  conviction of certain crimes,  breach of a fiduciary duty to the
Company or the  stockholders,  or repeated  failure to exercise or undertake his
duties as an officer of the Company (each, a "Termination Event").

     In June  1995,  the  Company  entered  into an  employment  agreement  with
Frederick G. Smith, Vice President of the Company.  Frederick Smith's employment
agreement  has an initial  term of three years and is renewable  for  additional
one-year terms, unless either party gives notice of termination not less than 60
days prior to the expiration of the then current term. Under the agreement,  Mr.
Smith  receives a base salary of $260,000 and is also entitled to participate in
the Company's Executive Bonus Plan based upon the performance of the Company and
Mr. Smith during the year.  The employment  agreement  provides that the Company
may terminate Mr. Smith's employment prior to expiration of the agreement's term
as a result of a Termination Event.

     In June 1995,  the Company  entered into an  employment  agreement  with J.
Duncan Smith,  Vice  President and Secretary of the Company.  J. Duncan  Smith's
employment  agreement  has an initial term of three years and is  renewable  for
additional  one-year terms,  unless either party gives notice of termination not
less than 60 days prior to the  expiration of the then current  term.  Under the
agreement,  Mr. Smith receives a base salary of $270,000 and is also entitled to
participate in the Company's  Executive Bonus Plan based upon the performance of
the Company and Mr. Smith during the year.  The  employment  agreement  provides
that the Company may terminate Mr. Smith's employment prior to expiration of the
agreement's term as a result of a Termination Event.

     In June 1995, the Company entered into an employment  agreement with Robert
E. Smith,  Vice  President  and  Treasurer  of the  Company.  Robert E.  Smith's
employment  agreement  has an initial term of three years and is  renewable  for
additional  one-year terms,  unless either party gives notice of termination not
less than 60 days prior to the  expiration of the then current  term.  Under the
agreement,  Mr. Smith receives a base salary of $250,000 and is also entitled to
participate in the Company's  Executive Bonus Plan based upon the performance of
the Company and Mr. Smith during the year.  The  employment  agreement  provides
that the Company may terminate Mr. Smith's employment prior to expiration of the
agreement's term as a result of a Termination Event.

     In connection with the River City Acquisition,  the Company entered into an
employment  agreement  (the  "Baker  Employment  Agreement")  with  Barry  Baker
pursuant to which Mr. Baker will become President and Chief Executive Officer of
SCI and Executive Vice President of the Company at such time as


                                      S-68
<PAGE>

Mr.  Baker  is able to hold  those  positions  consistent  with  applicable  FCC
regulations.  Until  such time as Mr.  Baker is able to become an officer of the
Company,  he serves as a  consultant  to the Company  pursuant  to a  consulting
agreement and receives  compensation  that he would be entitled to as an officer
under the Baker Employment Agreement.  While Mr. Baker acts as consultant to the
Company  he will not  direct  employees  of  Sinclair  in the  operation  of its
television  stations and will not perform services  relating to any shareholder,
bank financing or regulatory  compliance matters with respect to the Company. In
addition,  Mr. Baker will remain the Chief  Executive  Officer of River City and
will devote a  substantial  amount of his  business  time and  energies to those
services. Mr. Baker receives a base salary of approximately $1,135,200 per year,
subject to annual  increases of 7 1/2% on January 1 each year. Mr. Baker is also
entitled  to receive a bonus  equal to 2% of the  amount by which the  Broadcast
Cash Flow (as  defined  in the  Baker  Employment  Agreement)  of SCI for a year
exceeds the Broadcast Cash Flow for the  immediately  preceding  year. Mr. Baker
has received options to acquire 1,382,435 shares of the Class A Common Stock (or
3.33% of the common equity of Sinclair determined on a fully diluted basis as of
the date of the River City  Acquisition).  The option  became  exercisable  with
respect to 50% of the shares  upon  closing of the River City  Acquisition,  and
became  exercisable with respect to an additional 25% of the shares on the first
anniversary  of the  closing  of the River  City  Acquisition,  and will  become
exercisable  with respect to the remaining 25% on the second  anniversary of the
closing  of the River  City  Acquisition.  The  exercise  price of the option is
approximately  $30.11  per  share.  The term of the Baker  Employment  Agreement
extends  until  May  31,  2001,  and is  automatically  extended  to  the  third
anniversary  of any  Change of  Control  (as  defined  in the  Baker  Employment
Agreement).  If the Baker  Employment  Agreement is  terminated as a result of a
Series B Trigger Event (as defined below), then Mr. Baker shall be entitled to a
termination payment equal to the amount that would have been paid in base salary
for the remainder of the term of the  agreement  plus bonuses that would be paid
for such period  based on the average  bonus paid to Mr.  Baker for the previous
three years, and all options shall vest immediately  upon such  termination.  In
addition,  upon such a termination,  Mr. Baker shall have the option to purchase
from the Company  for the fair market  value  thereof  either (i) all  broadcast
operations of Sinclair in the St.  Louis,  Missouri DMA or (at the option of Mr.
Baker) the  Asheville/Greenville/Spartanburg,  South Carolina DMA or (ii) all of
the Company's  radio broadcast  operations.  Mr. Baker shall also have the right
following such a termination to receive  quarterly  payments  (which may be paid
either in cash or, at the  Company's  option,  in  additional  shares of Class A
Common  Stock)  equal to 5.00% of the  fair  market  value  (on the date of each
payment) of all stock  options and common stock issued  pursuant to the exercise
of such stock  options or pursuant to payments of this  obligation  in shares of
Class A Common  Stock and held by him at the time of such  payment  (except that
the first such payment  shall be 3.75% of such value).  The fair market value of
unexercised  options  for such  purpose  shall be equal to the  market  price of
underlying shares less the exercise price of the options.  Following termination
of Mr.  Baker's  employment  agreement,  the  Company  shall  have the option to
purchase the options and shares from Mr. Baker at their market value.  A "Series
B Trigger  Event" means the  termination  of Barry Baker's  employment  with the
Company  prior to the  expiration  of the  initial  five-year  term of the Baker
Employment  Agreement  (i) by the Company for any reason  other than "for cause"
(as  defined in the Baker  Employment  Agreement)  or (ii) by Barry  Baker under
certain  circumstances,  including (a) on 60 days' prior written notice given at
any time within 180 days following a Change of Control;  (b) if Mr. Baker is not
elected (and continued) as a director of Sinclair or SCI, as President and Chief
Executive  Officer of SCI or as Executive  Vice  President  of Sinclair,  or Mr.
Baker shall be removed from any such board or office; (c) upon a material breach
by Sinclair or SCI of the Baker Employment  Agreement which is not cured; (d) if
there shall be a material diminution in Mr. Baker's authority or responsibility,
or certain of his economic benefits are materially  reduced,  or Mr. Baker shall
be  required  to  work  outside  Baltimore;  or (e)  the  effective  date of his
employment as  contemplated  by clause (b) shall not have occurred by August 31,
1997.  Mr. Baker cannot be appointed to such  positions  with the Company or SCI
until the Company or SCI takes certain  actions with respect to WTTV and WTTK in
Indianapolis  or WTTE or WSYX in Columbus  as  described  under "Risk  Factors -
Dependence on Key Personnel;  Employment  Agreements  with Key Personnel" in the
accompanying Prospectus.  The Company has not taken these actions as of the date
of this Prospectus Supplement and,  accordingly,  Mr. Baker is able to terminate
the Baker Employment Agreement at any time.


                                      S-69
<PAGE>

            DESCRIPTION OF CONVERTIBLE EXCHANGEABLE PREFERRED STOCK


     The following summary description of the Convertible Exchangeable Preferred
Stock is qualified in its entirety by reference to the Articles Supplementary to
the Amended and  Restated  Articles of  Incorporation  of the Company as amended
(the "Amended  Certificate")  governing the Convertible  Exchangeable  Preferred
Stock  (the  "Articles  Supplementary"),  a copy of  which  will be  filed as an
exhibit to the registration  statement of which this Prospectus  Supplement is a
part. The definitions of certain capitalized terms used in the following summary
are set forth under "Certain  Definitions"  below.  Other capitalized terms used
herein and not otherwise defined below or under "Certain  Definitions" below are
defined in the Articles Supplementary.



GENERAL

     The Convertible  Exchangeable  Preferred Stock has been authorized as a new
series of preferred  stock,  consisting of up to 3,450,000  shares.  The Amended
Certificate  authorizes the Company to issue,  without any action on the part of
its stockholders, an aggregate of 10,000,000 shares of preferred stock, $.01 par
value  ("Preferred  Stock").  The  Company's  Board of Directors  (the "Board of
Directors")  has authority to divide the Preferred Stock into one or more series
and has broad  authority to determine the relative rights and preferences of the
shares  within  each  series,   including  voting  rights.  Subject  to  certain
conditions,  the Convertible  Exchangeable  Preferred Stock will be exchangeable
for the Company's 6% Convertible Subordinated Debentures due 2012 (the "Exchange
Debentures") at the option of the Company on any scheduled dividend payment date
on or after December 15, 2000. See "Certain Federal Income Tax Considerations."

     The Convertible  Exchangeable Preferred Stock will rank (i) junior in right
of payment to all indebtedness of the Company and the Subsidiaries;  (ii) senior
in right of payment to all Common  Stock of the  Company;  (iii) pari passu with
the Company's Series C Preferred Stock ($206.2 million  liquidation  value as of
the date  hereof);  and (iv) senior to the  Company's  Series B Preferred  Stock
($108.9  million  liquidation  value as of August 25, 1997) except that upon the
termination  of Barry  Baker's  employment  agreement  with the  Company,  as in
existence  on the date  hereof,  prior to May 31,  2001 by the  Company  for any
reason other than "for cause" (as defined in the employment agreement) or by Mr.
Baker under certain circumstances  described under "Description of Capital Stock
- -  Existing  Preferred  Stock - Series B  Preferred  Stock" in the  accompanying
Prospectus,  then the  Convertible  Exchangeable  Preferred Stock will rank pari
passu  with  the  Series  B  Preferred   Stock  in  respect  of  dividends   and
distributions upon liquidation,  dissolution and winding-up of the Company.  One
such  circumstance  pursuant to which Mr.  Baker can  terminate  his  employment
agreement  is the failure of Mr.  Baker to be elected and  continued  in certain
positions at the Company  before  August 31, 1997,  which  election  cannot take
place prior to the Company  taking  certain  actions  related to FCC approval of
such  election.  The Company has not taken these  actions as of the date of this
Prospectus  Supplement  and,  accordingly,  Mr. Baker is able to  terminate  his
employment  agreement at any time.  See  "Description  of Capital  Stock" in the
accompanying Prospectus and "Management" herein. 

     The Articles  Supplementary  relating to the Series B Preferred Stock limit
the aggregate  liquidation value of preferred stock that is senior to the Series
B Preferred Stock ("Senior  Securities") to $400 million. The Series C Preferred
Stock does, and the Convertible  Exchangeable  Preferred Stock will,  constitute
Senior Securities.


DIVIDENDS

     Holders of  Convertible  Exchangeable  Preferred  Stock will be entitled to
receive,  when,  as and if  declared  by the Board of  Directors  out of legally
available funds,  cash dividends of $3.00 per share annually,  payable quarterly
in arrears on March 15, June 15,  September 15 and December 15 of each year,  on
or after December 15, 1997 (each a "Dividend Payment Date"). Such dividends will
accrue and be cumulative from the most recent Dividend  Payment Date or, if none
have been paid, from the date of first issuance of the Convertible  Exchangeable
Preferred Stock and will be payable to holders on the March 1, June 1, September
1 and December 1 next preceeding each Dividend Payment Date, respec- 


                                      S-70
<PAGE>


tively.  If a Dividend  Payment  Date is a  Saturday,  Sunday or legal  holiday,
however,  the  dividend  will be payable on the next  business  day  without any
additional amounts required to be paid;  provided that dividends will accrue and
be cumulative from Dividend Payment Dates and not from the date of payment.


     The  Convertible  Exchangeable  Preferred  Stock will have  priority  as to
dividends over the Class A Common Stock,  the Class B Common Stock and any other
series or class of the  Company's  stock  that ranks  junior to the  Convertible
Exchangeable  Preferred Stock, as to dividends  ("Junior Dividend  Stock").  The
Company's  Series B Preferred  Stock is Junior  Dividend Stock except in certain
circumstances  with  respect to Mr.  Baker's  employment  agreement as described
above.  No dividend  (other than dividends  payable solely in Common Stock,  any
Junior  Dividend  Stock or warrants or other rights to acquire such Common Stock
or  Junior  Dividend  Stock)  may be paid or set apart for  payment  on,  and no
purchase,  redemption or other  acquisition shall be made by the Company of, the
Common Stock or Junior Dividend Stock unless all accrued and unpaid dividends on
the Convertible  Exchangeable  Preferred Stock,  including the full dividend for
the  then-current  quarterly  dividend  period and any Additional  Dividends (as
defined  herein),  shall have been paid or  declared  and set apart for  payment
without interest.

     Except as provided below, the Company may not pay dividends on any class or
series of stock having parity with the Convertible  Exchangeable Preferred Stock
as to dividends ("Parity Dividend Stock") unless it has paid or declared and set
apart for  payment  or  contemporaneously  pays or  declares  and sets apart for
payment all accrued and unpaid  dividends for all prior dividend payment periods
on  the  Convertible  Exchangeable  Preferred  Stock.  The  Company's  Series  C
Preferred  Stock is Parity  Dividend  Stock and, in certain  circumstances  with
respect to Mr. Baker's  employment  agreement as described  above,  the Series B
Preferred Stock is also Parity  Dividend Stock. In addition,  except as provided
below,  the  Company  may  not pay  dividends  on the  Convertible  Exchangeable
Preferred  Stock  unless it has paid or  declared  and set apart for  payment or
contemporaneously  pays or  declares  and sets apart for payment all accrued and
unpaid  dividends for all prior dividend  payment periods on the Parity Dividend
Stock.  Whenever  all  accrued  dividends  are not  paid in full on  Convertible
Exchangeable  Preferred Stock and on any Parity  Dividend  Stock,  all dividends
declared on the Convertible Exchangeable Preferred Stock and the Parity Dividend
Stock  will be  declared  and  made pro rata so that  the  amount  of  dividends
declared on the Convertible Exchangeable Preferred Stock and the Parity Dividend
Stock  will  bear the same  ratio  that  accrued  and  unpaid  dividends  on the
Convertible  Exchangeable  Preferred Stock and the Parity Dividend Stock bear to
each other.

     The Company may not  purchase  any shares of the  Convertible  Exchangeable
Preferred Stock or any Parity Dividend Stock (except for  consideration  payable
in Common Stock or Junior Dividend Stock) or redeem fewer than all the shares of
the  Convertible  Exchangeable  Preferred  Stock and Parity  Dividend Stock then
outstanding  if the  Company  has  failed  to pay any  accrued  dividend  on the
Convertible  Exchangeable  Preferred  Stock or any  Parity  Dividend  Stock on a
stated payment date.  Notwithstanding the foregoing,  in such event, the Company
may purchase or redeem fewer than all the shares of the Convertible Exchangeable
Preferred  Stock and Parity  Dividend Stock if such  repurchase or redemption is
made pro rata so that the amounts  purchased or redeemed  bear to each other the
same  ratio  that  the  required  redemption  payments  on  the  shares  of  the
Convertible  Exchangeable  Preferred  Stock and any Parity  Dividend  Stock then
outstanding bear to each other.

     If the  Company  hereafter  issues  any series or class of stock that ranks
senior as to dividends to the Convertible  Exchangeable Preferred Stock ("Senior
Dividend  Stock") and fails to pay or declare and set apart for payment  accrued
and unpaid  dividends on any Senior Dividend Stock (except to the extent allowed
by the terms of the Senior Dividend  Stock),  the Company may not pay or declare
and set apart for payment any dividend on the Convertible Exchangeable Preferred
Stock unless and until all accrued and unpaid  dividends on the Senior  Dividend
Stock,  including the full dividends for the then-current  dividend period, have
been paid or declared and set apart for payment  without  interest.  The Company
has no  Senior  Dividend  Stock  outstanding  on the  date  of  this  Prospectus
Supplement.

     The dividend payable on Convertible  Exchangeable  Preferred Stock for each
quarterly  dividend  period will be computed  by  dividing  the annual  dividend
amount by four. The amount of dividends  payable for the initial dividend period
and for any period shorter than a full quarterly dividend period


                                      S-71
<PAGE>


will  be  computed  on  the  basis of a 360-day year of twelve 30-day months. No
interest  will  be  payable  on any scheduled Convertible Exchangeable Preferred
Stock  dividend  that  may  be  in  arrears.  All  references to dividends shall
include Additional Dividends (as defined below).


     Under  Maryland law, no  distribution  to  stockholders  may be made by the
Company if, after giving effect to the  distribution,  (i) the Company would not
be able to pay  indebtedness of the Company as the  indebtedness  becomes due in
the usual course of business,  or (ii) the Company's  total assets would be less
than the sum of the Company's total liabilities plus, unless the charter permits
otherwise,  the amount that would be needed, if the Company were to be dissolved
at the  time of the  distribution,  to  satisfy  the  preferential  rights  upon
dissolution  of  stockholders  whose  preferential  rights  on  dissolution  are
superior to those receiving the distribution.  The Company's Amended Certificate
does not contain such a provision.  The Existing Notes and Bank Credit Agreement
limit  the  Company's  ability  to pay  cash  dividends  on its  capital  stock,
including the Convertible  Exchangeable  Preferred Stock, and future  agreements
may provide the same.

     Certain  covenants  under  the  Existing  Indentures  (as  defined  in  the
accompanying   Prospectus),   the  Bank  Credit   Agreement   and  the  Articles
Supplementary  relating to the Series C Preferred  Stock  restrict the amount of
dividends  that may be declared  and paid by the  Company on its  capital  stock
including the Convertible  Exchangeable  Preferred  Stock.  Although the Company
presently  believes  it  will  be  able  to pay  dividends  on  the  Convertible
Exchangeable  Preferred  Stock as required,  there can be no assurance  that the
Company  will  be  permitted  under  such   restrictions  to  declare  dividends
throughout the term of the Convertible Exchangeable Preferred Stock. The Company
may make other  restricted  payments  or the  Company's  consolidated  operating
performance  may decline,  either of which could limit the Company's  ability to
declare  dividends.  In addition,  under the terms of the Bank Credit Agreement,
the  Company  would not be able to pay full cash  dividends  on the  Convertible
Exchangeable  Preferred Stock  beginning  December 31, 1998 unless the Company's
Total Indebtedness Ratio (as defined in the Bank Credit Agreement) improves from
the Company's pro forma 1996 Total Indebtedness  Ratio. As of December 31, 1996,
on a pro  forma  basis  assuming  completion  on  January  1,  1996 of the  1996
Acquisitions,  the HYTOPS Issuance, the Debt Issuance, the Heritage Acquisition,
and the Preferred Stock Offering, this limitation would have allowed the Company
to pay up to $16.3  million in dividends on capital  stock for fiscal 1996.  The
Company  must also  satisfy  other  financial  covenants  under the Bank  Credit
Agreement to pay cash dividends. See "Risk Factors Restrictions Imposed by Terms
of Indebtedness" in the accompanying Prospectus.


LIQUIDATION RIGHTS

     In the case of the voluntary or  involuntary  liquidation,  dissolution  or
winding up of the Company,  subject to the payment in full,  or until  provision
has been made for the payment in full of all claims of creditors of the Company,
(i) holders of Convertible  Exchangeable Preferred Stock are entitled to receive
the  liquidation  preference  of $50.00 per share,  plus an amount  equal to any
accrued and unpaid dividends (including Additional  Dividends,  if any), whether
or not declared, to the payment date, before any payment or distribution is made
to the holders of Common Stock or any other  series or class of stock  hereafter
issued  that  ranks  junior  as  to  liquidation   rights  to  the   Convertible
Exchangeable  Preferred Stock ("Junior  Liquidation Stock"), and (ii) holders of
Convertible  Exchangeable  Preferred  Stock will not be  entitled to receive the
liquidation  preference of their shares until the liquidation  preference of any
other  series  or  class of stock  hereafter  issued  that  ranks  senior  as to
liquidation  rights to the  Convertible  Exchangeable  Preferred  Stock ("Senior
Liquidation  Stock"),  if any, has been paid in full. The holders of Convertible
Exchangeable  Preferred Stock and any series or class of stock hereafter  issued
that  ranks on a  parity  as to the  liquidation  rights  with  the  Convertible
Exchangeable  Preferred Stock ("Parity Liquidation Stock") are entitled to share
ratably, in accordance with the respective preferential amounts payable on their
stock, in any distribution  (after payment of the liquidation  preference on any
Senior  Liquidation  Stock) that is not  sufficient to pay in full the aggregate
liquidation preference on both the Convertible  Exchangeable Preferred Stock and
the Parity Liquidation Stock. The Series C Preferred Stock is Parity Liquidation
Stock and the Series B Preferred  Stock is Junior  Liquidation  Stock  except in
certain  circumstances  with  respect to Mr.  Baker's  employment  agreement  as
described above in which it becomes Parity Liquidation Stock.


                                      S-72
<PAGE>

     After payment in full of the  liquidation  preference  plus any accrued and
unpaid dividends (including  Additional  Dividends,  if any), on the Convertible
Exchangeable  Preferred  Stock,  the holders will not be entitled to any further
participation  in  any  distribution  of  assets  by  the  Company.   Neither  a
consolidation  or  merger  of the  Company  with  another  entity  nor a sale or
transfer of all or part of the  Company's  assets for cash,  securities or other
property  will be  considered a  liquidation,  dissolution  or winding up of the
Company.

VOTING RIGHTS

     The holders of Convertible Exchangeable Preferred Stock will have no voting
rights except as described below or as required by law. In exercising any voting
rights, each outstanding share of Convertible  Exchangeable Preferred Stock will
be  entitled  to one vote,  although  shares  held by the  Company or any entity
controlled by the Company will have no voting rights.

     Whenever dividends on the Convertible  Exchangeable  Preferred Stock are in
arrears in aggregate amount equal to at least six quarterly  dividends  (whether
or not  consecutive),  the  size of the  Company's  Board of  Directors  will be
increased by two, and the holders of Convertible  Exchangeable  Preferred Stock,
voting  separately  as a class,  will be entitled  to select the two  additional
directors to the Board of Directors at (i) any annual meeting of stockholders at
which  directors  are to be elected  held during the period  when the  dividends
remain in arrears or (ii) at a special  meeting  of  stockholders  called by the
Company at the request of the holders of the Convertible  Exchangeable Preferred
Stock;  provided,  that,  at any time when  shares of  Convertible  Exchangeable
Preferred  Stock are  outstanding and after the earlier of (i) the time when the
Amended  Certificate  is amended to increase the number of directors that may be
elected to the Board of  Directors  by two or two  directors  have  resigned  as
contemplated by the next succeeding  paragraph and (ii) one year after the issue
date of the Convertible  Exchangeable  Preferred Stock, if additional  directors
are not  then  holding  office  pursuant  to those  provisions,  the  number  of
directors at any such time  constituting  the Board of Directors  may not exceed
the number which is two less than the maximum number of directors then specified
in the  Amended  Certificate.  These  voting  rights  will  terminate  when  all
dividends in arrears and for the current quarterly period have been paid in full
or  declared  and set apart for  payment.  The term of office of the  additional
directors so elected will terminate  immediately  upon that payment or provision
for payment.

     The Amended  Certificate  currently  limits the number of directors to nine
and, pursuant to the Amended Certificate, directors can only be removed from the
Board of Directors "for cause".  Accordingly,  unless the Amended Certificate is
amended to increase the number of directors  that may be elected to the Board of
Directors or unless two directors resign in order to accommodate the election of
directors  by the holders of  Convertible  Exchangeable  Preferred  Stock,  such
holders  may be unable to elect the two  directors  to which  such  holders  are
entitled.  If the Company  fails (a) within one year after the issue date of the
Convertible Exchangeable Preferred Stock, to cause the Amended Certificate to be
amended to  increase  the  maximum  number of  directors  by two or to cause two
directors  to resign and (b) to comply with the proviso  contained  in the prior
paragraph,   then  the  Company  shall  pay  additional  dividends  ("Additional
Dividends")  to the holders of the  Convertible  Exchangeable  Preferred  Stock.
Additional  Dividends  shall accrue on the  Convertible  Exchangeable  Preferred
Stock  over and above the  stated  payment  rates  thereon at a rate of .50% per
annum for the first 90 days immediately  following the first  anniversary of the
issue date of the  Convertible  Exchangeable  Preferred Stock or the date of the
breach of the  proviso  of the prior  paragraph,  as the case may be,  with such
Additional  Dividend  rate  increasing  by an  additional  .25% per annum at the
beginning  of  each  subsequent  90-day  period;  provided,  however,  that  the
Additional Dividend rate on any shares of the Convertible Exchangeable Preferred
Stock may not exceed 1.5% per annum; and provided further, that when the Amended
Certificate  has been so amended or such  directors  have resigned or the breach
has been cured, Additional Dividends shall cease to accrue.

     Any  Additional  Dividends  will be payable in cash on the various  payment
dates related to the Convertible  Exchangeable  Preferred  Stock. The Additional
Dividends will be determined by multiplying the applicable  Additional  Dividend
rate by the  liquidation  preference of the Convertible  Exchangeable  Preferred
Stock  multiplied  by a fraction,  the  numerator of which is the number of days
such  Additional  Dividend  rate was  applicable  during  such  period,  and the
denominator of which is 360.


                                      S-73
<PAGE>

     In addition,  so long as any  Convertible  Exchangeable  Preferred Stock is
outstanding,  the Company will not,  without the affirmative  vote or consent of
the  holders  of at  least  66 2/3% of all  outstanding  shares  of  Convertible
Exchangeable  Preferred  Stock,  (i)  amend,  alter  or  repeal  (by  merger  or
otherwise) any provision of the Amended Certificate or the Bylaws of the Company
so as to affect  adversely  the relative  rights,  preferences,  qualifications,
limitations or  restrictions of the Convertible  Exchangeable  Preferred  Stock,
(ii) authorize any new class of Senior  Dividend Stock,  any Senior  Liquidation
Stock or any security convertible into or exchangeable for Senior Dividend Stock
or  Senior  Liquidation  Stock  or  (iii)  effect  any  reclassification  of the
Convertible  Exchangeable Preferred Stock or any reclassification of any capital
stock into Senior Dividend Stock or Senior Liquidation Stock.


REDEMPTION AT OPTION OF THE COMPANY

     The Convertible  Exchangeable  Preferred  Stock will be redeemable,  at the
Company's option, in whole or from time to time in part, at any time on or after
September 20, 2000, upon not less than 30 nor more than 60 days' prior notice by
first class mail to each holder of Convertible  Exchangeable  Preferred Stock to
be redeemed at its address  appearing in the security  register at the following
redemption  prices  ("Redemption  Prices")  plus  accrued  and unpaid  dividends
(including  Additional  Dividends,  if any),  expressed  on a per  share  basis,
whether or not declared, to the date of redemption.

     If redeemed during the 12-month period  beginning  September 15 in the year
indicated (September 20, in the case of 2000), the Redemption Price shall be:


<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
               REDEMPTION                                   REDEMPTION
                 PRICE                                        PRICE
   YEAR         PER SHARE               YEAR                PER SHARE
- ------------   ------------   ---------------------------   -----------
<S>             <C>           <C>                            <C>
2000  ......    $ 52.10       2004  .....................    $ 50.90
2001  ......      51.80       2005  .....................      50.60
2002  ......      51.50       2006  .....................      50.30
2003  ......      51.20       2007 and thereafter  ......      50.00
</TABLE>


     If fewer  than  all the  outstanding  shares  of  Convertible  Exchangeable
Preferred  Stock are to be redeemed,  the Company will select those shares to be
redeemed  pro  rata or in such  other  manner  as the  Board  of  Directors  may
reasonably  determine  to be  equitable.  There is no  mandatory  redemption  or
sinking fund obligation for the Convertible Exchangeable Preferred Stock. In the
event that the Company has failed to pay accrued and unpaid dividends (including
Additional Dividends,  if any) on the Convertible  Exchangeable Preferred Stock,
it may not redeem  less than all of the  outstanding  shares of the  Convertible
Exchangeable  Preferred  Stock until all such accrued and unpaid  dividends have
been paid in full.

     After the redemption date,  dividends will cease to accrue on the shares of
Convertible Exchangeable Preferred Stock called for redemption and all rights of
the holders of those shares will terminate,  except the conversion rights to the
extent  described  below and the right to  receive  the  redemption  price  plus
accrued and unpaid dividends (including Additional  Dividends,  if any), whether
or not declared,  to the  redemption  date,  without  interest.  The Bank Credit
Agreement,  the Existing Indentures and the Articles  Supplementary  relating to
the Series C Preferred  Stock  restrict the ability of the Company to redeem the
Convertible Exchangeable Preferred Stock and future agreements may do the same.

     Shares of Convertible  Exchangeable  Preferred  Stock issued and reacquired
will, upon compliance with the applicable requirements of Maryland law, have the
status of  authorized  but  unissued  shares of  preferred  stock of the Company
undesignated as to series and may with any and all other authorized but unissued
shares of  preferred  stock of the Company be  designated  or  redesignated  and
issued or reissued, as the case may be, as part of any series of preferred stock
of the Company,  except that any issuance or  reissuance  of shares of preferred
stock must be in compliance with the Articles Supplementary and except that such
shares  may not be  reissued  or  sold as  shares  of  Convertible  Exchangeable
Preferred Stock.


                                      S-74
<PAGE>

CONVERSION RIGHTS

     Each  holder of  Convertible  Exchangeable  Preferred  Stock  will have the
right, at the holder's option,  to convert any or all shares into Class A Common
Stock at any time at a  conversion  price  (subject to  adjustment  as described
below) of  $45.625  per share of the  underlying  Class A Common  Stock.  If the
Convertible   Exchangeable  Preferred  Stock  is  called  for  redemption,   the
conversion  right  will  terminate  at the close of  business  on the second day
preceding the redemption date fixed by the Board of Directors.

     Holders of shares of Convertible  Exchangeable Preferred Stock at the close
of business on a dividend  payment  record date shall be entitled to receive the
dividend  payable on such  shares on the  corresponding  Dividend  Payment  Date
notwithstanding  the conversion  thereof  following such dividend payment record
date  and  prior  to such  Dividend  Payment  Date.  If  shares  of  Convertible
Exchangeable  Preferred  Stock not called for  redemption  are  surrendered  for
conversion  during the period  between  the close of  business  on any  dividend
record date and the opening of business on any  corresponding  Dividend  Payment
Date such shares so surrendered must be accompanied by payment in same day funds
of an amount  equal to the  dividend  payable  on such  shares on such  Dividend
Payment Date and such shares will be entitled to such dividends. No such payment
will be required to accompany shares of Convertible Exchangeable Preferred Stock
called for  redemption  and  surrendered  during  such  period and which are not
converted.  A holder of shares of Convertible  Exchangeable Preferred Stock on a
dividend  record  date who (or whose  transferee)  tenders  any such  shares for
conversion  into shares of Class A Common  Stock on the  corresponding  Dividend
Payment Date will receive the dividend  payable by the Company on such shares of
Convertible Exchangeable Preferred Stock on such date, and the converting holder
need not include payment of the amount of such dividend upon surrender of shares
of Convertible  Exchangeable Preferred Stock for conversion.  Except as provided
above,  the  Company  will make no payment or  allowance  for accrued and unpaid
dividends,  whether or not in arrears,  on converted  shares or for dividends on
the shares of Class A Common Stock issuable upon such conversion.  No fractional
shares of Class A Common  Stock will be required  to be issued  upon  conversion
but, in lieu  thereof,  the Company may deliver  cash in an  appropriate  amount
which will be paid based on the last  reported sale price for the Class A Common
Stock on the day of conversion.

     The conversion  price will be subject to adjustment  upon the occurrence of
any  of  the   following   events:   (i)   the   subdivision,   combination   or
reclassification of outstanding shares of Class A Common Stock; (ii) the payment
in shares of Common Stock of a dividend or  distribution on any class of capital
stock of the Company; (iii) the issuance of rights or warrants to all holders of
Class A Common Stock or Class B Common Stock or both  entitling  them to acquire
shares of Common  Stock at a price per share  less than the  average of the last
reported  sales  price of the  Class A  Common  Stock  for the five  consecutive
trading  days  immediately  prior to such  issuance;  (iv) the  distribution  to
holders  of Class A Common  Stock or Class B Common  stock or both of  shares of
capital stock other than Common Stock, evidences of indebtedness, cash or assets
(including securities, but excluding dividends or distributions paid exclusively
in cash and dividends,  distributions,  rights and warrants  referred to above);
(v)  a  distribution   consisting   exclusively  of  cash  (excluding  any  cash
distributions  referred to in (iv) above) to all holders of Class A Common Stock
or Class B Common Stock or both in an aggregate  amount that,  together with (A)
the aggregate amount of all other cash distributions to all holders of the Class
A Common  Stock or Class B Common  Stock  within  the 12 months  preceding  such
distribution  and (B) any cash and the fair market value of other  consideration
payable in respect of any tender  offer by the  Company or a  Subsidiary  of the
Company  for  Common  Stock  consummated  within  the 12 months  preceding  such
distribution,  exceeds 12.5% of the Company's Market  Capitalization (as defined
below) on the date  fixed for  determining  the  stockholders  entitled  to such
distribution; and (vi) the consummation of a tender offer made by the Company or
any  Subsidiary  of the Company for Common  Stock  which  involves an  aggregate
consideration  that,  together  with (X) any cash and the fair  market  value of
other  consideration  payable in respect of any tender offer by the Company or a
Subsidiary  for Common  Stock  consummated  within the 12 months  preceding  the
consummation  of such  tender  offer  and (Y) the  aggregate  amount of all cash
distributions  (excluding any cash  distributions  referred to in (iv) above) to
all holders of the Class A Common  Stock or Class B Common  Stock or both within
the 12 months preceding the consummation of such tender offer,  exceeds 12.5% of
the Company's Market  Capitalization  on the date of consummation of such tender
offer. No adjustment of the conversion price will be


                                      S-75
<PAGE>

made  until  cumulative  adjustments  amount  to  one  percent  or  more  of the
conversion  price as last  adjusted;  provided,  however,  that any  adjustments
which,  by reason of the foregoing,  are not required to be made will be carried
forward and taken into account in any  subsequent  adjustment.  All  adjustments
will be made successively.

     "Market  Capitalization"  means the  product  of the  number of issued  and
outstanding  shares of Common Stock  multiplied by the last reported sales price
of the Class A Common Stock.

     The Company from time to time may reduce the conversion price by any amount
for any period of time if the period is at least 20 days and if the reduction is
irrevocable during the period.  Whenever the conversion price is so reduced, the
Company shall mail to holders of the Convertible  Exchangeable Preferred Stock a
notice of the reduction at least 15 days before the date the reduced  conversion
price takes effect,  stating the reduced conversion price and the period it will
be in effect.

     In  case  of  any  reclassification  of  the  Class  A  Common  Stock,  any
consolidation  of the Company  with,  or merger of the Company  into,  any other
entity, any merger of any entity into the Company (other than a merger that does
not result in a  reclassification,  conversion,  exchange or cancellation of the
outstanding  shares of Class A Common  Stock),  any sale or  transfer  of all or
substantially  all of the assets of the Company or any compulsory share exchange
whereby the Class A Common Stock is  converted  into other  securities,  cash or
other  property,  then the  holder  of each  share of  Convertible  Exchangeable
Preferred Stock then  outstanding  shall have the right  thereafter,  during the
period that the Convertible  Exchangeable  Preferred Stock shall be convertible,
to convert  that share  only into the kind and  amount of  securities,  cash and
other property  receivable  upon the  reclassification,  consolidation,  merger,
sale,  transfer or share exchange by a holder of the number of shares of Class A
Common Stock into which one share of Convertible  Exchangeable  Preferred  Stock
would  have  been  convertible   immediately  prior  to  the   reclassification,
consolidation,  merger, sale, transfer or share exchange. The kind and amount of
securities  into or for which the shares of Convertible  Exchangeable  Preferred
Stock will be convertible or redeemable  after  consummation of such transaction
will  be  subject  to  adjustment  as  described  above  following  the  date of
consummation of such transaction. The Company may not become a party to any such
transaction  unless the terms thereof are consistent  with the foregoing and the
surviving  corporation in any such transaction  agrees in writing to comply with
the terms of the foregoing.


CHANGE OF CONTROL

     If a Change of Control (as hereinafter  defined) occurs with respect to the
Company,  then shares of the  Convertible  Exchangeable  Preferred  Stock may be
converted,  at the  option of the holder  thereof,  at any time from the date of
such  Change of  Control  until the  expiration  of 45 days  after the date of a
notice by the Company to all holders of the Convertible  Exchangeable  Preferred
Stock of the  occurrence of the Change of Control,  into the number of shares of
Class A Common Stock  determined by dividing (i) the $50 liquidation  preference
of the  Convertible  Exchangeable  Preferred  Stock,  plus  accrued  and  unpaid
dividends, if any, up to but excluding the date of the Change of Control by (ii)
the adjusted  conversion  price.  The adjusted  conversion  price (the "Adjusted
Conversion  Price") is the greater of (i) the average of the last reported sales
price  per share of the Class A Common  Stock  for the last  five  trading  days
before the Change of Control or (ii) $26.42  (being 66 2/3% of the last reported
sales  price of the  Class A Common  Stock  on the day  before  the date of this
Prospectus Supplement) as adjusted for stock splits or combinations. The special
conversion  rights  will exist  upon the  occurrence  of any Change of  Control,
whether or not the transaction  relating thereto has been approved by management
of the  Company  and may not be waived by  management.  Exercise  of the special
conversion rights by the holder of a share of Convertible Exchangeable Preferred
Stock will be irrevocable.  If the Change of Control  involves a  consolidation,
merger or sale of assets of the Company, the holders of Convertible Exchangeable
Preferred Stock exercising their special  conversion  rights will be entitled to
receive the same  consideration  as received for the number of shares of Class A
Common Stock into which their shares of Convertible Exchangeable Preferred Stock
would have been  converted  pursuant to the  special  conversion  rights.  These
special  conversion rights are in addition to the regular conversion rights that
apply to the Convertible Exchangeable Preferred Stock. 


                                      S-76
<PAGE>

     The Company  may, at its  option,  elect to pay holders of the  Convertible
Exchangeable  Preferred  Stock  exercising  their special  conversion  rights an
amount  in cash  equal  to the $50  liquidation  preference  of the  Convertible
Exchangeable  Preferred Stock, plus accrued and unpaid dividends,  if any, up to
but  excluding  the date of the Change of Control,  in which event no conversion
pursuant  to the  exercise  of the  special  conversion  rights set forth in the
preceding paragraph will occur, unless the Company defaults in making payment of
such amounts.

     A Change  of  Control  will  result in an event of  default  under the Bank
Credit Agreement and could result in the acceleration of all indebtedness  under
the Bank Credit  Agreement.  Moreover,  the Bank Credit Agreement  prohibits the
repurchase of the Convertible  Exchangeable  Preferred  Stock by the Company.  A
Change of Control will also allow holders of Existing Notes or holders of Series
C Preferred  Stock to require the Company to redeem either the Existing Notes or
the Series C Preferred Stock, as the case may be.

     The existence of these special conversion rights may deter certain mergers,
tender offers or other takeover  attempts and may thereby  adversely  affect the
market price of the Class A Common Stock.

     "Change of Control"  means the  occurrence of any of the following  events:
(i) any "person" or "group" (as such terms are used in Sections  13(d) and 14(d)
of the Exchange Act),  other than Permitted  Holders (as defined  below),  is or
becomes  the  "beneficial  owner" (as defined in Ruled 13d-3 and 13d-5 under the
Exchange Act, except that a Person shall be deemed to have beneficial  ownership
of all shares that such Person has the right to acquire,  whether  such right is
exercisable  immediately  or only  after  the  passage  of  time),  directly  or
indirectly,  of more  than  40% of the  total  outstanding  Voting  Stock of the
Company,  provided that the Permitted Holders "beneficially own" (as so defined)
a lesser  percentage of such Voting Stock than such other Person and do not have
the  right or  ability  by  voting  power,  contract  or  otherwise  to elect or
designate for election a majority of the board of directors of the Company; (ii)
during any period of two consecutive years,  individuals who at the beginning of
such period constituted the board of directors of the Company (together with any
new directors whose election to such board of directors, or whose nomination for
election by the  shareholders of the Company,  was approved by a vote of 66 2/3%
of the directors then still in office who were either directors at the beginning
of such period or whose  election or nomination  for election was  previously so
approved)  cease for any  reason  to  constitute  a  majority  of such  board of
directors then in office;  (iii) the Company consolidates with or merges with or
into any Person or conveys,  transfers or leases all or substantially all of its
assets to any Person,  or any  corporation  consolidates  with or merges into or
with the  Company,  in any such event  pursuant  to a  transaction  in which the
outstanding  Voting Stock of the Company is changed into or exchanged  for cash,
securities  or  other  property,  other  than  any such  transaction  where  the
outstanding  Voting  Stock of the  Company is not  changed or  exchanged  at all
(except  to the extent  necessary  to  reflect a change in the  jurisdiction  of
incorporation  of the Company) or where (A) the outstanding  Voting Stock of the
Company is changed  into or  exchanged  for (x)  Voting  Stock of the  surviving
corporation which is not Disqualified  Equity Interests or (y) cash,  securities
and other property (other than Equity Interests of the surviving corporation) in
an amount which could be paid by the Company as a Restricted  Payment  under the
terms of the  indenture  relating  to the 1997 Notes as in effect on the date of
this  Prospectus  Supplement,  without  giving  effect to any  later  amendments
thereto (and such amount  shall be treated as a  Restricted  Payment) and (B) no
"person" or "group" other than  Permitted  Holders owns  immediately  after such
transaction,  directly  or  indirectly,  more than the greater of (1) 40% of the
total  outstanding  Voting  Stock  of the  surviving  corporation  and  (2)  the
percentage of the outstanding  Voting Stock of the surviving  corporation owned,
directly or indirectly, by Permitted Holders immediately after such transaction;
or (iv) the Company is liquidated  or dissolved or adopts a plan of  liquidation
or  dissolution  other than in a transaction  which complies with the provisions
described under Article Eight of the 1997 Indenture. 

     "Disqualified  Equity Interests" means any equity interests that, either by
their terms or by the terms of any security into which they are  convertible  or
exchangeable  or otherwise,  are or upon the happening of an event or passage of
time  would be  required  to be  redeemed  prior to any stated  maturity  of the
principal  of the  applicable  security or are  redeemable  at the option of the
holder thereof at any time prior to any such stated maturity, or are convertible
into or  exchangeable  for debt  securities at any time prior to any such stated
maturity at the option or the holder thereof.


                                      S-77
<PAGE>

     "Permitted  Holders" means as of the date of determination (i) any of David
D. Smith,  Frederick G. Smith, J. Duncan Smith and Robert E. Smith;  (ii) family
members of the  relatives  of the Persons  described  in clause  (i);  (iii) any
trusts  created for the benefit of any of the Persons  described in clauses (i),
(ii) or (iv) or any trust for the benefit of such trust; or (iv) in the event of
the  incompetence  or death of any of the Persons  described  in clauses (i) and
(ii), such Person's estate, executor, administrator, committee or other personal
representative or beneficiaries, who, in each case, at any particular date shall
beneficially  own or have the right to acquire,  directly or indirectly,  equity
interests of the Company.

     The term "all or substantially all" as used in the definition of "Change of
Control" has not been  interpreted  under  Maryland law (which is the  Company's
state  of  incorporation)  to  represent  a  specific  quantitative  test.  As a
consequence,  in the event the Holders of the Convertible Exchangeable Preferred
Stock elected to exercise their rights in the event of a Change of Control under
the terms set forth  above and the  Company  elected to contest  such  election,
there could be no  assurance as to how a court  interpreting  Maryland law would
interpret the phrase.


EXCHANGE RIGHTS

     Subject to certain  conditions,  the Company  may,  at its  option,  on any
scheduled  Dividend  Payment Date on or after  December  15, 2000,  exchange the
Convertible  Exchangeable  Preferred  Stock,  in whole but not in part,  for the
Exchange Debentures; provided that (i) on the date of such exchange there are no
accumulated and unpaid dividends (whether or not declared) (including Additional
Dividends, if any) on the Convertible Exchangeable Preferred Stock which are not
being  simultaneously paid with such exchange (including the dividend payable on
such date) or other contractual  impediments to such exchange;  (ii) there shall
be legally available funds sufficient for any such dividends;  (iii) immediately
after giving  effect to such  exchange,  no Default or Event of Default (each as
defined in the  Exchange  Debenture  Indenture)  would exist under the  Exchange
Debenture  Indenture;  and (iv) no default or event of default would exist under
the  Existing  Indentures  or the Bank Credit  Agreement.  See  "Description  of
Exchange Debentures" below for the terms of the Exchange Debentures.  Holders of
Convertible  Exchangeable  Preferred  Stock so  exchanged  will be  entitled  to
receive,  subject to the succeeding sentence $1,000 principal amount of Exchange
Debentures for each $1,000 of liquidation preference of Convertible Exchangeable
Preferred  Stock held by such holders at the time of exchange plus an amount per
share in cash equal to all accrued but unpaid  dividends  thereon to the date of
exchange.  The Exchange  Debentures will be issued (i) only in  denominations of
$1,000 and integral  multiples  thereof with a single  Exchange  Debenture in an
amount less than $1,000 to  effectuate  the transfer or exchange or (ii) in such
other denominations as may be authorized by the Company for purposes of transfer
or exchange.  An amount in cash may be paid to holders for any principal  amount
otherwise  issuable  which is less than $1,000.  Following  such  exchange,  all
dividends on the Convertible  Exchangeable Preferred Stock will cease to accrue,
the  rights  of the  holders  of  Convertible  Exchangeable  Preferred  Stock as
stockholders  of the Company  shall cease and the person or persons  entitled to
receive the Exchange  Debentures  issuable upon exchange shall be treated as the
registered  holder or holders of such  Exchange  Debentures.  Notice of exchange
will be mailed  at least 30 days but not more than 60 days  prior to the date of
exchange  to each  holder  of  Convertible  Exchangeable  Preferred  Stock.  See
"Description of Exchange Debentures" below.

     In addition,  under applicable  provisions of the federal bankruptcy law or
comparable  provisions of state  fraudulent  transfer law, if at the time of the
Company's  payment of  dividends  on,  redemption  of or  exchange  of  Exchange
Debentures for, the Convertible  Exchangeable Preferred Stock (i) the Company is
insolvent or rendered  insolvent by reason thereof;  (ii) the Company is engaged
in a business or transaction for which the Company's remaining assets constitute
unreasonably  small capital;  or (iii) the Company  intends to incur or believes
that it would incur debts  beyond its ability to pay such debts as they  mature,
then the relevant distribution to holders of Convertible  Exchangeable Preferred
Stock could be avoided in whole or in part as a fraudulent  conveyance  and such
holders could be required to return the same or equivalent amounts to or for the
benefit  of  existing  or  future  creditors  of the  Company.  The  measure  of
insolvency  for purposes of the foregoing  will vary depending on the law of the
jurisdiction which is being applied.  Generally, the Company would be considered
insolvent  if the  sum of its  debts,  including  contingent  liabilities,  were
greater than the fair saleable value of its assets at a fair valuation or if the
present fair saleable value of its assets were less 


                                      S-78
<PAGE>

than  the  amount  that  would  be required to pay its probable liability on its
existing  debts,  including  contingent liabilities, as they become absolute and
mature.   See  "Description  of  Exchange  Debentures  -  Fraudulent  Conveyance
Considerations."

     The  Bank  Credit  Agreement,  the  Existing  Indentures  and the  Articles
Supplementary  relating to the Series C Preferred  Stock  restrict the Company's
ability  to  exchange  the  Convertible  Exchangeable  Preferred  Stock  for the
Exchange Debentures.


GLOBAL CERTIFICATE

     Shares  of  Convertible  Exchangeable  Preferred  Stock  will be  evidenced
initially  by  one  or  more  registered   global   certificates   (the  "Global
Certificate")  which will be deposited with or on behalf of The Depository Trust
Company  ("DTC") and  registered  in the name of Cede & Co.,  as DTC's  nominee.
Except as set forth below,  record  ownership of the Global  Certificate  may be
transferred,  in  whole  or in  part,  only to  another  nominee  of DTC or to a
successor of DTC or its nominee. 

     Owners of  beneficial  interests in the Global  Certificate  may hold their
interests  in the Global  Certificate  directly  through DTC if such holder is a
participant in DTC or indirectly through  organizations that are participants in
DTC (the "Participants").  Persons who are not Participants may beneficially own
interests in the Global  Certificate  held by DTC only through  Participants  or
certain banks,  brokers,  dealers,  trust companies and other parties that clear
through or maintain a custodial relationship with a Participant, either directly
or indirectly ("Indirect  Participants").  So long as Cede & Co., as the nominee
of DTC, is the registered  owner of the Global  Certificate,  Cede & Co. for all
purposes will be considered the sole holder of the Global Certificate. Except as
noted below,  owners of beneficial  interests in the Global Certificate will not
be entitled to receive physical delivery of certificates in definitive form.

     Payment of dividends on and any redemption price with respect to the Global
Certificate will be made to Cede & Co., the nominee for DTC, as registered owner
of the Global  Certificate,  by wire transfer of immediately  available funds on
each  dividend  payment date or  redemption  date,  as  applicable.  Neither the
Company nor the Transfer Agent will have any responsibility or liability for any
aspect of the  records  relating to or  payments  made on account of  beneficial
ownership interests in the Global Certificate or for maintaining, supervising or
reviewing any records relating to such beneficial ownership interests.

     The Company has been  informed by DTC that,  with respect to any payment of
dividends on, or the redemption  price with respect to, the Global  Certificate,
DTC's  practice  is to  credit  Participants'  accounts,  on  the  payment  date
therefor,  with payments in amounts proportionate to their respective beneficial
interests in the Convertible  Exchangeable  Preferred  Stock  represented by the
Global  Certificate  as shown on the  records  of DTC,  unless DTC has reason to
believe  that it will not  receive  payment on such  payment  date.  Payments by
Participants to owners of beneficial  interests in the Convertible  Exchangeable
Preferred  Stock  represented  by  the  Global  Certificate  held  through  such
Participants will be the responsibility of such Participants, as is now the case
with securities held for the accounts of customers registered in "street name."

     Transfers  between  Participants  will be effected in the  ordinary  way in
accordance with DTC's rules and will be settled in immediately  available funds.
The laws of some states require that certain  persons take physical  delivery of
securities in definitive form. Consequently,  the ability to transfer beneficial
interests in the Global Certificate to such persons may be limited.  Because DTC
can only act on behalf of  Participants,  who in turn act on behalf of  Indirect
Participants  and certain  banks,  the ability of a person  having a  beneficial
interest in the  Convertible  Exchangeable  Preferred  Stock  represented by the
Global  Certificate  to pledge such  interest to persons or entities that do not
participate  in the DTC system,  or  otherwise  take  actions in respect of such
interest,  may be affected by the lack of a physical certificate evidencing such
interest.

     Neither the Company nor the Transfer Agent will have responsibility for the
performance  of  DTC or its  Participants  or  Indirect  Participants  of  their
respective   obligations   under  the  rules  and  procedures   governing  their
operations.  DTC has advised the Company that it will take any action  permitted
to be taken by a holder of Convertible  Exchangeable Preferred Stock (including,
without limitation, the presentation of Convertible Exchangeable Preferred Stock
for exchange or conversion as described above) only at the direction 


                                      S-79
<PAGE>

of one or more  Participants  to whose  account with DTC interests in the Global
Certificate are credited,  and only in respect of the  Convertible  Exchangeable
Preferred  Stock  represented  by  the  Global  Certificate  as  to  which  such
Participant or Participants has or have given such direction.

     DTC has also  advised  the  Company  that DTC is a  limited  purpose  trust
company  organized  under  the laws of the  state of New  York,  a member of the
Federal  Reserve  System,  a  "clearing  corporation"  within the meaning of the
Uniform  Commercial  Code and a  "clearing  agency"  registered  pursuant to the
provisions  of  Section  17A of the  Exchange  Act.  DTC  was  created  to  hold
securities for its  Participants  and to facilitate the clearance and settlement
of securities  transactions between  Participants through electronic  book-entry
changes  to  accounts  of its  Participants,  thereby  eliminating  the need for
physical movement of certificates.  Participants  include securities brokers and
dealers,  banks,  trust  companies  and  clearing  corporations  and may include
certain  other   organizations  such  as  the  Underwriters.   Certain  of  such
Participants (or their representatives),  together with other entities, own DTC.
Indirect access to the DTC system is available to others such as banks, brokers,
dealers and trust companies through, or which maintain a custodial  relationship
with, a Participant, either directly or indirectly.

     Although DTC has agreed to the foregoing  procedures in order to facilitate
transfers of interests in the Global Certificate among Participants, it is under
no  obligation  to perform or  continue  to perform  such  procedures,  and such
procedures may be  discontinued  at any time. If DTC is at any time unwilling or
unable to continue as depositary and a successor  depositary is not appointed by
the Company within 90 days, the Company will cause the Convertible  Exchangeable
Preferred  Stock to be issued in  definitive  form in  exchange  for the  Global
Certificate.  In addition,  the Company in its sole  discretion  may at any time
determine  not to  have  any of the  Convertible  Exchangeable  Preferred  Stock
represented by the Global Certificate. 


OTHER PROVISIONS

     The shares of Convertible  Exchangeable  Preferred  Stock,  and the Class A
Common  Stock when  issued  upon  conversion  thereof,  will be duly and validly
issued, fully paid and nonassessable.

     The holders of shares of Convertible Exchangeable Preferred Stock will have
no preemptive rights with respect to any securities of the Company.


     The  Company  has  applied  for  listing  of the  Convertible  Exchangeable
Preferred  Stock on the Nasdaq National  Market.  No assurance can be given that
such application will be approved or that the Convertible Exchangeable Preferred
Stock will trade on the Nasdaq  National  Market.  Prior to the  issuance of the
Convertible  Exchangeable  Preferred Stock,  there will be no trading market for
the shares of  Convertible  Exchangeable  Preferred  Stock,  and there can be no
assurance  that a market  will  develop.  See "Risk  Factors - Absence of Public
Trading Market" in the accompanying Prospectus. 

     If shares of the Convertible  Exchangeable  Preferred Stock trade, they are
expected  to trade at a price that  takes into  account  the value,  if any,  of
accrued and unpaid distributions; thus, purchasers will not pay for, and sellers
will not receive,  any accrued and unpaid distributions that are not included in
the trading price of the Convertible Exchangeable Preferred Stock.

     The  Convertible  Exchangeable  Preferred  Stock pays  dividends at a fixed
rate. The liquidation preference of the Convertible Exchangeable Preferred Stock
is not necessarily indicative of the price at which the Convertible Exchangeable
Preferred  Stock  will  actually  trade  at or after  the  time of the  issuance
thereof,  and the Convertible  Exchangeable  Preferred Stock may trade at prices
below its liquidation preference.  The market price can be expected to fluctuate
with changes in other  securities that pay dividends or interest at a fixed rate
and economic  conditions,  the financial  condition and prospects of the Company
and other factors that  generally  influence the market prices of debt and other
securities that pay dividends or interest at a fixed rate.

     The registrar,  transfer agent,  conversion  agent and dividend  disbursing
agent for the  Convertible  Exchangeable  Preferred Stock and the transfer agent
and registrar for the Class A Common Stock issuable upon  conversion  thereof is
The First National Bank of Boston.


                                      S-80
<PAGE>

                      DESCRIPTION OF EXCHANGE DEBENTURES

     The Exchange  Debentures  will be issued under an indenture,  a copy of the
form of which has been  filed as an  exhibit to the  registration  statement  of
which this Prospectus Supplement is a part (the "Exchange Debenture Indenture"),
between the Company and First Union National  Bank, as trustee (the  "Trustee").
The  following  summaries  of  certain  provisions  of  the  Exchange  Debenture
Indenture do not purport to be complete and are subject to, and are qualified in
their entirety by reference to, all of the provisions of the Exchange  Debenture
Indenture,   including  the  definition  therein  of  certain  terms.   Wherever
particular  sections or defined  terms of the Exchange  Debenture  Indenture are
referred  to,  such  sections  or  defined  terms  are  incorporated  herein  by
reference. For purposes of the following discussion, "Common Stock" includes any
stock of any  class  of the  Company  which  has no  preference  in  respect  of
dividends or of amounts  payable in the event of any  voluntary  or  involuntary
liquidation,  dissolution  or winding-up of the Company and which is not subject
to redemption by the Company, including, without limitation, the Company's Class
A Common Stock and Class B Common Stock.


GENERAL

     The Exchange Debentures will be unsecured  obligations of the Company, will
be limited to $150 million in aggregate  principal  amount (plus an amount equal
to  the  aggregate   liquidation   preference  of  any  shares  of   Convertible
Exchangeable   Preferred  Stock  issued  upon  exercise  of  the   Underwriters'
over-allotment  option) and will mature on  September  15,  2012.  The  Exchange
Debentures  will  bear  interest  at the rate  per  annum of 6% from the date of
original issuance of Exchange Debentures pursuant to the Indenture,  or from the
most recent  interest  payment date to which  interest has been paid or provided
for,  payable  quarterly  on March 15, June 15,  September 15 and December 15 of
each year (each an "Interest Payment Date") commencing on the first such payment
date  following  the date of the  exchange,  to the  Person  in  whose  name the
Exchange Debenture (or any predecessor  Exchange Debenture) is registered at the
close of business on the preceding  March 1, June 1, September 1 and December 1,
as the case may be.  Interest  on the  Exchange  Debentures  will be paid on the
basis of a 360-day year of twelve 30-day months.

     Principal of, and premium, if any, and interest on, the Exchange Debentures
will be  payable  (i) in respect of  Exchange  Debentures  held of record by The
Depository  Trust Company ("DTC") or its nominee,  in same day funds on or prior
to the  payment  dates  with  respect  to such  amounts  and (ii) in  respect of
Exchange  Debentures held of record by holders other than DTC or its nominee, at
the corporate trust office of the Trustee. In addition, with respect to Exchange
Debentures  held of record by holders other than DTC or its nominee,  payment of
interest may be made at the option of the Company by check mailed to the address
of the persons  entitled  thereto as it appears in the register for the Exchange
Debentures on the regular  record date for such  interest  (the "Regular  Record
Date").  The Exchange  Debentures may be surrendered  for transfer,  exchange or
conversion  at the corporate  trust office of the Trustee.  Except under certain
conditions,  the Exchange  Debentures will not be issued in certificate form but
will be held by DTC in permanent global form.

     The Exchange  Debentures  will be issued only in registered  form,  without
coupons and in denominations of $1,000 or any integral  multiple thereof or such
other denomination as determined by the Company.  No service charge will be made
for any  transfer or exchange of the  Exchange  Debentures,  but the Company may
require  payment  of a sum  sufficient  to cover  any tax or other  governmental
charge and any other  expenses  (including the fees and expenses of the Trustee)
payable in  connection  therewith.  The  Company is not  required  (i) to issue,
register the transfer of or exchange  any  Exchange  Debentures  during a period
beginning  at the opening of business 15 days before the day of the mailing of a
notice of  redemption  and  ending at the close of  business  on the day of such
mailing,  or (ii) to register the transfer of or exchange any Exchange Debenture
selected for redemption in whole or in part,  except the  unredeemed  portion of
Exchange Debentures being redeemed in part.

     All monies paid by the  Company to the Trustee or any Paying  Agent for the
payment  of  principal  of and  premium  if any  and  interest  on any  Exchange
Debenture which remain unclaimed for two years after such principal,  premium or
interest  become due and payable may be repaid to the Company.  Thereafter,  the
registered  holder of such  Exchange  Debenture  may,  as an  unsecured  general
creditor, look only to the Company for payment thereof.


                                      S-81
<PAGE>

     The Exchange Debenture Indenture does not contain any provisions that would
provide  protection to holders of the Exchange  Debentures  against a sudden and
dramatic  decline in credit quality of the Company  resulting from any takeover,
recapitalization  or similar  restructuring,  except as described below under "-
Change of Control."


CONVERSION RIGHTS

     The holder of any Exchange  Debenture will have the right,  at the holder's
option,  to convert the principal amount thereof (or any portion thereof that is
an integral  multiple of $1,000) into shares of Class A Common Stock at any time
prior to maturity, initially at the conversion rate in effect on the Convertible
Exchangeable  Preferred  Stock  at the  date  of  exchange  of  the  Convertible
Exchangeable  Preferred Stock for Exchange Debentures (subject to adjustments as
described below), except that if an Exchange Debenture is called for redemption,
the  conversion  right will  terminate  on the close of  business  on the second
business day preceding the date fixed for redemption. No payment of interest and
no  adjustment in respect of dividends  will be made upon the  conversion of any
Exchange Debenture, and the holder will lose any right to payment of interest on
the  Exchange  Debentures   surrendered  for  conversion.   Exchange  Debentures
surrendered for conversion during the period from the Regular Record Date for an
interest  payment to the  corresponding  Interest  Payment Date (except Exchange
Debentures  called for  redemption  during that period) must be  accompanied  by
payment of an amount equal to the interest upon conversion. No fractional shares
will be issued upon conversion but, in lieu thereof,  an appropriate amount will
be paid in cash based on the last  reported sale price for the shares of Class A
Common Stock on the day of conversion.  The provisions in the Exchange Debenture
Indenture for  adjustment of the conversion  rate  (including a reduction of the
conversion rate under certain circumstances) and conversion in connection with a
reclassification,  consolidation,  merger, sale, transfer or share exchange will
be substantially  the same as those  applicable to the Convertible  Exchangeable
Preferred Stock  described  above under the caption  "Description of Convertible
Exchangeable Preferred Stock-Conversion Rights."


SUBORDINATION

     The payment of the  principal of and  premium,  if any, and interest on the
Exchange  Debentures  will,  to the extent set forth in the  Exchange  Debenture
Indenture,  be  subordinated in right of payment to the prior payment in full of
all Senior Debt in cash or cash  equivalents or in any other form  acceptable to
the  holders  of Senior  Debt.  The  Exchange  Debentures  will be  subordinated
indebtedness  of the Company  ranking  junior to all existing and future  Senior
Subordinated  Indebtedness  of the Company and pari passu to all other  existing
and future subordinated indebtedness of the Company.

     As of June 30, 1997 on a pro forma basis,  after giving  effect to the Debt
Issuance,  the sale of the  Convertible  Exchangeable  Preferred  Stock  offered
hereby and the application of the estimated net proceeds thereof,  the aggregate
amount of Senior  Debt that  ranked  senior in right of payment to the  Exchange
Debentures  would have been  approximately  $1.6  billion.  As the  Company is a
holding  company,  substantially  all of the  Company's  assets  consist  of the
capital  stock of its  Subsidiaries.  Except to the extent  that the Company may
itself be a creditor with recognized claims against its Subsidiaries, the claims
of the holders of the Exchange  Debentures are  effectively  subordinated to the
claims of the direct  creditors of the  Subsidiaries of the Company.  All of the
Senior Debt is guaranteed by  substantially  all of the Company's  Subsidiaries.
Subject  to  compliance   with  certain   limitations   in  the  Company's  debt
instruments, the Company and its Subsidiaries may incur additional indebtedness.
See "Risk Factors - Subordination  of the  Subordinated  Debt Securities and the
Related  Guarantees;  Asset  Encumbrances"  in the  accompanying  Prospectus and
"Capitalization" herein.

     During the continuance of any default in the payment of any Senior Debt and
non-payment  default with respect to Senior Debt  pursuant to which the maturity
thereof has been  accelerated,  no payment or  distribution of any assets of the
Company of any kind or character  (excluding  certain permitted equity interests
or  subordinated  securities)  shall be made on  account  of the  principal  of,
premium,  if any, or interest on the  Exchange  Debentures  or on account of the
purchase, redemption, defeasance or other


                                      S-82
<PAGE>

acquisition  of the Exchange  Debentures  unless and until such default has been
cured,  waived  or has  ceased  to exist or such  Senior  Debt  shall  have been
discharged  or paid in full in cash or cash  equivalents  or in any  other  form
acceptable to the holders of Senior Debt.

     During the  continuance  of any  non-payment  default  with  respect to any
Designated  Senior Debt pursuant to the terms of which the maturity  thereof may
be  accelerated (a  "Non-payment  Default") and after the receipt by the Trustee
from a representative  of the holder of any Designated  Senior Debt of a written
notice of such default,  no payment or distribution of any assets of the Company
of any kind or character  (excluding  certain  permitted  equity or subordinated
securities)  may be made by the Company on account of the principal of, premium,
if any, or interest on the Exchange  Debentures  or on account of the  purchase,
redemption,  defeasance or other acquisition of the Exchange  Debentures for the
period specified below (the "Payment Blockage Period").

     The Payment  Blockage  Period shall  commence upon the receipt of notice of
the Non-payment  Default by the Trustee from a representative  of the holders of
any  Designated  Senior Debt and shall end on the earliest of (i) the first date
on which more than 179 days shall have elapsed since the receipt of such written
notice (provided such Designated  Senior Debt as to which notice was given shall
not therefore have been  accelerated);  (ii) the date on which such  Non-payment
Default  (and all  Non-payment  Defaults as to which  notice is given after such
Payment  Blockage Period is initiated) are cured or waived or ceased to exist or
on which such  Designated  Senior Debt is  discharged or paid in full in cash or
cash  equivalents  or in any other form  acceptable to the holders of Designated
Senior Debt;  or (iii) the date on which such Payment  Blockage  Period (and all
Non-payment  Defaults as to which  notice is given after such  Payment  Blockage
Period is initiated) shall have been terminated by written notice to the Company
or the Trustee from the  representative  of holders of Designated Senior Debt or
the holders of at least a majority of the Designated Senior Debt initiating such
Payment  Blockage  Period,  after which,  in the case of clauses  (i),  (ii) and
(iii), the Company shall promptly resume making any and all required payments in
respect of the Exchange Debentures,  including any missed payments.  In no event
will a  Payment  Blockage  Period  extend  beyond  179 days from the date of the
receipt by the  Company of the  Trustee of the notice  initiating  such  Payment
Blockage Period (such 179-day period referred to as the "Initial  Period").  Any
number of notices  of  Non-payment  Defaults  may be given  during  the  Initial
Period;  provided  that during any 365-day  consecutive  period only one Payment
Blockage  Period  during which  payment of  principal  of,  premium,  if any, or
interest on the  Exchange  Debentures  may not be made may commence and that the
duration of the Payment  Blockage Period may not exceed 179 days. No Non-payment
Default with respect to Designated  Senior Debt which existed or was  continuing
on the date of the  commencement of any Payment  Blockage Period will be, or can
be, made the basis for the  commencement  of a second Payment  Blockage  Period,
whether or not within a period of 365 consecutive  days, unless such default has
been cured or waived for a period of not less than 90 consecutive days.

     If the Company  fails to make any payment on the Exchange  Debentures  when
due or within  any  applicable  grace  period,  whether or not on account of the
payment blockage  provisions referred to above, such failure would constitute an
Event of Default  under the Exchange  Debenture  Indenture  and would enable the
holders of the Exchange  Debentures  to  accelerate  the Maturity  thereof.  See
"-Events of Default."

     The  Exchange  Debenture  Indenture  will  provide that in the event of any
insolvency or bankruptcy case or proceeding,  or any receivership,  liquidation,
reorganization  or other similar case or  proceeding  in  connection  therewith,
relative to the Company or its assets, or any liquidation,  dissolution or other
winding up of the Company,  whether  voluntary or involuntary and whether or not
involving  insolvency  or  bankruptcy,  or any  assignment  for the  benefit  of
creditors or any other  marshaling of assets or liabilities of the Company,  all
Senior  Debt  must be paid in full in cash or cash  equivalents  or in any other
manner  acceptable  to the holders of Senior Debt,  or  provision  made for such
payment, before any payment or distribution (excluding  distributions of certain
permitted equity or subordinated securities) is made on account of the principal
of, premium, if any, or interest on the Exchange Debentures.

     By reason of such subordination, in the event of liquidation or insolvency,
creditors  of the  Company  who are  holders of Senior  Debt may  recover  more,
ratably,  than the holders of the Exchange Debentures,  and funds which would be
otherwise payable to the holders of the Exchange Debentures will be


                                      S-83
<PAGE>

paid to the holders of the Senior Debt to the extent necessary to pay the Senior
Debt in full in cash or cash  equivalents  or in any other manner  acceptable to
the  holders  of  Senior  Debt,  and the  Company  may be  unable  to  meet  its
obligations fully with respect to the Exchange Debentures.


FRAUDULENT CONVEYANCE CONSIDERATIONS

     Under  applicable  provisions of the federal  bankruptcy  law or comparable
provisions of state fraudulent transfer law, if a court were to find that at the
time of the exchange of the Convertible  Exchangeable  Preferred  Securities for
Exchange  Debentures  (i) the Company was  insolvent  or rendered  insolvent  by
reason thereof,  (ii) the Company was engaged, or about to engage, in a business
or transaction for which the Company's remaining assets constitute  unreasonably
small  capital,  (iii) the Company  intended to incur or believed  that it would
incur  debts  beyond its  ability  to pay such debts as they  mature or (iv) the
Company was a defendant  in an action for money  damages,  or had a judgment for
money damages docketed against it (if in either case, after final judgment,  the
judgment is unsatisfied).  In such case, the holders could be required to return
the Exchange Debentures to or for the benefit of existing or future creditors of
the Company.  The measure of insolvency  for purposes of the foregoing will vary
depending on the law of the jurisdiction which is being applied.  Generally,  an
entity would be considered  insolvent  if, at the time it incurs any  obligation
(i) the sum of its debts, including contingent liabilities, was greater than the
fair  salable  value of its assets at a fair  valuation,  (ii) the present  fair
salable  value of its assets was less than the amount  that would be required to
pay its  probable  liability on its existing  debts and  liabilities,  including
contingent  liabilities,  as they become  absolute  and  mature,  or (iii) it is
incurring debt beyond its ability to pay as such debt matures.


REDEMPTION AT OPTION OF THE COMPANY

     The Exchange  Debentures will be redeemable,  at the Company's  option,  in
whole or from time to time in part,  at any time on or after  December 15, 2000,
upon not less than 30 nor more than 60 days' prior notice by first class mail to
each holder of Exchange  Debentures  to be redeemed at its address  appearing in
the security  register and prior to maturity at the following  redemption prices
("Redemption  Prices")  (expressed as percentages of the principal  amount) plus
accrued  interest  to the  Redemption  Date  (subject to the right of holders of
record  on the  relevant  Regular  Record  Date to  receive  interest  due on an
Interest Payment Date that is on or prior to the Redemption Date).

     If redeemed during the 12-month period  beginning  September 15 in the year
indicated (December 15, in the case of 2000), the Redemption Price shall be:


<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
               REDEMPTION                                   REDEMPTION
   YEAR          PRICE                  YEAR                  PRICE
- ------------   ------------   ---------------------------   -----------
<S>            <C>            <C>                            <C>
2000  ......    104.20%       2004  .....................    101.80%
2001  ......    103.60        2005  .....................    101.20
2002  ......    103.00        2006  .....................    100.60
2003  ......    102.40        2007 and thereafter  ......    100.00
</TABLE>


SINKING FUND AND DEFEASANCE

     There will be no sinking fund or defeasance rights.


CONSOLIDATION, MERGER AND SALE OF ASSETS

     The  Company  shall  not,  in a single  transaction  or a series of related
transactions,  consolidate  with or merge with or into any other Person or sell,
assign, convey, transfer, lease or otherwise dispose of all or substantially all
of its  properties and assets to any Person or group of affiliated  Persons,  or
permit  any  of  its   Subsidiaries  to  enter  into  any  such  transaction  or
transactions if such transaction or transactions, in the aggregate, would result
in a sale,  assignment,  conveyance,  transfer,  lease or  disposition of all or
substantially  all  of  the  properties  and  assets  of  the  Company  and  its
Subsidiaries on a consolidated  basis to any other Person or group of affiliated
Persons, unless at the time and after giving effect thereto:


                                      S-84
<PAGE>

(i) either (1) the Company shall be the surviving  corporation or (2) the Person
(if other  than the  Company)  formed by such  consolidation  or into  which the
Company is merged or the Person which acquires by sale, assignment,  conveyance,
transfer, lease or disposition of all or substantially all of the properties and
assets  of the  Company  and  its  Subsidiaries  on a  consolidated  basis  (the
"Surviving  Entity") shall be a corporation  duly organized and validly existing
under  the laws of the  United  States of  America,  any  state  thereof  or the
District of Columbia and such Person assumes,  by a supplemental  indenture in a
form reasonably  satisfactory to the Trustee, all the obligations of the Company
under the Exchange  Debentures  and the Exchange  Debenture  Indenture,  and the
Exchange  Debenture  Indenture  shall  remain  in full  force and  effect;  (ii)
immediately  before and immediately after giving effect to such transaction,  no
Default or Event of Default  shall have occurred and be  continuing;  (iii) such
transaction  does not  adversely  effect the validity or  enforceability  of the
Exchange  Debentures;  and (iv) the Company or the  Surviving  Entity shall have
delivered,  or caused to be  delivered,  to the Trustee,  in form and  substance
reasonably  satisfactory to the Trustee, an officers' certificate and an opinion
of counsel, each to the effect that such consolidation,  merger, transfer, sale,
assignment, lease or other transaction and the supplemental indenture in respect
thereto comply with the provisions of the Exchange Debenture  Indenture and that
all  conditions  precedent  provided  for in the  Exchange  Debenture  Indenture
relating to such transaction have been complied with.

     In the  event of any  transaction  (other  than a lease)  described  in and
complying with the conditions listed in the immediately  preceding  paragraph in
which the Company is not the continuing corporation, the successor Person formed
or remaining  shall succeed to, and be  substituted  for, and may exercise every
right and power of, the Company,  and the Company would be  discharged  from its
obligations under the Exchange Debenture Indenture and the Exchange Debentures.

CHANGE OF CONTROL

     If a Change of  Control  (as  defined  under the  caption  "Description  of
Convertible  Exchangeable  Preferred  Stock - Change of Control") shall occur at
any  time,  then each  holder of  Exchange  Debentures  shall  have the right to
require that the Company purchase such holder's Exchange  Debentures in whole or
in part in integral  multiples  of $1,000,  at a purchase  price (the "Change of
Control  Purchase  Price") in cash in an amount  equal to 100% of the  principal
amount of such Exchange Debentures, plus accrued and unpaid interest, if any, to
the date of purchase (the "Change of Control  Purchase  Date"),  pursuant to the
offer described  below (the "Change of Control Offer") and the other  procedures
set forth in the Exchange Debenture Indenture.

     Within 30 days  following  any Change of Control,  the Company shall notify
the  Trustee  thereof and give  written  notice of such Change of Control to the
holder of Exchange  Debentures,  by first-class mail, postage prepaid,  at their
addresses appearing in the security register,  stating,  among other things, the
Change of Control  Purchase  Price and that the Change of Control  Purchase Date
shall be a business  day no earlier than 30 days nor later than 60 days from the
date such notice is mailed,  or such later date as is  necessary  to comply with
requirements  under the Exchange Act;  that any Exchange  Debenture not tendered
will  continue to accrue  interest;  that,  unless the  Company  defaults in the
payment  of the  Change of  Control  Purchase  Price,  any  Exchange  Debentures
accepted  for  payment  pursuant  to the Change of Control  Offer shall cease to
accrue  interest  after the Change of Control  Purchase  Date; and certain other
procedures  that a holder of Exchange  Debentures must follow to accept a Change
of Control Offer or to withdraw such acceptance.

     If a Change of Control  Offer is made,  there can be no assurance  that the
Company  will have  available  funds  sufficient  to pay the  Change of  Control
Purchase  Price for all of the  Exchange  Debentures  that might be delivered by
holders  of the  Exchange  Debentures  seeking  to accept  the Change of Control
Offer.  The holders of the Existing Notes and the Series C Preferred  Stock have
rights upon a Change of Control that are similar to the rights of the holders of
the  Exchange  Debentures.  A Change of Control  will also result in an event of
default under the Bank Credit  Agreement and could result in the acceleration of
all  indebtedness  under the Bank Credit  Agreement.  Moreover,  the Bank Credit
Agreement  prohibits the  repurchase of the Exchange  Debentures by the Company.
The failure of the Company to make or consummate  the Change of Control Offer or
pay the Change of  Control  Purchase  Price when due will  result in an Event of
Default under the Exchange Debenture Indenture.


                                      S-85
<PAGE>

     The term "all or substantially all" as used in the definition of "Change of
Control" has not been interpreted under New York law (which is the governing law
of the Exchange Debenture Indenture) to represent a specific  quantitative test.
As a consequence, in the event the holders of the Exchange Debentures elected to
exercise  their rights under the Exchange  Debenture  Indenture  and the Company
elected to contest such election,  there could be no assurance as to how a court
interpreting New York law would interpret the phrase.

     The existence of a holder's right to require the Company to repurchase such
holder's  Exchange  Debentures  upon a Change of Control may deter a third party
from  acquiring  the  Company in a  transaction  which  constitutes  a Change of
Control.

     The provisions of the Exchange Debenture  Indenture will not afford holders
of  Exchange  Debentures  the right to require  the  Company to  repurchase  the
Exchange  Debentures in the event of a highly  leveraged  transaction or certain
transactions  with the  Company's  management  or its  affiliates,  including  a
reorganization,  restructuring,  merger or similar  transaction  (including,  in
certain  circumstances,  an  acquisition  of the  Company by  management  or its
Affiliates)  involving  the Company  that may  adversely  affect  holders of the
Exchange  Debentures,  if such  transaction  is not a  transaction  defined as a
Change of Control.  A  transaction  involving  the  Company's  management or its
affiliates,  or a transaction  involving a recapitalization of the Company, will
result in a Change of Control if it is the type of transaction specified by such
definition.

     The Company will comply with tender offer rules, including Rule 14e-1 under
the Exchange Act, and any other  applicable  securities  laws or  regulations in
connection with a Change of Control Offer.


EVENTS OF DEFAULT

     An Event of Default will occur under the Exchange Debenture Indenture if:

     (i) there shall be a default in the payment of any interest on any Exchange
Debenture when it becomes due and payable, and such default shall continue for a
period of 30 days;

     (ii)  there  shall be a default  in the  payment  of the  principal  of (or
premium,  if any, on) any Exchange Debenture at its Maturity (upon acceleration,
optional or mandatory redemption, required repurchase or otherwise);

     (iii) (a) there shall be a default in the  performance,  or breach,  of any
covenant or agreement  of the Company  under the  Exchange  Debenture  Indenture
(other than a default in the performance,  or breach, of a covenant or agreement
which is  specifically  dealt with in clause (i) or (ii) or in clause (b) or (c)
of this clause (iii)) and such default or breach shall  continue for a period of
60 days after  written  notice has been given,  by  certified  mail,  (x) to the
Company by the  Trustee or (y) to the  Company and the Trustee by the holders of
at  least  25%  in  aggregate  principal  amount  of  the  outstanding  Exchange
Debentures;  (b) there  shall be a default in the  performance  or breach of the
provisions  described in "- Consolidation,  Merger,  Sale of Assets"; or (c) the
Company  shall have failed to make or  consummate  a Change of Control  Offer in
accordance with the provisions described in "- Change of Control";

     (iv)  one or more  defaults  shall  have  occurred  under  any  agreements,
indentures or instruments  under which the Company or any Restricted  Subsidiary
then has outstanding  Indebtedness in excess of $5,000,000 in the aggregate and,
if not already matured at its final maturity in accordance with its terms,  such
Indebtedness shall have been accelerated;

     (v) there shall have been the entry by a court of competent jurisdiction of
(a) a decree or order for  relief in respect  of the  Company or any  Restricted
Subsidiary in an involuntary case or proceeding under any applicable  Bankruptcy
Law or (b) a decree or order adjudging the Company or any Restricted  Subsidiary
bankrupt or insolvent,  or seeking  reorganization,  arrangement,  adjustment or
composition of or in respect of the Company or any Restricted  Subsidiary  under
any  applicable  federal or state law,  or  appointing  a  custodian,  receiver,
liquidator,  assignee, trustee,  sequestrator (or other similar official) of the
Company  or any  Restricted  Subsidiary  or of any  substantial  part  of  their
respective  properties,  or  ordering  the  winding up or  liquidation  of their
affairs, and any such decree or order for relief shall continue to be in effect,
or any such other decree or order shall be unstayed and in effect,  for a period
of 60 consecutive days; or


                                      S-86
<PAGE>

     (vi) (a) the  Company or any  Restricted  Subsidiary  commences a voluntary
case or  proceeding  under any  applicable  Bankruptcy  Law or any other case or
proceeding  to be  adjudicated  bankrupt  or  insolvent,  (b) the Company or any
Restricted  Subsidiary  consents to the entry of a decree or order for relief in
respect of the Company or such Restricted  Subsidiary in an involuntary  case or
proceeding  under any applicable  Bankruptcy Law or to the  commencement  of any
bankruptcy or insolvency  case or proceeding  against it, (c) the Company or any
Restricted   Subsidiary   files  a  petition   or  answer  or  consent   seeking
reorganization  or relief  under any  applicable  federal or state law,  (d) the
Company or any Restricted Subsidiary (x) consents to the filing of such petition
or  the  appointment  of,  or  taking  possession  by,  a  custodian,  receiver,
liquidator,  assignee,  trustee,  sequestrator or other similar  official of the
Company  or such  Restricted  Subsidiary  or of any  substantial  part of  their
respective property, (y) makes an assignment for the benefit of creditors or (z)
admits in writing its inability to pay its debts generally as they become due or
(e) the  Company or any  Restricted  Subsidiary  takes any  corporate  action in
furtherance of any such actions in this paragraph (vi).

     If an Event of Default  (other than as specified in clauses (v) and (vi) of
the prior paragraph)  shall occur and be continuing,  the Trustee or the holders
of not less than 25% in aggregate  principal  amount of the Exchange  Debentures
outstanding  may, and the Trustee at the request of such holders shall,  declare
all unpaid  principal  of,  premium,  if any,  and accrued  interest on, all the
Exchange  Debentures to be due and payable immediately by a notice in writing to
the  Company  (and to the  Trustee  if  given  by the  holders  of the  Exchange
Debentures);  provided  that so long as the Bank Credit  Agreement is in effect,
such  declaration  shall not  become  effective  until the  earlier  of (a) five
business days after receipt of such notice of  acceleration  from the holders or
the Trustee by the agent under the Bank Credit  Agreement or (b) acceleration of
the Indebtedness under the Bank Credit Agreement.  Thereupon the Trustee may, at
its  discretion,  proceed to protect  and  enforce  the rights of the holders of
Exchange Debentures by appropriate judicial  proceeding.  If an Event of Default
specified in clause (v) or (vi) of the prior paragraph occurs and is continuing,
then all the Exchange  Debentures shall ipso facto become and be immediately due
and  payable,  in an  amount  equal  to the  principal  amount  of the  Exchange
Debentures,  together with accrued and unpaid interest,  if any, to the date the
Exchange Debentures become due and payable, without any declaration or other act
on the  part of the  Trustee  or any  holder.  The  Trustee  or,  if  notice  of
acceleration is given by the holders of the Exchange Debentures,  the holders of
the  Exchange  Debentures  shall give  notice to the agent under the Bank Credit
Agreement of such acceleration.

     After a declaration  of  acceleration,  but before a judgment or decree for
payment of the money due has been  obtained  by the  Trustee,  the  holders of a
majority in aggregate  principal amount of Exchange Debentures  outstanding,  by
written  notice to the  Company  and the  Trustee,  may  rescind  and annul such
declaration  if (a) the  Company  has paid or  deposited  with the Trustee a sum
sufficient  to pay (i) all  sums  paid or  advanced  by the  Trustee  under  the
Exchange  Debenture  Indenture  and  the  reasonable   compensation,   expenses,
disbursements  and  advances of the Trustee,  its agents and  counsel,  (ii) all
overdue interest on all Exchange Debentures, (iii) the principal of and premium,
if any, on any Exchange  Debentures which have become due otherwise than by such
declaration of acceleration and interest thereon at a rate borne by the Exchange
Debentures  and (iv) to the  extent  that  payment of such  interest  is lawful,
interest upon overdue interest at the rate borne by the Exchange Debentures; and
(b) all  Events of  Default,  other than the  non-payment  of  principal  of the
Exchange  Debentures  which  have  become  due  solely  by such  declaration  of
acceleration, have been cured or waived.

     The holders of not less than a majority in  aggregate  principal  amount of
the  Exchange  Debentures  outstanding  may on behalf of the  holders of all the
Exchange  Debentures  waive  any  past  default  under  the  Exchange  Debenture
Indenture and its consequences, except a default in the payment of the principal
of, premium, if any, or interest on any Exchange  Debenture,  or in respect of a
covenant or provision  which under the Exchange  Debenture  Indenture  cannot be
modified or amended without the consent of the holder of each Exchange Debenture
outstanding.

     The Company is also  required to notify the  Trustee  within five  business
days of the occurrence of any Default. The Company is required to deliver to the
Trustee,  on or before a date not more than 60 days after the end of each fiscal
quarter and not more than 120 days after the end of each fiscal  year, a written
statement as to  compliance  with the Exchange  Debenture  Indenture,  including
whether or not


                                      S-87
<PAGE>

any default has occurred.  The Trustee is under no obligation to exercise any of
the rights or powers  vested in it by the  Exchange  Debenture  Indenture at the
request or  direction of any of the holders of the  Exchange  Debentures  unless
such  holders  offer to the Trustee  security or indemnity  satisfactory  to the
Trustee  against the costs,  expenses  and  liabilities  which might be incurred
thereby.

     The Trust Indenture Act contains  limitations on the rights of the Trustee,
should it become a  creditor  of the  Company,  to obtain  payment  of claims in
certain cases or to realize on certain property received by it in respect of any
such  claims,  as security or  otherwise.  The Trustee is permitted to engage in
other  transactions,  provided that if it acquires any  conflicting  interest it
must  eliminate such conflict upon the occurrence of an Event of Default or else
resign. The Exchange Debenture  Indenture provides that the Trustee may withhold
notice to the  holders of the  Exchange  Debentures  of any  continuing  default
(except in the payment of the  principal  of or premium,  if any, or interest on
any Exchange  Debentures) if the Trustee considers it in the interest of holders
of the Exchange Debentures to do so.


MODIFICATION, AMENDMENTS AND WAIVERS

     Modifications  and  amendments of the Exchange  Debenture  Indenture may be
made by the Company and the Trustee  with the consent of the holders of not less
than a  majority  in  aggregate  principal  amount of the  outstanding  Exchange
Debentures;  provided,  however,  that no such  modification  or amendment  may,
without  the  consent  of the  holder  of each  outstanding  Exchange  Debenture
affected  thereby:  (i) change the stated  Maturity of the  principal of, or any
installment  of interest  on, any  Exchange  Debenture  or reduce the  principal
amount thereof or the rate of interest  thereon or any premium,  if any, payable
upon the  redemption  thereof,  or  change  the coin or  currency  in which  the
principal  of any Exchange  Debenture  or any  premium,  if any, or the interest
thereon is payable, or impair the right to institute suit for the enforcement of
any  such  payment  after  the  stated  Maturity  thereof  (or  in the  case  of
redemption,  on or after the redemption date); (ii) amend,  change or modify the
obligation  of the Company to make and  consummate a Change of Control  Offer in
the event of a Change of Control in accordance with the provisions  described in
"- Change of Control," including amending, changing or modifying any definitions
with  respect  thereto;  (iii)  reduce the  percentage  in  principal  amount of
outstanding  Exchange  Debentures,  the consent of whose holders is required for
any such supplemental indenture, or the consent of whose holders is required for
any waiver or  compliance  with certain  provisions  of the  Exchange  Debenture
Indenture or certain  defaults;  (iv) modify any of the  provisions  relating to
supplemental  indentures  requiring  the  consent of holders or  relating to the
waiver of past defaults or relating to the waiver of certain  covenants,  except
to increase the percentage of outstanding  Exchange Debentures required for such
actions or to provide that certain other  provisions  of the Exchange  Debenture
Indenture cannot be modified or waived without the consent of the holder of each
Exchange Debenture affected thereby;  (v) except as otherwise permitted under "-
Consolidation, Merger, Sale of Assets," consent to the assignment or transfer by
the Company of any of its rights and  obligations  under the Exchange  Debenture
Indenture;  or (vi)  amend  or  modify  any of the  provisions  of the  Exchange
Debenture  Indenture relating to the subordination or conversion of the Exchange
Debentures in any manner adverse to the holders of the Exchange Debentures.

     The holders of a majority in  aggregate  principal  amount of the  Exchange
Debentures  outstanding may waive compliance with certain restrictive  covenants
and provisions of the Exchangeable Debenture Indenture.


SATISFACTION AND DISCHARGE

     The Exchange Debenture Indenture will cease to be of further effect (except
as to surviving  rights of  registration  of transfer or  conversion of Exchange
Debentures, as expressly provided for in the Exchange Debenture Indenture) as to
all  outstanding  Exchange  Debentures  when (a) either (i) all of the  Exchange
Debentures  therefore  authenticated  and  delivered  (except  lost,  stolen  or
destroyed  Exchange  Debentures  which  have been  replaced  or paid)  have been
delivered to the Trustee for  cancellation  or (ii) all Exchange  Debentures not
theretofore  delivered to the Trustee for  cancellation  (x) have become due and
payable,  or (y) will become due and payable at their stated Maturity within one
year, or (z) are to be called for redemption within one year under  arrangements
satisfactory to the Trustee for the


                                      S-88
<PAGE>

giving of notice of redemption  by the Trustee in the name,  and at the expense,
of the  Company  and the  Company  has  irrevocably  deposited  or  caused to be
deposited  with the Trustee  funds in an amount  sufficient to pay and discharge
the entire  indebtedness on the Exchange  Debentures not therefore  delivered to
the Trustee for  cancellation,  including  principal  of,  premium,  if any, and
accrued interest at such stated Maturity or redemption date; (b) the Company has
paid or caused to be paid all other sums payable  under the  Exchange  Debenture
Indenture  by the Company;  and (c) the Company has  delivered to the Trustee an
officers'  certificate and an opinion of counsel stating that (i) all conditions
precedent under the Exchange  Debenture  Indenture  relating to the satisfaction
and discharge of the Exchange  Debenture  Indenture  have been complied with and
(ii) such  satisfaction  and discharge  will not result in a breach or violation
of, or constitute a default under, the Exchange Debenture Indenture or any other
material agreement or instrument to which the Company is a party or by which the
Company is bound.


PAYMENTS OF PRINCIPAL AND INTEREST

     The Exchange  Debenture  Indenture will require that payments in respect of
the Exchange  Debentures  (including  principal,  premium, if any, and interest)
held of record by DTC  (including  Exchange  Debentures  evidenced by the Global
Exchange  Debentures)  be made in same day  funds.  Payments  in  respect of the
Exchange  Debentures held of record by holders other than DTC may, at the option
of the  Company,  be made by check and mailed to such holders of record as shown
on the register for the Exchange Debentures.


GOVERNING LAW

     The Exchange Debenture  Indenture and Exchange  Debentures will be governed
by and construed in accordance  with the laws of the State of New York,  without
giving effect to such state's conflict of laws principles.


INFORMATION CONCERNING THE TRUSTEE

     The Exchange Debenture Indenture contains certain limitations on the rights
of the Trustee, should it become a creditor of the Company, to obtain payment of
claims in certain cases, or to realize on certain  property  received in respect
of any such claim as security or  otherwise.  The Trustee  will be  permitted to
engage in other transactions;  however, if it acquires any conflicting  interest
it must eliminate such conflict within ninety days,  apply to the Commission for
permission to continue or resign.

     The  holders  of a majority  in  principal  amount of the then  outstanding
Exchange  Debentures will have the right to direct the time, method and place of
conducting any  proceeding  for exercising any remedy  available to the Trustee,
subject to certain exceptions. The Exchange Debenture Indenture provides that in
case an Event of Default  shall occur  (which  shall not be cured),  the Trustee
will be required,  in the exercise of its power,  to use the degree of care of a
prudent man in the conduct of his own affairs.  Subject to such provisions,  the
Trustee  will be under no  obligation  to  exercise  any of its rights or powers
under the Exchange Debenture  Indentures at the request of any of the holders of
the Exchange Debentures,  unless they shall have offered to the Trustee security
and indemnity satisfactory to it against any loss, liability or expense.


OTHER PROVISIONS

     The Company is under no  obligation  to apply for  listing of the  Exchange
Debentures on any securities exchange or on any automated  interdealer quotation
system.  If the Company did apply for any such  listing,  there is no  assurance
that such  application  would be granted or that, if granted,  an active trading
market would  develop.  See "Risk Factors - Absence of Public Trading Market for
Certain Securities" in the accompanying Prospectus.


                                      S-89
<PAGE>

                              CERTAIN DEFINITIONS

     Set  forth  below  is a  summary  of  certain  terms  used in the  Exchange
Debenture Indenture and the Articles Supplementary:

     "Bank  Credit  Agreement"  means  the Third  Amended  and  Restated  Credit
Agreement,  dated as of May 20, 1997,  between the Company,  the Subsidiaries of
the  Company  identified  on the  signature  pages  thereof  under  the  caption
"Subsidiary  Guarantors," the lenders named therein and The Chase Manhattan Bank
as agent,  as such  agreement may be amended,  renewed,  extended,  substituted,
refinanced, restructured, replaced, supplemented or otherwise modified from time
to time (including,  without limitation,  any successive  renewals,  extensions,
substitutions, refinancings, restructurings,  replacements,  supplementations or
other  modifications  of the  foregoing).  For all purposes under the Indenture,
"Bank Credit  Agreement"  shall include any  amendments,  renewals,  extensions,
substitutions,  refinancings,  restructurings,  replacements, supplements or any
other  modifications  that increase the principal  amount of the Indebtedness or
the commitments to lend thereunder.

     "Designated  Senior  Debt" is defined as (i) all  Senior  Debt  outstanding
under the Bank Credit Agreement and (ii) any other Senior Debt which is incurred
pursuant  to an  agreement  (or  series of  related  agreements)  simultaneously
entered into  providing for  Indebtedness,  or  commitments to lend, of at least
$25,000,000 at the time of determination  and is specifically  designated in the
instrument  evidencing such Senior Debt or the agreement under which such Senior
Indebtedness arises as "Designated Senior Debt" by the Company.

     "Equity Interest" of any person means any and all shares, interests, rights
to  purchase,  warrants,  options,  participations  or other  equivalents  of or
interests   in   (however   designated)   corporate   stock  or   other   equity
participations,  including partnership interests, whether general or limited, of
such  Person,  including  an Equity  Interest  of any class or classes  (however
designated)  which is preferred as to the payment of dividends or distributions,
or  as  to  the  distribution  of  assets  upon  any  voluntary  or  involuntary
liquidation or dissolution  of such person,  over Equity  Interests of any other
class of such Person.

     "Existing  Indentures" means the indentures relating to the Existing Notes.

     "Existing  Notes" means the  Company's  10% Senior  Subordinated  Notes due
2003, the Company's 10% Senior Subordinated Notes due 2005, and the Company's 9%
Senior Subordinated Notes due 2007.

     "Film  Contract"  means  contracts  with suppliers that convey the right to
broadcast  specified films,  videotape motion  pictures,  syndicated  television
programs or sports or other programming.

     "Founders'  Notes"  means the term notes, dated September 30, 1990, made by
the  Company  to  Julian S.  Smith  and  to Carolyn C. Smith pursuant to a stock
redemption  agreement,  dated  June 19,  1990, among the Company, certain of its
Subsidiaries,  Julian S.  Smith,  Carolyn C. Smith, David D. Smith, Frederick G.
Smith, J. Duncan Smith and Robert E. Smith.

     "Guaranteed  Debt"  of  any  Persons  means,   without   duplication,   all
Indebtedness  of any other person  referred to in the definition of Indebtedness
contained in this section  guaranteed  directly or  indirectly  in any manner by
such  Person,  or in effect  guaranteed  directly or  indirectly  by such Person
through an agreement (i) to pay or purchase such  Indebtedness  or to advance or
supply funds for the payment or purchase of such Indebtedness, (ii) to purchase,
sell or lease (as lessee or lessor)  property,  or to purchase or sell services,
primarily  for the  purpose  of  enabling  the  debtor to make  payment  of such
Indebtedness or to assure the holder of such Indebtedness against loss, (iii) to
supply funds to, or in any other  manner  invest in, the debtor  (including  any
agreement to pay for property or services  without  requiring that such property
be received or such services be rendered),  (iv) to maintain  working capital or
equity capital of the debtor,  or otherwise to maintain the net worth,  solvency
or other financial condition of the debtor or (v) otherwise to assure a creditor
against loss; provided that the term "guarantee" shall not include  endorsements
for collection or deposit, in either case in the ordinary course of business.

     "Indebtedness" means, with respect to any Person, without duplication,  (i)
all indebtedness of such Person for borrowed money or for the deferred  purchase
price of property or services,  excluding  any trade  payables and other accrued
current liabilities arising in the ordinary course of business, but includ-


                                      S-90
<PAGE>

ing,  without  limitation,  all  obligations,  contingent or otherwise,  of such
Person in  connection  with any letters of credit  issued under letter of credit
facilities,  acceptance facilities or other similar facilities and in connection
with any agreement to purchase,  redeem, exchange,  convert or otherwise acquire
for value any  Equity  Interests  of such  Person,  or any  warrants,  rights or
options to acquire such Equity Interests, now or hereafter outstanding, (ii) all
obligations  of such  Person  evidenced  by bonds,  notes,  debentures  or other
similar  instruments,  (iii)  all  indebtedness  created  or  arising  under any
conditional  sale or other title  retention  agreement  with respect to property
acquired by such Person (even if the rights and remedies of the seller or lender
under such agreement in the event of default are limited to repossession or sale
of such property),  but excluding trade payables  arising in the ordinary course
of business, (iv) all obligations under Interest Rate Agreements of such Person,
(v) all capital lease obligations of such Person, (vi) all Indebtedness referred
to in clauses (i) through (v) above of other  Persons and all dividends of other
Persons,  the  payment  of which is  secured by (or for which the holder of such
Indebtedness has an existing right,  contingent or otherwise,  to be secured by)
any lien,  upon or with  respect to  property  (including,  without  limitation,
accounts and contract rights) owned by such Person,  even though such Person has
not  assumed or become  liable for the payment of such  Indebtedness,  (vii) all
Guaranteed Debt of such Person,  (viii) all Disqualified Equity Interests valued
at the greater of their voluntary or involuntary  maximum fixed repurchase price
plus  accrued  and  unpaid  dividends,  and  (ix)  any  amendment,   supplement,
modification,  deferral,  renewal,  extension,  refunding or  refinancing of any
liability  of the  types  referred  to in  clauses  (i)  through  (viii)  above;
provided,  however, that the term Indebtedness shall not include any obligations
of the Company and its Subsidiaries  with respect to Film Contracts entered into
in the ordinary course of business.

     "Interest Rate  Agreements"  means one or more of the following  agreements
which  shall  be  entered  into  from  time to  time  by one or  more  financial
institutions:   interest  rate   protection   agreements   (including,   without
limitation,  interest rate swaps, caps, floors,  collars and similar agreements)
and any obligations in respect of any Hedging Agreement,  as defined in the Bank
Credit Agreement.

     "Maturity,"  when used with  respect to any Exchange  Debenture,  means the
date on which the principal of such Exchange  Debenture  becomes due and payable
as provided in the Exchange  Debenture or as provided in the Exchange  Debenture
Indenture,  whether at stated  Maturity,  the offer date, or the redemption date
and whether by declaration of acceleration, offer in respect of excess proceeds,
Change of Control, call for redemption or otherwise.

     "Person"  means  any  individual,  corporate,  limited  liability  company,
partnership,   joint   venture,   association,   joint-stock   company,   trust,
unincorporated   organization   or   government   or  any  agency  or  political
subdivisions thereof.

     "Restricted  Subsidiary"  means a  Subsidiary  subject to the  covenants or
events of default  under the  agreements  governing  other  indebtedness  of the
Company.

     "Senior  Subordinated  Indebtedness" means the Existing Notes and all other
Indebtedness ranking pari passu in right of payment with the Existing Notes.

     "Senior Debt" is defined as the principal of, premium, if any, and interest
(including  interest  accruing  after the  filing of a petition  initiating  any
proceeding under any state,  federal or foreign  bankruptcy law, whether or note
allowable  as a claim in such  proceeding)  on any  Indebtedness  of the Company
(other than as otherwise  provided in this definition),  whether  outstanding on
the date of the Exchange Debenture Indenture or thereafter created,  incurred or
assumed, and whether at any time owing, actually or contingently, unless, in the
case of any particular  Indebtedness,  the instrument creating or evidencing the
same or pursuant to which the same is outstanding  expressly  provides that such
Indebtedness shall not be senior in right of payment to the Exchange Debentures.
Without  limiting the generality of the  foregoing,  "Senior Debt" shall include
(i) the principal of, premium, if any, and interest (including interest accruing
after the  filing of a  petition  initiating  any  proceeding  under any  state,
federal or foreign  bankruptcy law,  whether or not allowable as a claim in such
proceeding)  and all other  obligations of every nature of the Company from time
to time owed to the lenders (or their  agent)  under the Bank Credit  Agreement;
provided,  however,  that any Indebtedness  under any refinancing,  refunding or
replacement of the Bank Credit Agreement shall not constitute Senior Debt to the
extent that the Indebt-


                                      S-91
<PAGE>

edness thereunder is by its express terms subordinate to any other  Indebtedness
of the Company,  (ii) Indebtedness  outstanding under the Founders' Notes, (iii)
existing and future  Senior  Subordinated  Indebtedness  of the Company and (iv)
Indebtedness  under  Interest Rate  Agreements.  Notwithstanding  the foregoing,
"Senior  Debt" shall not  include (i)  Indebtedness  evidenced  by the  Exchange
Debentures,  (ii)  Indebtedness  which when incurred and without  respect to any
election  under  Section  1111(b)  of Title 11 United  States  Code,  is without
recourse to the Company, (iii) Indebtedness which is represented by Disqualified
Equity Interests, (iv) any liability for foreign, federal, state, local or other
taxes  owed or owing by the  Company,  (v)  Indebtedness  of the  Company to the
extent such  liability  constitutes  Indebtedness  to a subsidiary  or any other
affiliate  of the  Company  or any of such  affiliate's  subsidiaries,  and (vi)
Indebtedness owed by the Company for compensation to employees or for services.

     "Subsidiary"  means any Person a majority  of the equity  ownership  or the
voting  stock of which is at the time  owned,  directly  or  indirectly,  by the
Company or by one or more other Subsidiaries,  or by the Company and one or more
other Subsidiaries.

     "Voting  Stock"  means stock of the class or classes  pursuant to which the
holders  thereof have the general voting power under ordinary  circumstances  to
elect at least a majority of the board of  directors,  managers or trustees of a
corporation (irrespective of whether or not at the time stock of any other class
or classes  shall have or might have voting power by reason of the  happening of
any contingency).

                                      S-92
<PAGE>

                    DESCRIPTION OF INDEBTEDNESS OF SINCLAIR

BANK CREDIT AGREEMENT

     On May  20,  1997,  the  Company  amended  and  restated  the  Bank  Credit
Agreement.  The terms of the Bank Credit  Agreement  as amended and restated are
summarized  below.  The  summary set forth below does not purport to be complete
and is qualified in its  entirety by  reference  to the  provisions  of the Bank
Credit Agreement.  A copy of the Bank Credit Agreement is available upon request
from the Company. In addition,  not all indebtedness of the Company is described
below, only that incurred in connection with the Existing Notes and indebtedness
that has been incurred  since May 20, 1997. The terms of other  indebtedness  of
the Company  are set forth in other  documents  previously  filed by the Company
with the Commission. See "Available Information."

     The Company entered into the Bank Credit Agreement with the Banks. The Bank
Credit  Agreement  is comprised of two  components,  consisting  of (i) the $400
million  Revolving  Credit  Facility  and (ii) the $600  million  Term Loan.  An
additional  term loan in the amount of $400  million is available to the Company
under the Bank Credit Agreement.  The Company has borrowed no funds with respect
to this additional term loan. Beginning March 31, 2000, the commitment under the
Revolving  Credit Facility is subject to mandatory  quarterly  reductions to the
following  percentages of the initial amount: 90% at December 31, 2000, 69.2% at
December 31, 2001, 48.4% at December 31, 2002, 27.5% at December 31, 2003 and 0%
at December 31,  2004.  The Term Loan is required to be repaid by the Company in
equal quarterly  installments beginning on September 30, 1997 with the quarterly
payment  escalating  annually  through the final  maturity  date of December 31,
2004.

     Concurrently  with  the  Common  Stock  Offering  and the  Preferred  Stock
Offering,  the Company has  requested  that the Banks approve a reduction in the
$600 million Term Loan by $275 million (to $325  million) and an increase in the
$400 million Revolving Credit Facility by $275 million (to $675 million). If the
Banks approve the Company's request,  the commitments under the Revolving Credit
Facility, as increased, will be subject to mandatory quarterly reductions to the
following percentages of the increased amount: 97.7% at December 31, 1997, 93.3%
at December  31, 1998,  88.6% at December 31, 1999,  76.6% at December 31, 2000,
58.1% at December 31, 2004.  The Term Loan,  as amended,  will be required to be
repaid by the Company in equal quarterly  installments  beginning  September 30,
1997 with the quarterly payments  escalating annually through the final maturity
date of December 31, 2004.

     The  Company  is  entitled  to prepay  the  outstanding  amounts  under the
Revolving  Credit  Facility  and the Term Loan  subject  to  certain  prepayment
conditions  and  certain  notice  provisions  at any time and from time to time.
Partial  prepayments  of the  Term  Loan are  applied  in the  inverse  order of
maturity to the  outstanding  loans on a pro rata basis.  Prepaid amounts of the
Term Loan may not be reborrowed.  In addition, the Company is required to pay an
amount equal to (i) 100% of the net proceeds from the sale of assets (other than
in the ordinary  course of business)  not used within 270 days,  (ii)  insurance
recoveries and condemnation proceeds not used for permitted uses within 270 days
(iii) 80% of net Equity Issuance (as defined in the Bank Credit Agreement),  net
of prior  approved  uses and certain other  exclusions  not used within 270 days
unless the Company has a contract to reinvest the proceeds within 90 days of the
270 days, and (iv) 50% of Excess Cash Flow so long as Total Debt/Adjusted EBITDA
(each as defined in the Bank Credit Agreement) is greater than or equal to 5.0x,
to the Banks for application  first to prepay the Term Loan, pro rata in inverse
order of maturity,  and then to prepay  outstanding  amounts under the Revolving
Credit Facility with a corresponding reduction in commitment.

     In addition to the Revolving  Credit Facility and the Term Loans,  the Bank
Credit Agreement provides that the Banks may, but are not obligated to, loan the
Company up to an additional $400 million at any time prior to September 29, 1998
(the  "Incremental  Facility").  This additional loan, if agreed to by the Agent
and a majority of the Banks,  would be in the form of a senior  secured  standby
multiple draw term loan. The Incremental Facility would be available to fund the
acquisition  of WSYX and certain  other  acquisitions  and would be repayable in
equal quarterly  installments  beginning  September 30, 1998, with the quarterly
payment  escalating  annually  through the final  maturity  date of December 30,
2004.

     The Company's  obligations under the Bank Credit Agreement are secured by a
pledge of substantially all of the Company's assets,  including the stock of all
of the Company's  subsidiaries  other than KDSM, Inc., KDSM Licensee,  Inc., the
Trust and Cresap Enterprises, Inc. The subsidiaries of the Company (other than


                                      S-93
<PAGE>

KDSM, Inc., KDSM Licensee, Inc., Cresap Enterprises, Inc. and the Trust) as well
as  Gerstell  Development   Corporation,   Keyser  Investment  Group,  Inc.  and
Cunningham Communications (each a "Stockholder Affiliate"),  have guaranteed the
obligations of the Company. In addition,  all subsidiaries of the Company (other
than Cresap  Enterprises,  Inc., KDSM, Inc., KDSM Licensee,  Inc. and the Trust)
have pledged,  to the extent  permitted by law, all of their assets to the Banks
and  Gerstell  Development  Corporation,   Keyser  Investment  Group,  Inc.  and
Cunningham Communications have pledged certain real property to the Banks.

     The Company has caused the FCC license for each television  station (to the
extent such license has been  transferred  or acquired) or the option to acquire
such licenses to be held in a  single-purpose  entity  utilized  solely for such
purpose (the "TV License  Subsidiaries")  with the  exception of the options for
WTTV  and  WTTK in the  Indianapolis  DMA,  both of  which  are held by a single
entity.  The TV License  Subsidiaries are in all instances owned by wholly-owned
indirect subsidiaries of the Company.  Additionally,  the Company has caused the
FCC  licenses of the radio  stations in each local market to be held by a single
purpose   entity   utilized   solely  for  that  purpose  (the  "Radio   License
Subsidiaries").  The Radio License  Subsidiaries  are in all instances  owned by
wholly-owned indirect subsidiaries of the Company.

     Interest on amounts drawn under the Bank Credit Agreement is, at the option
of Company, equal to (i) the London Interbank Offered Rate plus a margin of .50%
to 1.875% for the Revolving Credit Facility and 2.75% for the Term Loan, or (ii)
the Base Rate,  which equals the higher of the Federal Funds Rate plus 1/2 of 1%
or the  Prime  Rate of Chase,  plus a margin of zero to .625% for the  Revolving
Credit  Facility and the Term Loan.  The Company  must  maintain  interest  rate
hedging  arrangements or instruments for at least 60% of the principal amount of
the facilities until May 20, 1999.

     The Bank Credit Agreement contains a number of covenants which restrict the
operations  of the Company and its  subsidiaries,  including the ability to: (i)
merge, consolidate,  acquire or sell assets; (ii) create additional indebtedness
or liens;  (iii) pay dividends on the Parent Preferred;  (iv) enter into certain
arrangements  with or investments in affiliates;  and (v) change the business or
ownership of the Company.  The Company and its  subsidiaries are also prohibited
under the Bank  Credit  Agreement  from  incurring  obligations  relating to the
acquisition  of  programming  if,  as a  result  of such  acquisition,  the cash
payments  on such  programming  exceed  specified  amounts set forth in the Bank
Credit Agreement.

     In addition, the Company must comply with certain other financial covenants
in the Bank Credit Agreement which include:  (i) Fixed Charges Ratio (as defined
in the Bank  Credit  Agreement)  of no less  than  1.05 to 1 at any  time;  (ii)
Interest  Coverage  Ratio (as defined in the Bank Credit  Agreement)  of no less
than 1.8 to 1 from the Restatement Effective Date (as defined in the Bank Credit
Agreement)  to December  30, 1998 and  increasing  each fiscal year to 2.20 to 1
from December 31, 2000 and thereafter; and (iii) a Senior Indebtedness Ratio (as
defined  in the  Bank  Credit  Agreement)  of no  greater  than  5.0x  from  the
Restatement  Effective  Date  declining  to 4.0x by December 31, 2001 and at all
times  thereafter  and (iv) a Total  Indebtedness  Ratio (as defined in the Bank
Credit  Agreement) of no greater than 6.75 to 1 from the  Restatement  Effective
Date declining to 4.00 to 1 by December 31, 2001 and at all times thereafter.

     The  Events of  Default  under the Bank  Credit  Agreement  include,  among
others:  (i) the failure to pay  principal,  interest or other amounts when due;
(ii) the making of untrue  representations and warranties in connection with the
Bank Credit Agreement; (iii) a default by the Company or the subsidiaries in the
performance  of its  obligations  under the Bank  Credit  Agreement  or  certain
related security documents; (iv) certain events of insolvency or bankruptcy, (v)
the   rendering  of  certain  money   judgments   against  the  Company  or  its
subsidiaries;  (vi) the  incurrence  of certain  liabilities  to  certain  plans
governed by the Employee  Retirement Income Security Act of 1974; (vii) a change
of control or ownership of the Company or its subsidiaries;  (viii) the security
documents being terminated and ceasing to be in full force and effect;  (ix) any
broadcast  license  (other  than  a  non-material   license)  being  terminated,
forfeited or revoked or failing to be renewed for any reason  whatsoever  or for
any  reason a  subsidiary  shall at any time  cease to be a  licensee  under any
broadcast license (other than a non-material  broadcast license); (x) any LMA or
options to acquire  License Assets being  terminated for any reason  whatsoever;
(xi) any amendment, modification,  supplement or waiver of the provisions of the
Indenture without the prior written consent of the majority lenders; and (xii) a
payment default on any other indebtedness of the Company if the principal amount
of such indebtedness exceeds $5 million.


                                      S-94
<PAGE>

DESCRIPTION OF EXISTING NOTES UNDER EXISTING INDENTURES

     The existing notes were issued under  indentures  dated December 9, 1993 as
amended,  modified or supplemented  from time to time (the "1993 Indenture") and
August 28, 1995 (the "1995 Indenture" and July 2, 1997 (the "1997 Indenture" and
as amended,  modified,  or supplemented from time to time together with the 1993
Indenture and the 1995 Indenture,  the "Existing  Indentures").  Pursuant to the
terms of the Existing Indentures, the Existing Notes are guaranteed, jointly and
severally,  on a senior subordinated unsecured basis by all of the Subsidiaries,
except Cresap Enterprises, Inc., KDSM, Inc., KDSM Licensee, Inc.
and the Trust.

     The 1993 Notes  mature on  December  15,  2003,  the 1995  Notes  mature on
September 30, 2005 and the 1997 Notes mature on July 15, 2007, and are unsecured
senior subordinated  obligations of the Company.  The 1993 Indenture limited the
aggregate  principal  amount  of the 1993  Notes  to  $200.0  million,  the 1995
Indenture  limited the  aggregate  principal  amount of the 1995 Notes to $300.0
million and the 1997  Indenture  limited the aggregate  principal  amount of the
1997 Notes to $200.0  million.  The 1993 Notes bear  interest at the rate of 10%
per annum  payable  semi-annually  on June 15 and December 15 of each year,  the
1995 Notes bear  interest at a rate of 10% per annum  payable  semi-annually  on
September  30 and March 30 of each year and the 1997  Notes bear  interest  at a
rate of 9% per annum  payable  semi-annually  on  January 15 and July 15 of each
year.

     The Company  issued  $200.0  million of the 1993 Notes on December 9, 1993.
$100.0 million of these Notes were subsequently redeemed by the Company in March
1994 with  proceeds  from the sale of the original 1993 Notes that had been held
in escrow pending their expected use in connection with certain  acquisitions of
the Company that were instead  financed  through  drawings under the Bank Credit
Agreement.  As of the date  hereof,  $100.0  million  of the 1993  Notes  remain
outstanding.  The Company  issued $300.0 million of the 1995 Notes on August 28,
1995. As of the date hereof, $300.0 million of the 1995 Notes remain outstanding
and $200.0 million of the 1997 Notes remain outstanding.

     The 1993 Notes are  redeemable in whole or in part prior to maturity at the
option of the Company on or after December 15, 1998 at certain redemption prices
specified in the 1993  Indenture.  The 1995 Notes are  redeemable in whole or in
part prior to maturity at the option of the  Company on or after  September  30,
2000 at certain  redemption  prices  specified in the 1995  Indenture.  The 1997
Notes are  redeemable in whole or in part prior to maturity at the option of the
Company on or after July 15, 2002 at certain  redemption prices specified in the
1997 Indenture.

     The Existing  Notes are general  unsecured  obligations  of the Company and
subordinated in right of payment to all Senior  Indebtedness  (as defined in the
Existing  Indentures),  including all indebtedness of the Company under the Bank
Credit Agreement.

     Upon a change of control  (as  defined in the  Existing  Indentures),  each
holder of the  Existing  Notes  will have the right to  require  the  Company to
repurchase  such  holder's  Existing  Notes  at a  price  equal  to  101% of the
principal amount plus accrued interest through the date of repurchase.  A Change
of  Control  will also  result  in an event of  default  under  the Bank  Credit
Agreement and could result in an acceleration of the indebtedness under the Bank
Credit  Agreement.  See  "Description  of Indebtedness of Sinclair - Bank Credit
Agreement."  In addition,  the Company will be obligated to offer to  repurchase
Existing Notes at 100% of their principal  amount plus accrued  interest through
the date of repurchase in the event of certain asset sales.

     The Existing  Indentures include covenants that impose certain  limitations
on the ability of the Company and its Subsidiaries to, among other things, incur
additional  indebtedness,  pay  dividends,  or  make  certain  other  restricted
payments,  consummate certain asset sales, enter into certain  transactions with
affiliates,  incur  indebtedness  that is subordinate in right to the payment of
any senior  debt and senior in right of payment  to the  Existing  Notes,  incur
liens,  impose restrictions on the ability of the subsidiary to pay dividends or
make any payments to the Company,  or merge or consolidate with any other person
or sell,  assign,  transfer,  lease,  convey,  or  otherwise  dispose  of all or
substantially all of the assets of the Company.  See "Risk  Factors-Restrictions
Imposed by Terms of Indebtedness" in the accompanying Prospectus.


                                      S-95
<PAGE>

                   CERTAIN FEDERAL INCOME TAX CONSIDERATIONS

     The  following   summary   describes  the  material   federal   income  tax
consequences of the purchase, ownership, conversion, redemption, and disposition
of the Convertible  Exchangeable  Preferred  Stock and the Exchange  Debentures.
This summary is based upon the provisions of the Internal  Revenue Code of 1986,
as  amended  (the  "Code"),  the  final,   temporary  and  proposed  regulations
promulgated  thereunder and administrative rulings and judicial decisions now in
effect,  all of which are subject to change (possibly with retroactive  effect).
This summary  addresses only the tax  consequences  of the purchase,  ownership,
conversion, redemption and disposition of the Convertible Exchangeable Preferred
Stock and the  Exchange  Debentures  by a person  who is (i) for  United  States
federal  income  tax  purposes  a  citizen  or  resident  of the  United  States
(including  certain  former  citizens and former  long-term  residents),  (ii) a
corporation,  partnership  or other entity  created or organized in or under the
laws of the United States or of any political  subdivision  thereof (except,  to
the extent, in the case of a partnership,  the partnership is treated as foreign
under  regulations),  (iii) an estate  the  income of which is subject to United
States  federal  income  taxation  regardless of its source or (iv) a trust with
respect to the  administration of which a court within the United States is able
to exercise primary  supervision and one or more United States  fiduciaries have
the authority to control all  substantial  decisions of the trust.  This summary
does not purport to deal with all aspects of federal income taxation that may be
relevant to an  investor's  decision to purchase  the  Convertible  Exchangeable
Preferred  Stock,  such as  foreign,  state and  local,  or estate  and gift tax
consequences,  and it is not  intended to be  applicable  to all  categories  of
investors, some of which, such as dealers in securities, financial institutions,
insurance  companies,  tax-exempt  organizations  and  foreign  persons,  may be
subject to special rules.

     In  addition,  the  summary is (i) limited to initial  purchasers  who will
acquire the  Convertible  Exchangeable  Preferred Stock pursuant to the Offering
made by this  Prospectus  Supplement  and any  Exchange  Debentures  received in
exchange therefor, and (ii) assumes that the Convertible  Exchangeable Preferred
Stock  and  Exchange  Debentures  will  be held as  capital  assets  (generally,
property  held for  investment  within the meaning of Section 1221 of the Code).
Holders  should note that there can be no assurance  that the  Internal  Revenue
Service  ("IRS") will take a similar  view with respect to the tax  consequences
described  below and that no ruling has been or will be requested by the Company
from  the  IRS on any  tax  matters  relating  to the  Convertible  Exchangeable
Preferred Stock or Exchange  Debentures.  ALL PROSPECTIVE HOLDERS OF CONVERTIBLE
EXCHANGEABLE PREFERRED STOCK OR EXCHANGE DEBENTURES ARE ADVISED TO CONSULT THEIR
OWN  TAX  ADVISORS  REGARDING  THE  FEDERAL,   STATE,  LOCAL,  AND  FOREIGN  TAX
CONSEQUENCES OF THE PURCHASE, OWNERSHIP, CONVERSION, REDEMPTION, AND DISPOSITION
OF CONVERTIBLE EXCHANGEABLE PREFERRED STOCK OR EXCHANGE DEBENTURES.


DIVIDENDS AND OTHER DISTRIBUTIONS

     Distributions  on the  Convertible  Exchangeable  Preferred  Stock  will be
taxable as ordinary income to the extent of the Company's current or accumulated
earnings  and  profits,  as  determined  for federal  income tax  purposes.  Any
distribution  in excess of current or  accumulated  earnings and profits will be
treated first as a nontaxable  return of capital reducing the holder's tax basis
in the Convertible  Exchangeable  Preferred Stock. Any distribution in excess of
the  holder's  basis in the  Convertible  Exchangeable  Preferred  Stock will be
treated as a capital gain.

     Dividends  received  by  corporate  holders  of  Convertible   Exchangeable
Preferred  Stock will qualify for the 70%  dividends  received  deduction  under
Section 243 of the Code if the holding  period and other  requirements  for such
deduction  are met,  subject to the  limitations  in Section 246 and 246A of the
Code  (although the benefits of the  deductions  may be reduced or eliminated by
the corporate alternative minimum tax). Under Section 246(c) of the Code the 70%
dividends  received  deduction is  disallowed  for any dividend  with respect to
stock (i) that is held for 45 days or less during the 90 day period beginning 45
days before the ex-dividend  date (or held 90 days or less in the 180 day period
beginning 90 days before the ex-dividend date in the case of a dividend on stock
having  preference in dividends  which are  attributable  to a period or periods
aggregating more than 366 days), or (ii) if the taxpayer is under


                                      S-96
<PAGE>

an   obligation   to  make  related   payments  with  respect  to  positions  in
substantially  similar or related property.  In addition,  a taxpayer's  holding
period for these  purposes is suspended  during any period in which the taxpayer
has an option to sell, is under a contractual  obligation to sell, has made (and
not  closed) a short  sale of, or has  granted  an option to buy,  substantially
identical  stock or  securities,  or holds one or more positions with respect to
substantially  similar or related  property  that diminish the risk of loss from
holding  the stock.  Finally,  under  Section  246A of the Code,  the  dividends
received  deduction may be reduced or eliminated if a corporate  holder's shares
of Convertible Exchangeable Preferred Stock are debt financed.

     Section  1059 of the Code  requires a  corporate  holder of stock to reduce
(but not below  zero) its basis in the stock by the  "nontaxed  portion"  of any
"extraordinary  dividend" if the holder has not held the stock subject to a risk
of loss for more than 2 years before the date of the announcement,  declaration,
or agreement (whichever is earliest) with respect to the extraordinary  dividend
or if the  distribution  occurs in the  context of a  redemption,  as  discussed
below.

     A holder will  recognize  gain in the year the  dividend is received to the
extent the nontaxed portion of any  extraordinary  dividend exceeds the holder's
adjusted  tax basis for the  stock.  Generally,  the  "nontaxed  portion"  of an
extraordinary  dividend is the amount  excluded from income under Section 243 of
the Code (relating to the dividends  received  deduction  described  above).  An
"extraordinary  dividend"  is a  dividend  that (i)  equals or exceeds 5% of the
holder's  adjusted  tax  basis in the stock  (reduced  for this  purpose  by the
nontaxed portion of any prior  extraordinary  dividend),  treating all dividends
having  ex-dividend  dates  within an 85-day  period  as one  dividend,  or (ii)
exceeds  20% of the  holder's  adjusted  tax basis in the  stock,  treating  all
dividends  having  ex-dividend  dates within a 365-day  period as one  dividend,
provided, however, that in either case the fair market value of the stock (as of
the day before the  ex-dividend  date) may be substituted for stock basis if the
fair  market  value  of the  stock  can be  established  by  the  holder  to the
satisfaction of the IRS.

     An  extraordinary  dividend  would also  include  any  amount  treated as a
dividend in the case of a  redemption  (including  an  exchange  of  Convertible
Exchangeable  Preferred  Stock for Exchange  Debentures)  that is either non-pro
rata as to all stockholders or in partial liquidation of the Company, regardless
of the relative size of the dividend and  regardless  of the corporate  holder's
holding period for the Convertible  Exchangeable  Preferred  Stock. In addition,
"extraordinary  dividend"  treatment  will result  without  regard to the period
stock is held if a  redemption  is treated  as a  dividend  by reason of options
being taken into  account  under  Section  318(a)(4) of the Code.  Thus,  if, as
discussed  below, the exchange of Convertible  Exchangeable  Preferred Stock for
Exchange  Debentures  is  treated as a  dividend,  any such  dividend  may be an
extraordinary dividend to corporate holders.

     Special rules overriding the general application of Code Section 1059 apply
with respect to "qualified preferred  dividends," which are defined as any fixed
dividends paid on stock that provide for a fixed  preferred  dividend to be paid
not less  frequently  than  annually,  provided that no such  dividends  were in
arrears at the time the holder acquired the stock.  Where a qualified  preferred
dividend  exceeds the 5% or 20% limitations  described above, it will be treated
as an extraordinary  dividend only if (i) the actual rate of return on the stock
for the  period  the stock has been held by the holder  receiving  the  dividend
exceeds  15%,  or (ii) such rate of return  does not  exceed  15% and the holder
disposes of such stock before  holding it, subject to risk of loss, for 5 years.
In the latter case, however, the amount treated as an extraordinary  dividend is
generally  limited to the excess of the  actual  rate of return  over the stated
rate of return. For purposes of determining the actual or stated rate of return,
a holder should  compare the actual or stated annual  dividends to the lesser of
(a) the  holder's  adjusted  tax basis  for the  stock,  or (b) the  liquidation
preference  of the stock.  The length of time that a taxpayer  is deemed to have
held  stock  for  purposes  of  Section  1059 of the  Code is  determined  under
principles  similar to those contained in Section 246(c) of the Code,  described
above.


REDEMPTION PREMIUM

     Under Section 305(c) of the Code and applicable  Treasury  Regulations,  if
the Convertible  Exchangeable  Preferred  Stock is redeemable at a premium,  the
entire  premium  may be taxable  as a  constructive  distribution  to the holder
(treated as a dividend, a non-taxable return of capital, or capital


                                      S-97
<PAGE>

gain pursuant to the rules  summarized  above under the caption  "Dividends  and
Other  Distributions").  Holders would be required to recognize such  redemption
premium  before  payment is actually  received  under a constant  interest  rate
method similar to that described below for accruing original issue discount.

     The Company does not intend to treat the Convertible Exchangeable Preferred
Stock as having such a redemption premium reportable under the constant interest
rate method because the Company believes that there are no plans,  arrangements,
or agreements that effectively require or are intended to compel it to redeem or
exchange the Convertible  Exchangeable Preferred Stock. Were the IRS to disagree
with  the  Company's  conclusion,  holders  could  be  required  to  report  any
redemption premium as described above. Moreover,  holders who are related to the
Company  within the meaning of  Treasury  regulations  under  Section 305 may be
subject to different rules.


SALE, REDEMPTION, OR EXCHANGE OF CONVERTIBLE EXCHANGEABLE PREFERRED STOCK

Sale

     On the sale of shares of Convertible  Exchangeable Preferred Stock, gain or
loss will be  recognized  by the  holder in an  amount  equal to the  difference
between (i) the amount of cash and fair market value of any property received on
such sale (less any portion thereof attributable to accumulated and declared but
unpaid  dividends,  which will be  taxable  as a  dividend  to the extent of the
Company's  current or accumulated  earnings and profits),  and (ii) the holder's
adjusted tax basis in the Convertible Exchangeable Preferred Stock. Such gain or
loss will be  capital  gain or loss if the  shares of  Convertible  Exchangeable
Preferred Stock are held as capital  assets.  For certain  noncorporate  holders
(including individuals),  the rate of taxation of capital gains will depend upon
(i) the holder's holding period for the Convertible Exchangeable Preferred Stock
(with the lowest rate  available  only for  Convertible  Exchangeable  Preferred
Stock  held more than 18 months)  and (ii) the  holder's  marginal  tax rate for
ordinary  income.  Holders of Convertible  Exchangeable  Preferred  Stock should
consult their tax advisors with respect to applicable rates and holding periods,
and netting rules for capital losses.

Redemption

     A redemption of shares of Convertible  Exchangeable Preferred Stock will be
treated  under  Section  302 of the Code as a  distribution  that is  taxable at
ordinary  income tax rates as a dividend,  a non-taxable  return of capital,  or
capital  gain,  pursuant  to  the  rules  summarized  above  under  the  caption
"Dividends  and Other  Distributions"  unless the redemption  satisfies  certain
tests set forth in Section 302(b) of the Code, in which case the redemption will
be treated  as a sale or  exchange  of the  Convertible  Exchangeable  Preferred
Stock, the tax treatment of which is described in the preceding  paragraph.  The
redemption will have satisfied such tests under Section 302(b) of the Code if it
(i) is "substantially disproportionate" with respect to the holder, (ii) results
in a "complete  termination"  of the holder's stock interest in the company,  or
(iii) is "not essentially  equivalent to a dividend" with respect to the holder.
A distribution to a holder is "not  essentially  equivalent to a dividend" if it
results in a "meaningful  reduction" in such holder's  proportionate interest in
the Company.  If, as a result of the redemption of the Convertible  Exchangeable
Preferred  Stock,  a holder,  whose  relative  stock  interest in the Company is
minimal and who  exercises  no control over  corporate  affairs,  experiences  a
reduction  in his  proportionate  interest in the Company  (taking  into account
shares deemed owned by the holder under Sections 302(c) and 318 of the Code and,
in certain events,  dispositions of stock which occur contemporaneously with the
redemption), then, based upon published IRS rulings, such holder may be regarded
as having  suffered a meaningful  reduction  in his interest in the Company.  In
determining  whether any of these tests has been met,  shares  considered  to be
owned by the holder by reason of certain constructive  ownership rules set forth
in Sections 302(c) and 318 of the Code, as well as shares  actually owned,  must
generally be taken into account.  Because the determination as to whether any of
the  alternative  tests of  Section  302(b) of the Code will be  satisfied  with
respect to any particular  holder of Convertible  Exchangeable  Preferred  Stock
depends on the facts and circumstances at the time that the  determination  must
be made,  prospective investors are advised to consult their own tax advisors to
determine such tax treatment.


                                      S-98
<PAGE>

     If a redemption of the Convertible  Exchangeable Preferred Stock is treated
as a distribution that is taxable as a dividend,  the amount of the distribution
will be  measured  by the amount of cash and the fair  market  value of property
received  by the  holder  without  any  offset  for the  holder's  basis  in the
Convertible Exchangeable Preferred Stock. The holder's adjusted tax basis in the
redeemed Convertible  Exchangeable Preferred Stock will be transferred to any of
the holder's  remaining stock holdings in the Company.  If, however,  the holder
has no remaining stock holdings in the Company, such basis could be lost.

     Any  redemption of the  Convertible  Exchangeable  Preferred  Stock that is
treated as a dividend and that is non-pro rata as to all stockholders, including
holders of Class A Common Stock, will be subject to the "extraordinary dividend"
provisions of Code Section 1059 discussed above under the caption "Dividends and
Other Distributions."

Exchange of Convertible Exchangeable Preferred Stock for Exchange Debentures

     An  exchange  of  Convertible  Exchangeable  Preferred  Stock for  Exchange
Debentures  will be a taxable  event for federal  income tax  purposes.  For the
reasons set forth below, it is unclear  whether,  standing  alone,  the exchange
would be treated as a sale or exchange of the Convertible Exchangeable Preferred
Stock or would be taxable as a  dividend.  This is so because an exchange of the
Convertible  Exchangeable  Preferred  Stock will be subject to the same  general
rules as a redemption for cash or property.  However, since a holder of Exchange
Debentures will be treated under the constructive ownership rules of the Code as
owning  the  Class A  Common  Stock  into  which  the  Exchange  Debentures  are
convertible,  in  applying  Section  302  of  the  Code,  a  redemption  of  the
Convertible  Exchangeable  Preferred Stock may not, standing alone,  satisfy the
"complete  termination" or the  "substantially  disproportionate"  tests of Code
Section 302(b), as described above. Such a redemption may, therefore, be taxable
as a dividend to the extent of the Company's current or accumulated earnings and
profits,  unless, based on all the facts and circumstances,  it satisfies either
the  "not  essentially  equivalent  to a  dividend"  test or  unless  any of the
foregoing  tests could  otherwise be satisfied.  Although the Company intends to
take the position that the redemption of the Convertible  Exchangeable Preferred
Stock for  Exchange  Debentures  is a sale or exchange  for  federal  income tax
purposes that is "not essentially equivalent to a dividend," no assurance can be
given that an exchange of Convertible  Exchangeable Preferred Stock for Exchange
Debentures  will be  treated  as a sale  or  exchange  for  federal  income  tax
purposes.  Based on  published  rulings,  a holder who does not desire  dividend
treatment  and who sells or otherwise  disposes of a portion of the  Convertible
Exchangeable  Preferred  Stock  or  Exchange  Debentures  to  unrelated  parties
substantially   contemporaneously   with  the   exchange   of  the   Convertible
Exchangeable Preferred Stock for Exchange Debentures may increase the likelihood
of satisfying  one or more of the foregoing  tests.  Prospective  holders should
consult their tax advisors as to whether dividend  treatment might apply to them
on  an  exchange  of  Convertible  Exchangeable  Preferred  Stock  for  Exchange
Debentures.

     If any of the  foregoing  tests under  Section 302 of the Code are met, the
exchange of shares of  Convertible  Exchangeable  Preferred  Stock for  Exchange
Debentures  will result in taxable gain or loss based on the difference  between
(i) the  issue  price of the  Exchange  Debentures  (less  any  portion  thereof
attributable  to accumulated  and declared but unpaid  dividends,  which will be
taxable as a  dividend  to the extent of the  Company's  current or  accumulated
earnings  and  profits)  and  (ii)  the  holder's  adjusted  tax  basis  in  the
Convertible  Exchangeable  Preferred  Stock  surrendered  in the  exchange.  The
determination  of the issue price of the Exchange  Debentures is discussed below
under the caption "Original Issue Discount."

     If an exchange of the Convertible Exchangeable Preferred Stock for Exchange
Debentures  is treated as a  distribution  that is  taxable as a  dividend,  the
amount of the  distribution  will be measured by the issue price of the Exchange
Debentures  received by the holder. Any amount so treated as a dividend will, in
most  circumstances,  be subject to the "extraordinary  dividend"  provisions of
Code Section 1059  applicable  to corporate  holders,  which is discussed  above
under the  caption  "Dividends  and Other  Distributions."  To the  extent  that
dividend  treatment results from the exchange,  a holder's adjusted tax basis in
the exchanged  Convertible  Exchangeable  Preferred Stock will be transferred to
such holder's  remaining stock holdings,  if any, in the Company.  If the holder
does not retain any stock  ownership in the Company,  such holder's basis may be
transferred to any shares owned by a related person or to any


                                      S-99
<PAGE>

Exchange  Debentures  received in the exchange (although some uncertainty exists
with  respect  to the  holder's  ability  to apply  such  basis to the  Exchange
Debentures)  or the  holder  may lose  such  basis  entirely.  If such  basis is
transferred  to the  Exchange  Debentures  received,  it may have an  effect  on
subsequent calculations of original issue discount or bond premium.


STATED INTEREST ON EXCHANGE DEBENTURES

     The stated interest on the Exchange  Debentures will be taxable as ordinary
income when received by a holder  utilizing the cash receipts and  disbursements
method of tax  accounting  and when  accrued by a holder  utilizing  the accrual
method of tax  accounting,  unless  the  Exchange  Debentures  are  issued  with
original issue discount or premium, in which case the rules described below will
apply.


ORIGINAL ISSUE DISCOUNT

     An Exchange  Debenture  that is issued for an issue price that is less than
its stated  redemption  price at maturity  will  generally be considered to have
been issued with original  issue  discount for United States  federal income tax
purposes.  If the Exchange  Debentures are traded on an  established  securities
market within the meaning of Section  1273(b) of the Code,  the "issue price" of
an Exchange Debenture will equal its fair market value on the issue date. If the
Exchange  Debentures are not traded on an established market and the Convertible
Exchangeable  Preferred  Stock is traded on an  established  market,  the "issue
price"  of an  Exchange  Debenture  will  equal  the  fair  market  value of the
Convertible  Exchangeable  Preferred  Stock on the issue date. In the event that
neither the Convertible Exchangeable Preferred Stock nor the Exchange Debentures
are traded on an  established  securities  market,  and absent any  "potentially
abusive  situation,"  the issue price of the Exchange  Debentures  will be their
stated principal  amount,  or, in the event the Exchange  Debentures do not bear
"adequate stated interest" within the meaning of Section 1274 of the Code, their
"imputed  principal  amount" as determined  under Section 1274 of the Code using
the  applicable  federal rate ("AFR") in effect as of the date of the  exchange.
The "stated  redemption  price at maturity" of an Exchange  Debenture will equal
the sum of all  payments  required  under  the  Exchange  Debenture  other  than
payments of qualified stated  interest.  "Qualified  stated interest"  generally
means stated interest unconditionally payable as a series of payments in cash or
property  (other than debt  instruments of the Company) at least annually during
the entire term of the  Exchange  Debenture  at a single  fixed rate of interest
that  appropriately  takes  into  account  the  length of the  interval  between
payments.

     An  Exchange  Debenture  will  not be  considered  to have  original  issue
discount if the difference  between the Exchange  Debenture's  stated redemption
price at  maturity  and its issue price is less than a de minimis  amount,  i.e.
one-quarter of one percent of the stated redemption price at maturity multiplied
by the number of complete years to maturity. Holders of Exchange Debentures with
a de minimis  amount of original  issue  discount  will  generally  include such
original  issue  discount  in income,  as capital  gain,  on a pro rata basis as
principal payments are made on such Exchange Debentures.

     A holder of an Exchange  Debenture  with  original  issue  discount will be
required  to  include  qualified  stated  interest  payments  in  income as such
payments  are  received or accrued in  accordance  with the  holder's  method of
accounting for federal income tax purposes. A holder will be required to include
original issue discount in income for federal income tax purposes as it accrues,
regardless of accounting  method,  in  accordance  with a constant  yield method
based on a compounding of interest. As a consequence, holders may be required to
include  interest on Exchange  Debentures with original issue discount in income
before receiving the corresponding interest payments.

     If issued with original  issue  discount,  the Exchange  Debentures  may be
subject  to  the  provision  of  the  Code  dealing  with  high-yield   discount
obligations,  in which case a certain portion of the original issue discount may
be treated as a dividend  with respect to the stock of the Company and the rules
applicable  to  distributions  with  respect  to  the  Convertible  Exchangeable
Preferred Stock may apply.


PREMIUM

     If a holder's tax basis in an Exchange Debenture exceeds the amount payable
at maturity, Section 171 of the Code provides for an election whereby the excess
or premium,  to the extent not  attributable to the conversion  privilege of the
Exchange Debenture, can be offset against (and thereby reduce)



                                     S-100
<PAGE>

taxable income attributable to interest received on the Exchange Debenture.  The
premium is amortized, as an offset to interest received, over the remaining term
of the Exchange  Debenture.  An election under Section 171 of the Code generally
is  binding  once made and  applies  to all  obligations  owned or  subsequently
acquired  by the  taxpayer.  In  addition,  if the  price  paid for an  Exchange
Debenture is in excess of the "adjusted  issue price" of the Exchange  Debenture
at the time of the  purchase,  but less  than the  Exchange  Debenture's  stated
redemption  price at  maturity,  the  regulations  allow the  holder to take the
"acquisition premium" into account thereby reducing the amount of original issue
discount otherwise required to be included in income.


MARKET DISCOUNT

     The market discount  provisions of Sections 1276-1278 of the Code generally
provide that, subject to a statutorily-defined de minimis exception, if a holder
of an  Exchange  Debenture  purchases  it at a market  discount  and  thereafter
recognizes gain on the disposition of the Exchange Debenture (including a gift),
the lesser of such gain (or appreciation,  in the case of a gift) or the portion
of the market  discount  that accrued  while the Exchange  Debenture was held by
such  holder  will be treated  as  ordinary  interest  income at the time of the
disposition.  For this  purpose,  a  purchase  at a market  discount  includes a
purchase of an Exchange  Debenture  with original issue discount at or after the
original issue at a price below the revised issue price. The revised issue price
equals the original  issue price of the Exchange  Debenture  plus the  aggregate
amount of original  issue  discount  includible  in income  with  respect to the
Exchange  Debenture  before the date of its purchase.  The market discount rules
also  provide  that a holder who  acquires  an  Exchange  Debenture  at a market
discount (and who does not elect to include such market  discount in income on a
current  basis) may be required to defer a portion of any  interest  incurred or
maintained to purchase or carry such debt  instrument  until the holder disposes
of the debt instrument in a taxable transaction.

     The Exchange  Debentures provide that they may be redeemed,  in whole or in
part, before maturity.  If some or all of the Exchange  Debentures are redeemed,
each  holder of an Exchange  Debenture  that was  acquired at a market  discount
would be required to treat the principal  payment as ordinary interest income to
the extent of any accrued market discount on such Exchange Debenture.

     A holder of an Exchange  Debenture may elect to have market discount accrue
on a constant  interest  rate basis or a straight  line basis.  In  addition,  a
holder of an  Exchange  Debenture  acquired  at a market  discount  may elect to
include the market discount in income as the discount thereon accrues, either on
a straight line basis or, if elected,  on a constant  interest  rate basis.  The
current  inclusion   election,   once  made,  applies  to  all  market  discount
obligations  acquired  by such  holder  on or after  the  first day of the first
taxable  year to which the election  applies and may not be revoked  without the
consent  of the IRS.  If a holder of an  Exchange  Debenture  elects to  include
market  discount  in income  in  accordance  with the  preceding  sentence,  the
foregoing  rules with respect to the recognition of ordinary income on a sale or
certain  other  disposition  of such  Exchange  Debenture  and the  deferral  of
interest  deduction on indebtedness  related to such Exchange Debenture will not
apply.


REDEMPTION OR SALE OF EXCHANGE DEBENTURES

     In general,  a holder of an Exchange  Debenture will recognize gain or loss
upon the sale, exchange, redemption or other taxable disposition of the Exchange
Debenture measured by the difference between (i) the amount of cash and the fair
market  value of property  received  (except to the extent  attributable  to the
payment of accrued  interest  not  previously  included  in income) and (ii) the
holder's  tax basis in the  Exchange  Debenture.  The tax  basis of an  Exchange
Debenture to a holder will generally  equal its cost, or in the case of a holder
who  received an Exchange  Debenture in exchange  for  Convertible  Exchangeable
Preferred Stock, the issue price of the Exchange  Debenture on the date of issue
(in either case  increased by any  original  issue  discount or market  discount
previously  included in income by the holder and  decreased by any cash payments
received,  other than payments constituting  qualified stated interest,  and any
amortizable  bond premium  deducted  over the term of the  Exchange  Debenture).
Subject to the market discount rules discussed above, any such gain or loss will
generally be capital gain or loss, the tax  consequences  of which are discussed
under the caption "Sale,  Redemption,  or Exchange of  Convertible  Exchangeable
Preferred Stock."


                                     S-101
<PAGE>

CONVERSION  OF  CONVERTIBLE  EXCHANGEABLE PREFERRED STOCK OR EXCHANGE DEBENTURES
INTO CLASS A COMMON STOCK

     In  general,  no gain or loss will be  recognized  for  federal  income tax
purposes upon conversion of the Convertible  Exchangeable Preferred Stock or the
Exchange  Debentures  solely into shares of Class A Common  Stock.  However,  if
dividends on the Convertible Exchangeable Preferred Stock were in arrears at the
time of  conversion,  a portion of the Class A Common Stock received in exchange
for the Convertible  Exchangeable  Preferred Stock would be viewed under Section
305(c)  of  the  Code  as  a  distribution   with  respect  to  the  Convertible
Exchangeable Preferred Stock, taxable as a dividend at the time of the exchange.
Similarly, if interest on the Exchange Debentures were in arrears at the time of
conversion,  a portion of the Class A Common Stock  received in exchange for the
Exchange  Debentures would be taxable as ordinary interest income at the time of
the exchange.  In addition,  a holder will  recognize gain or loss on receipt of
cash in lieu of fractional  shares of Class A Common Stock in an amount equal to
the difference between the amount of cash received and the holder's tax basis in
such fractional shares.  Except to the extent of cash paid in lieu of fractional
shares of Class A Common Stock, the adjusted tax basis for the shares of Class A
Common Stock received upon conversion will be equal to the adjusted tax basis of
the  Convertible   Exchangeable  Preferred  Stock  or  the  Exchange  Debentures
converted,  and,  provided the Convertible  Exchangeable  Preferred Stock or the
Exchange Debentures are held as capital assets, the holding period of the shares
of Class A Common  Stock will  include  the  holding  period of the  Convertible
Exchangeable  Preferred Stock or the Exchange Debentures converted.  Any accrued
market  discount  not  previously  included  in  income  as of the  date  of the
conversion  of Exchange  Debentures  will carry over to the Class A Common Stock
received on conversion and gain realized upon the subsequent  disposition of the
Class A Common  Stock will be treated as  ordinary  income to the extent of such
market discount.


ADJUSTMENTS TO CONVERSION PRICE

     Adjustments  in  the  conversion   price  (or  the  failure  to  make  such
adjustments)  pursuant  to  the  anti-dilution  provisions  of  the  Convertible
Exchangeable Preferred Stock or the Exchange Debentures to reflect distributions
of cash or  property  to holders of Class A Common  Stock,  or  pursuant  to the
optional adjustment  provisions  permitted to be made by the Company, may result
in constructive  distributions to holders of Convertible  Exchangeable Preferred
Stock or Exchange Debentures that could be taxable to them as dividends pursuant
to Section 305 of the Code. If such a constructive distribution were to occur, a
holder of Convertible  Exchangeable Preferred Stock or Exchange Debentures could
be required to recognize  ordinary income for tax purposes  without  receiving a
corresponding distribution of cash.


BACKUP WITHHOLDING AND REPORTING REQUIREMENTS

     Information  reporting  to the  IRS is  required  for  dividends,  interest
payments and original issue discount accruals for certain  noncorporate  holders
(including  individuals).  These  noncorporate  holders may be subject to backup
withholding at a rate of 31 percent on payments of dividends, principal, premium
and interest (including original issue discount, if any) on, and the proceeds of
a sale, exchange, or redemption of, shares of Convertible Exchangeable Preferred
Stock or the  Exchange  Debentures.  Backup  withholding  will apply only if the
holder (i) fails to furnish its Taxpayer  Identification  Number  ("TIN") which,
for an  individual,  would be his Social  Security  Number,  (ii)  furnishes  an
incorrect  TIN,  (iii) is notified by the Internal  Revenue  Service that it has
failed to properly  report  payments of interest  and  dividends,  or (iv) under
certain  circumstances,  fails to certify, under penalty of perjury, that it has
furnished a correct TIN and has not been  notified by the IRS that it is subject
to backup withholding for failure to report interest and dividend payments.  The
application  for  exemption is available by providing a properly  completed  IRS
Form  W-9.   Holders   should  consult  their  tax  advisors   regarding   their
qualification  for  exemption  from backup  withholding  and the  procedure  for
obtaining such an exemption if applicable.

     The  Company  will  report  to  the  holders  of  Convertible  Exchangeable
Preferred Stock or Exchange Debentures and the IRS the amount of any "reportable
payments" and any amount withheld with respect to the  Convertible  Exchangeable
Preferred Stock or Exchange Debentures during each calendar year.


                                     S-102
<PAGE>

SPECIAL TAX RULES APPLICABLE TO FOREIGN HOLDERS

General

     As used herein,  a "Non-U.S.  Holder" means any  individual or entity other
than a holder of Convertible  Exchangeable Preferred Stock that is (i) a citizen
or resident of the United States  (including  certain former citizens and former
residents),  (ii) a partnership,  corporation  (including an entity treated as a
corporation  or  partnership  for United States  federal income tax purposes) or
other entity  created or organized in the United States or under the laws of the
United States or of any political  subdivision organized thereof (other than any
partnership treated as foreign under federal  regulations),  (iii) an estate the
income of which is subject to United States federal income  taxation  regardless
of source,  or (iv) a trust with respect to the  administration of which a court
within the United States is able to exercise  primary  supervision and which has
one or more United  States  fiduciaries,  who have the  authority to control all
substantial decisions of the trust.

     An  individual  may,  subject  to  certain  exceptions,  be  deemed to be a
resident alien (as opposed to a  non-resident  alien) by virtue of being present
in the United  States at least 31 days in the calendar year and for an aggregate
of at least 183 days during a three-year  period ending in the current  calendar
year  (counting  for such  purposes all of the days present in the current year,
one-third of the days present in the  immediately  preceding year, and one-sixth
of the days present in the second preceding  year).  Resident aliens are subject
to United States federal tax as if they were United States citizens.

Dividends on Convertible Exchangeable Preferred Stock

     Subject to the discussion below, any dividends paid to a Non-U.S. Holder of
Convertible   Exchangeable   Preferred   Stock  generally  will  be  subject  to
withholding  tax at a 30%  rate or such  lower  rate as may be  specified  by an
applicable income tax treaty.

     Under  present  law,  for  purposes  of  determining  whether  tax is to be
withheld at a 30% rate or a reduced  rate as  specified by an income tax treaty,
the Company  ordinarily  will  presume  that  dividends  paid to an address in a
foreign country are paid to a resident of such country absent definite knowledge
that such presumption is not warranted. A Non-U.S. Holder that is eligible for a
reduced rate of United States  withholding  tax pursuant to an income tax treaty
may  obtain a refund  of any  excess  amount  currently  withheld  by  filing an
appropriate  claim for refund with the United States Internal  Revenue  Service.
Under proposed  regulations,  a beneficial  owner who is a Non-U.S.  Holder must
submit a properly  completed Internal Revenue Service Form W-8 to the Company or
a qualified intermediary to be eligible for a tax treaty reduction.

     If a  Non-U.S.  Holder is  engaged  in a trade or  business  in the  United
States, and if (i) dividends on the Convertible Exchangeable Preferred Stock are
effectively  connected  with the  conduct of such trade or business or (ii) if a
tax treaty  applies,  dividends are  attributable  to a United States  permanent
establishment  of the Non-U.S.  Holder,  the Non-U.S.  Holder will  generally be
subject to regular United States income tax on such effectively connected income
in the same manner as if the Non-U.S. Holder were a United States resident. Such
a Non-U.S.  Holder will be  required to provide the Company a properly  executed
United States  Revenue  Service Form 4224 or successor form in order to claim an
exemption from the 30% withholding tax.

Interest on Exchange Debentures

     Payments of interest  (including  original issue  discount,  if any) on the
Exchange  Debentures  by the Company or any agent of the Company to any Non-U.S.
Holder will not be subject to  withholding  of United States federal income tax,
provided that in the case of interest  (including  original issue  discount) (1)
the Non-U.S.  Holder does not actually or constructively  own 10 percent or more
of the  total  combined  voting  power of all  classes  of stock of the  Company
entitled  to vote,  (2) the  Non-U.S.  Holder  is not (x) a  controlled  foreign
corporation  that is related to the Company  through stock  ownership,  or (y) a
bank receiving interest  described in Section  881(c)(3)(A) of the Code, and (3)
either (A) the  beneficial  owner of the  Exchange  Debentures  certifies to the
Company or its agent, under penalties of perjury, that


                                     S-103
<PAGE>

it is not a "United  States  person" (as defined in the Code) and  provides  its
name and  address,  or (B) a  securities  clearing  organization,  bank or other
financial institution that holds customers' securities in the ordinary course of
its trade or  business  (a  "financial  institution")  and  holds  the  Exchange
Debentures  on behalf of the  beneficial  owner  certifies to the Company or its
agent,  under  penalties of perjury,  that such statement has been received from
the beneficial  owner by it or by the financial  institution  between it and the
beneficial owner and furnishes the payor with a copy thereof.  The certification
requirement  described  in clause 3(A) will be  fulfilled  by the  provision  of
United States  Internal  Revenue  Service Form W-8.  Each Non-U.S.  Holder of an
Exchange  Debenture  should be aware that if it does not  properly  provide  the
required  Internal Revenue Service form, or if the Internal Revenue Service form
is  not  properly  transmitted  to and  received  by the  United  States  person
otherwise required to withhold United States federal income tax, interest on the
Exchange  Debenture  may be subject  to United  States  withholding  tax at a 30
percent rate.

     If a Non-U.S. Holder is engaged in a trade or business in the United States
and  interest  (including  original  issue  discount,  if any)  on the  Exchange
Debentures is  effectively  connected with the conduct of such trade or business
(or, if an income tax treaty applies, and the Non-U.S. Holder maintains a United
States   "permanent   establishment"   to  which  the   interest  is   generally
attributable),  the Non-U.S.  Holder,  although  exempt from the withholding tax
discussed in the  preceding  paragraph  (provided  that such holder  furnishes a
properly  executed  IRS Form 4224 on or before  any  payment  date to claim such
exemption),  will  generally be subject to United States  federal  income tax on
such interest in the same manner as if it were a United States person.

Ownership  and  Sale  of  Convertible  Exchangeable Preferred Stock and Exchange
Debentures

     In general, a Non-U.S.  Holder will not be subject to United States federal
income tax with respect to any gain realized on a sale or other  disposition  of
Convertible  Exchangeable  Preferred Stock or Exchange Debentures (including any
gain realized on an exchange of  Convertible  Exchangeable  Preferred  Stock for
Exchange  Debentures  that is treated as a sale or  exchange  for United  States
federal  income tax purposes)  unless (i) such Non-U.S.  Holder is an individual
who is present in the United  States for 183 days or more in the taxable year of
disposition, and either (a) such individual has a "tax home" (as defined in Code
Section 911 (d)(3)) in the United States (unless such gain is  attributable to a
fixed place of business in a foreign  country  maintained by such individual and
has been subject to foreign tax of at least 10%) or (b) the gain is attributable
to an office or other fixed place of business  maintained by such  individual in
the United States;  (ii) such gain is effectively  connected with the conduct by
such Non-U.S.  Holder of a trade or business in the United  States;  or (iii) in
certain  cases,  if the Company is or has been a "United  States  real  property
holding  corporation" within the meaning of Section 897(c)(2) of the Code at any
time within the shorter of the five-year  period  preceding such  disposition or
such Non-U.S.  Holder's  holding  period.  A corporation  is generally a "United
States  real  property  holding  corporation"  if the fair  market  value of its
"United States real property  interests" equals or exceeds 50% of the sum of the
fair market value of its worldwide real property interests plus its other assets
used or held for use in a trade  or  business.  Although  the  Company  does not
believe  that it has been or is or will become a "United  States  real  property
holding  corporation" in the foreseeable future, any such development could have
adverse United States tax consequences for Non-U.S. Holders.

     In addition, no federal income tax will be imposed on a Non-U.S.  Holder on
the  conversion  of the  Convertible  Exchangeable  Preferred  Stock or Exchange
Debentures for Class A Common Stock.

     Further,  if such  Non-U.S.  Holder  is a  foreign  corporation,  it may be
subject to a branch  profits tax equal to 30% (or such lower rate provided by an
applicable treaty) of its effectively connected earnings and profits, subject to
certain adjustments, deemed to have been repatriated from the United States. For
purposes of the branch  profits  tax,  dividends  or  interest  on, and any gain
recognized  on the  sale,  exchange  or  other  disposition  of the  Convertible
Exchangeable Preferred Stock or the Exchange Debentures, will be included in the
effectively  connected  earnings  and  profits of such  Non-U.S.  Holder if such
dividends,  interest or gain, as the case may be, is effectively  connected with
the conduct by the Non-U.S. Holder of a trade or business in the United States.


                                     S-104
<PAGE>

Federal Estate Tax

     Under  Section  2104 of the Code an  individual  Non-U.S.  Holder  who owns
shares of Convertible Exchangeable Preferred Stock at the time of his death will
be required to include the value  thereof in his gross estate for United  States
federal estate tax purposes,  and may be subject to United States federal estate
tax  unless  an  applicable  estate  tax  treaty  provides  otherwise.  Exchange
Debentures held by an individual  Non-U.S.  Holder at the time of his death will
not be  included  in his gross  estate  for  United  States  federal  estate tax
purposes, provided that the individual Non-U.S. Holder does not own, actually or
constructively,  10 percent or more of the total  combined  voting  power of all
classes  of stock  of the  Company  entitled  to vote  and,  at the time of such
individual  Non-U.S.  Holder's  death,  payments  with respect to such  Exchange
Debentures  would not have been  effectively  connected with the conduct by such
individual Non-U.S. Holder of a trade or business in the United States.

Information Reporting and Backup Withholding

     Under  certain   circumstances,   the  Internal  Revenue  Service  requires
"information  reporting" and "backup  withholding" at a rate of 31% with respect
to payments of dividends  and  interest.  Non-U.S.  Holders  generally  would be
exempt from Internal  Revenue Service  reporting  requirements and United States
backup withholding with respect to dividends payable on Convertible Exchangeable
Preferred  Stock and interest  payable on Exchange  Debentures.  Under  proposed
regulations,  however, a Non-U.S.  Holder of Convertible  Exchangeable Preferred
Stock that fails to certify its Non-U.S.  Holder status in  accordance  with the
requirements of the proposed  regulations,  would under certain circumstances be
subject to United  States  backup  withholding  at a rate of 31% on  payments of
dividends and interest.  The application for exemption is available by providing
a properly completed Internal Revenue Service Form W-8.

     The payment of the proceeds of the disposition of Convertible  Exchangeable
Preferred  Stock or  Exchange  Debentures  by a holder to or through  the United
States  office of a broker or  through a  non-United  States  branch of a United
States  broker  generally  will be subject to  information  reporting and backup
withholding at a rate of 31% unless the holder either  certifies its status as a
Non-U.S.   Holder  under  penalties  of  perjury  or  otherwise  establishes  an
exemption.  The payment of the proceeds of the disposition by a Non-U.S.  Holder
of Convertible Exchangeable Preferred Stock or Exchange Debentures to or through
a non-United  States office of a non-United States broker will not be subject to
backup withholding or information  reporting unless the non-United States broker
has certain United States relationships.

     Any amounts withheld under the backup withholding rules from a payment to a
Non-U.S. Holder will be refunded (or credited against the holder's United States
federal income tax liability,  if any) provided that the required information is
furnished to the Internal Revenue Service.

     THE FOREGOING  DISCUSSION IS FOR GENERAL INFORMATION AND IS NOT TAX ADVICE.
ACCORDINGLY, EACH PROSPECTIVE HOLDER OF CONVERTIBLE EXCHANGEABLE PREFERRED STOCK
OR EXCHANGE  DEBENTURES  SHOULD CONSULT HIS OWN TAX ADVISOR AS TO THE PARTICULAR
TAX CONSEQUENCES TO HIM OF THE PURCHASE, OWNERSHIP,  CONVERSION,  REDEMPTION AND
DISPOSITION  OF  THE  CONVERTIBLE   EXCHANGEABLE  PREFERRED  STOCK  OR  EXCHANGE
DEBENTURES,  INCLUDING  THE  APPLICABILITY  AND  EFFECT OF ANY  STATE,  LOCAL OR
FOREIGN TAX LAWS, AND ANY RECENT OR PROSPECTIVE CHANGES IN APPLICABLE TAX LAWS.


                                     S-105
<PAGE>

                                  UNDERWRITING

     Under the terms and subject to the  conditions  stated in the  Underwriting
Agreement  dated the date of this  Prospectus  Supplement,  each of Smith Barney
Inc.,  BT Alex.  Brown  Incorporated,  Credit  Suisse First Boston  Corporation,
Salomon   Brothers  Inc,  Chase   Securities  Inc.  and  Furman  Selz  LLC  (the
"Underwriters") has severally agreed to purchase,  and the Company has agreed to
sell to each  Underwriter,  the  number of shares  of  Convertible  Exchangeable
Preferred Stock set forth opposite the name of such Underwriter below:


<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
                                                           NUMBER
                      UNDERWRITER                         OF SHARES
- -------------------------------------------------------- ----------
<S>                                                        <C>
         Smith Barney Inc.   ...........................   637,500
         BT Alex. Brown Incorporated  ..................   637,500
         Credit Suisse First Boston Corporation   ......   637,500
         Salomon Brothers Inc   ........................   637,500
         Chase Securities Inc.  ........................   225,000
         Furman Selz LLC  ..............................   225,000
                                                         ---------
Total   ................................................ 3,000,000
                                                         =========
</TABLE>


     The  Underwriting  Agreement  provides that the  obligations of the several
Underwriters  to pay for and  accept  delivery  of the  shares  are  subject  to
approval of certain legal  matters by counsel and to certain  other  conditions.
The  Underwriters  are  obligated to take and pay for all shares of  Convertible
Exchangeable  Preferred  Stock  offered  hereby (other than those covered by the
overallotment option described below) if any such shares are taken.

     The  Underwriters  initially  propose  to  offer  part  of  the  shares  of
Convertible  Exchangeable  Preferred  Stock directly to the public at the public
offering  price set forth on the cover page of this  Prospectus  Supplement  and
part of the shares to certain  dealers at a price that  represents  a concession
not  in  excess  of  $.83  per  share  below  the  public  offering  price.  The
Underwriters may allow, and such dealers may reallow, a concession not in excess
of $.10 per share to the other  Underwriters or to certain other dealers.  After
the initial offering of the shares to the public,  the public offering price and
such concessions may be changed by the Underwriters.

     The Company has granted to the  Underwriters an option,  exercisable for 30
days from the date of this Prospectus Supplement, to purchase up to an aggregate
of 450,000 additional shares of Convertible  Exchangeable Preferred Stock at the
public offering price set forth on the cover page of this Prospectus  Supplement
less underwriting discounts and commissions.  The Underwriters may exercise such
option  to  purchase  additional  shares  solely  for the  purpose  of  covering
over-allotments,  if any,  incurred in connection with the sale of the shares of
Convertible  Exchangeable  Preferred  Stock offered  hereby.  To the extent such
option is exercised, each Underwriter will become obligated,  subject to certain
conditions,  to purchase  approximately  the same  percentage of such additional
shares as the number of shares set forth opposite each Underwriter's name in the
preceding table bears to the total number of shares of Convertible  Exchangeable
Preferred Stock offered by the Underwriters hereby.

     The  Company  and the  Underwriters  have  agreed to  indemnify  each other
against certain liabilities, including liabilities under the Securities Act.

     The  Company,  its  officers  and  directors  and the holders of all of the
shares of Class B Common Stock to be outstanding  after the Offering have agreed
that, for a period of 90 days from the date of this Prospectus Supplement,  they
will not, without the prior written consent of Smith Barney Inc.,  offer,  sell,
contract to sell,  or  otherwise  dispose of, any shares of Common  Stock of the
Company or any securities  convertible into, or exercisable or exchangeable for,
Common Stock of the Company.

     In connection with this Offering and in compliance with applicable law, the
Underwriters may overallot (i.e.,  sell more shares of Convertible  Exchangeable
Preferred  Stock than the total amount shown on the list of  Underwriters  which
appears above) and may effect transactions which stabilize,


                                     S-106
<PAGE>

maintain  or  otherwise  affect  the market  price of the shares of  Convertible
Exchangeable Preferred Stock at levels above those which might otherwise prevail
in the  open  market.  Such  transactions  may  include  placing  bids  for  the
Convertible   Exchangeable   Preferred  Stock  or  effecting  purchases  of  the
Convertible  Exchangeable Preferred Stock for the purpose of pegging,  fixing or
maintaining the price of the Convertible Exchangeable Preferred Stock or for the
purpose of reducing a syndicate  short position  created in connection  with the
Offering.  A syndicate  short  position may be covered by exercise of the option
described above in lieu of or in addition to open market purchases. In addition,
the contractual arrangements among the Underwriters include a provision whereby,
if the Underwriters purchase shares of Convertible  Exchangeable Preferred Stock
in the  open  market  for the  account  of the  underwriting  syndicate  and the
securities purchased can be traced to a particular  Underwriter or member of the
selling group, the underwriting syndicate may require the Underwriter or selling
group  member in  question to purchase  the shares of  Convertible  Exchangeable
Preferred  Stock in question at the cost price to the  syndicate  or may recover
from (or decline to pay to) the  Underwriter or selling group member in question
the  selling   concession   applicable  to  the  securities  in  question.   The
Underwriters  are not required to engage in any of these activities and any such
activities, if commenced, may be discontinued at any time.

     Smith  Barney  Inc.  and  certain  of  the  other Underwriters have and may
continue  to  provide  investment banking services to the Company for which they
receive customary fees.

     Chase  Securities Inc. is an affiliate of The Chase Manhattan Bank which is
agent bank and a lender to the  Company  under the Bank  Credit  Agreement.  The
Chase Manhattan Bank and affiliates of certain other  Underwriters  will receive
their proportionate share of any repayment by the Company of amounts outstanding
under the Bank Credit  Agreement  from the proceeds of the sale of the shares of
Convertible  Exchangeable  Preferred  Stock offered hereby.  In addition,  Chase
Securities Inc., The Chase Manhattan Bank and their affiliates  participate from
time to time in investment banking and commercial  banking  transactions for the
Company. 


                                     S-107
<PAGE>

                           GLOSSARY OF DEFINED TERMS

     "ABC" means Capital Cities/ABC, Inc.

     "Adjusted EBITDA" means broadcast cash flow less corporate overhead expense
and is a commonly used measure of performance for broadcast companies.  Adjusted
EBITDA does not purport to represent  cash  provided by operating  activities as
reflected  in the  Company's  consolidated  statements  of cash flows,  is not a
measure of financial  performance under generally accepted accounting principles
and should not be  considered  in isolation  or as a substitute  for measures of
performance   prepared  in  accordance   with  generally   accepted   accounting
principles.

     "Adjusted   EBITDA  margin"  means  the  Adjusted  EBITDA  divided  by  net
broadcast revenues.

     "Amended   Certificate"   means   the  Amended  and  Restated  Articles  of
Incorporation of the Company, as amended.

     "Arbitron" means Arbitron, Inc.

     "Bank  Credit  Agreement"  means  the Third  Amended  and  Restated  Credit
Agreement,  dated as of May 20,  1997,  among  the  Company,  the  Subsidiaries,
certain lenders named therein, and The Chase Manhattan Bank, as agent.

     "Broadcast  cash flow  margin"  means  broadcast  cash flow  divided by net
broadcast revenues.

     "Broadcast  Cash Flow"  means  operating  income  plus  corporate  overhead
expenses,  special  bonuses  paid  to  executive  officers,   non-cash  deferred
compensation,   depreciation  and  amortization,  including  both  tangible  and
intangible assets and program rights, less cash payment for program rights. Cash
program  payments  represent cash payments made for current program payables and
sports  rights  and do not  necessarily  correspond  to program  usage.  Special
bonuses paid to executive officers are considered unusual and non-recurring. The
Company has presented  broadcast cash flow data,  which the Company believes are
comparable to the data provided by other companies in the industry, because such
data are commonly  used as a measure of  performance  for  broadcast  companies.
However,  broadcast cash flow (i) does not purport to represent cash provided by
operating  activities as reflected in the Company's  consolidated  statements of
cash  flow,  (ii) is not a measure  of  financial  performance  under  generally
accepted  accounting  principles and (iii) should not be considered in isolation
or as a  substitute  for measures of  performance  prepared in  accordance  with
generally accepted accounting principles.

     "CBS" means CBS, Inc.

     "Cincinnati/Kansas  City Acquisitions"  means the Company's  acquisition of
the assets and liabilities of WSTR-TV (Cincinnati, OH) and KSMO-TV (Kansas City,
MO).

     "Class A Common Stock" means the Company's Class A Common Stock,  par value
$.01 per share.

     "Class B Common Stock" means the Company's Class B Common Stock,  par value
$.01 per share.

     "Columbus   Option"  means  the  Company's  option  to  purchase  both  the
Non-License Assets and the License Assets relating to WSYX-TV, Columbus, OH.

     "Commission" means the Securities and Exchange Commission.

     "Common  Stock"  means  the  Class  A  Common  Stock and the Class B Common
   Stock.

     "Communications Act" means the Communications Act of 1934, as amended.

     "Company"  means  Sinclair  Broadcast  Group,  Inc.  and  its  wholly owned
subsidiaries.

     "Controlling  Stockholders"  means  David  D. Smith, Frederick G. Smith, J.
Duncan Smith and Robert E. Smith.

     "DAB" means digital audio broadcasting.

     "DBS" means direct-to-home broadcast satellite television.

     "Debt Issuance" means the Company's private placement of the 1997 Notes, in
the principal amount of $200,000,000, on July 2, 1997.


                                      G-1
<PAGE>

     "Designated Market Area" or "DMA" means one of the 211 generally-recognized
television market areas.

     "DOJ" means the United States Justice Department.

     "DTV" means digital television.

     "Exchange Act" means the Securities Exchange Act of 1934, as amended.

     "FCC" means the Federal Communications Commision.

     "FCN" means the Fox Children's Network.

     "Flint  Acquisition"  means  the  Company's  acquisition  of  the assets of
   WSMH-TV (Flint, Michigan).

     "Fox" means Fox Broadcasting Company.

     "Glencairn" means Glencairn, Ltd. and its subsidiaries.

     "Greenville  Stations"  means radio  stations  WFBC-FM,  WORD-AM,  WFBC-AM,
WSPA-AM,  WSPA-FM,  WOLI-FM, and WOLT-FM located in the  Greenville/Spartanburg,
South Carolina area.

     "HSR"  means  the  Hart-Scott-Rodino Antitrust Improvements Act of 1976, as
amended.

     "HYTOPS"  means the  Company's  115/8% High Yield Trust  Offered  Preferred
Securities issued pursuant to the HYTOPS Issuance.

     "HYTOPS  Issuance" means the Company's  private  placement of HYTOPS,  in a
liquidation amount of $200,000,000, on March 14, 1997.

     "Independent"  means a station that is not affiliated with any of ABC, CBS,
NBC, FOX, UPN or WB.

     "JSAs"  means  joint sales  agreements  pursuant to which an entity has the
right,  for a fee  paid  to  the  owner  and  operator  of a  station,  to  sell
substantially all of the commercial advertising on the station.

     "KSC" means Keymarket of South Carolina, Inc.

     "License  Assets" means the television  and radio station assets  essential
for  broadcasting  a television  or radio signal in compliance  with  regulatory
guidelines,  generally consisting of the FCC license, transmitter,  transmission
lines, technical equipment, call letters and trademarks,  and certain furniture,
fixtures and equipment.

     "License Assets Option" means the Company's  option to purchase the License
Assets of KDNL-TV, St. Louis, MO; KOVR-TV,  Sacramento, CA; WTTV-TV and WTTK-TV,
Indianapolis, IN; WLOS-TV, Asheville, NC; KABB-TV, San Antonio, TX; and KDSM-TV,
Des Moines,  IA,  which the Company has  exercised  with respect to all stations
other than WTTV-TV and WTTK-TV.

     "LMAs" means program  services  agreements,  time  brokerage  agreements or
local  marketing  agreements  pursuant to which an entity  provides  programming
services to television or radio stations that are not owned by the entity.

     "Major Networks" means each of ABC, CBS or NBC, singly or collectively.

     "MSA" means the Metro Survey Area as defined by Arbitron.

     "MMDS" means multichannel multipoint distribution services.

     "NBC" means the National Broadcasting Company.

     "Nielsen" means the A.C. Nielsen Company Station Index dated May 1996.

     "1993 Notes" means the Company's 10% Senior Subordinated Notes due 2003.

     "1995 Notes" means the Company's 10% Senior Subordinated Notes due 2005.

     "1996  Acquisitions" means the 16 television and 33 radio stations that the
Company acquired,  obtained options to acquire, or obtained the right to program
during 1996 for an aggregate consideration of approximately $1.2 billion.


                                      G-2
<PAGE>

     "1997 Notes" means the  Company's  9% Senior  Subordinated  Notes due 2007,
issued pursuant to the Debt Issuance.

     "Non-License Assets" means the assets relating to operation of a television
or radio station other than License Assets.

     "Peoria/Bloomington  Acquisition"  means the  acquisition by the Company of
the assets of WYZZ-TV on July 1, 1996.

     "River City" means River City Broadcasting, L.P.

     "River City  Acquisition"  means the Company's  acquisition from River City
and the owner of KRRT of certain Non-License Assets,  options to acquire certain
License and  Non-License  Assets and rights to provide  programming or sales and
marketing for certain stations, which was completed May 31, 1996.

     "SCI" means Sinclair Communications, Inc., a wholly owned subsidiary of the
Company that holds all of the broadcast operations of the Company.

     "Securities Act" means the Securities Act of 1933, as amended.

     "Series A  Preferred  Stock"  means  the  Company's  Series A  Exchangeable
Preferred  Stock,  par  value  $.01 per  share,  each  share  of which  has been
exchanged for a share of the Company's Series B Convertible Preferred Stock.

     "Series  B  Preferred  Stock"  means  the  Company's  Series B  Convertible
Preferred Stock, par value $.01 per share.

     "Series C Preferred  Stock" means the Company's  Series C Preferred  Stock,
par value $.01 per share.

     "Sinclair"  means  Sinclair  Broadcast  Group,  Inc.  and  its wholly owned
subsidiaries.

     "Superior  Acquisition"  means  the  Company's  acquisition of the stock of
Superior Communications, Inc. ("Superior").

     "TBAs" means time brokerage agreements; see definition of "LMAs."

     "UHF" means ultra-high frequency.

     "UPN" means United Paramount Television Network Partnership.

     "VHF" means very-high frequency.

     "WB" and the "WB Network" mean The WB Television Network Partners.

                                      G-3
<PAGE>
<TABLE>

<S>                                                                              <C>
================================================================================ ==================================================

       NO DEALER, SALESPERSON OR OTHER PERSON HAS BEEN AUTHORIZED
TO GIVE ANY INFORMATION OR TO MAKE ANY REPRESENTATIONS OTHER THAN
THOSE CONTAINED IN THIS PROSPECTUS SUPPLEMENT IN THE ACCOMPANYING
PROSPECTUS, IN CONNECTION WITH THE OFFER CONTAINED  HEREIN,  AND,
IF  GIVEN  OR  MADE,  SUCH   INFORMATION  OR REPRESENTATIONS MUST                                3,000,000 SHARES
NOT BE RELIED  UPON  AS  HAVING  BEEN AUTHORIZED  BY  THE COMPANY
OR  ANY  OF  THE  UNDERWRITERS.  THIS  PROSPECTUS  SUPPLEMENT AND
THE ACCOMPANYING PROSPECTUS DO NOT CONSTITUTE AN OFFER TO SELL OR                                SINCLAIR BROADCAST
A SOLICITATION OF AN  OFFER  TO  BUY  THE  SHARES  OF CONVERTIBLE                                    GROUP, INC.
EXCHANGEABLE PREFERRED STOCK BYANYONE   IN  ANY  JURISDICTION  IN
WHICH THE OFFER OR SOLICITATION IS NOT AUTHORIZED,  OR  IN  WHICH
THE  PERSON  MAKING THE OFFER OR SOLICITATION IS NOT QUALIFIED TO                          $3.00 CONVERTIBLE EXCHANGEABLE
QUALIFIED  TO  DO SO, OR TO ANY PERSON TO  WHOM IT IS UNLAWFUL TO                                   PREFERRED STOCK
MAKE SUCH OFFER OR  SOLICITATION.  NEITHER  THE  DELIVERY OF THIS
PROSPECTUS SUPPLEMENT AND THE ACCOMPANYING   PROSPECTUS  NOR  ANY
SALE MADE HEREUNDER SHALL CREATE ANY IMPLICATION THAT INFORMATION
CONTAINED  HEREIN  IS  CORRECT  AS OF ANY TIME SUBSEQUENT TO THIS
DATE HEREOF.
</TABLE>

              -----------------------------------

                       TABLE OF CONTENTS


<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
                                                         PAGE NO.
                                                         -------
<S>                                                        <C>
                    PROSPECTUS SUPPLEMENT

Prospectus Supplement Summary ........................      S-1
Historical and Pro Forma Ratios of Earnings to
   Fixed Charges and of Earnings to Fixed Charges
   and Preferred Dividends ...........................      S-11
Use of Proceeds   ....................................      S-12
Capitalization .......................................      S-13
Pro Forma Consolidated Financial Information of
   Sinclair ..........................................      S-14
Management's Discussion and Analysis of
   Financial Condition and Results of Operations of                                     P R O S P E C T U S  S U P P L E M E N T 
   Sinclair ..........................................      S-24
Industry Overview ....................................      S-33
Business of Sinclair .................................      S-36                                  September 17, 1997
Management  ..........................................      S-64                                  ----------------- 
Description of Convertible Exchangeable Preferred               
   Stock .............................................      S-70
Description of Exchange Debentures  ..................      S-81
Certain Definitions  .................................      S-90
Description of Indebtedness of Sinclair   ............      S-93
Certain Federal Income Tax Considerations    .........      S-96
Underwriting   .......................................     S-106                                    SMITH BARNEY, INC.
Glossary of Defined Terms  ...........................       G-1                                      BT ALEX. BROWN
                    PROSPECTUS                                                                  CREDIT SUISSE FIRST BOSTON
Available Information   ..............................         1                                  SALOMON BROTHERS INC.
Incorporation of Certain Documents by Reference       .        1                                  CHASE SECURITIES INC.
The Company ..........................................         3                                       FURMAN SELZ
Risk Factors   .......................................         3
Use of Proceeds   ....................................        17
Historical and Pro Forma Ratio of Earnings to Fixed
   Charges  ..........................................        18
Selling Stockholders .................................        19
Description of Debt Securities   .....................        20
Description of Capital Stock  ........................        34
Plan of Distribution .................................        42
Legal Matters  .......................................        43
Experts  .............................................        43


================================================================================ ===================================================
</TABLE>


© 2022 IncJournal is not affiliated with or endorsed by the U.S. Securities and Exchange Commission